Remove ada-lang.c:align_value
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / ada-lang.c
1 /* Ada language support routines for GDB, the GNU debugger.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1992-2020 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20
21 #include "defs.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "gdb_regex.h"
24 #include "frame.h"
25 #include "symtab.h"
26 #include "gdbtypes.h"
27 #include "gdbcmd.h"
28 #include "expression.h"
29 #include "parser-defs.h"
30 #include "language.h"
31 #include "varobj.h"
32 #include "inferior.h"
33 #include "symfile.h"
34 #include "objfiles.h"
35 #include "breakpoint.h"
36 #include "gdbcore.h"
37 #include "hashtab.h"
38 #include "gdb_obstack.h"
39 #include "ada-lang.h"
40 #include "completer.h"
41 #include "ui-out.h"
42 #include "block.h"
43 #include "infcall.h"
44 #include "annotate.h"
45 #include "valprint.h"
46 #include "source.h"
47 #include "observable.h"
48 #include "stack.h"
49 #include "typeprint.h"
50 #include "namespace.h"
51 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
52
53 #include "value.h"
54 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
55 #include "arch-utils.h"
56 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
57 #include "gdbsupport/function-view.h"
58 #include "gdbsupport/byte-vector.h"
59 #include <algorithm>
60
61 /* Define whether or not the C operator '/' truncates towards zero for
62 differently signed operands (truncation direction is undefined in C).
63 Copied from valarith.c. */
64
65 #ifndef TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO
66 #define TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO ((-5 / 2) == -2)
67 #endif
68
69 static struct type *desc_base_type (struct type *);
70
71 static struct type *desc_bounds_type (struct type *);
72
73 static struct value *desc_bounds (struct value *);
74
75 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *);
76
77 static int fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *);
78
79 static struct type *desc_data_target_type (struct type *);
80
81 static struct value *desc_data (struct value *);
82
83 static int fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *);
84
85 static int fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *);
86
87 static struct value *desc_one_bound (struct value *, int, int);
88
89 static int desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *, int, int);
90
91 static int desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *, int, int);
92
93 static struct type *desc_index_type (struct type *, int);
94
95 static int desc_arity (struct type *);
96
97 static int ada_type_match (struct type *, struct type *, int);
98
99 static int ada_args_match (struct symbol *, struct value **, int);
100
101 static struct value *make_array_descriptor (struct type *, struct value *);
102
103 static void ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *,
104 const struct block *,
105 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
106 domain_enum, struct objfile *);
107
108 static void ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *, const struct block *,
109 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
110 domain_enum, int, int *);
111
112 static int is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol *, int);
113
114 static void add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *, struct symbol *,
115 const struct block *);
116
117 static int num_defns_collected (struct obstack *);
118
119 static struct block_symbol *defns_collected (struct obstack *, int);
120
121 static struct value *resolve_subexp (expression_up *, int *, int,
122 struct type *, int,
123 innermost_block_tracker *);
124
125 static void replace_operator_with_call (expression_up *, int, int, int,
126 struct symbol *, const struct block *);
127
128 static int possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode, struct value **);
129
130 static const char *ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
131
132 static const char *ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode);
133
134 static int numeric_type_p (struct type *);
135
136 static int integer_type_p (struct type *);
137
138 static int scalar_type_p (struct type *);
139
140 static int discrete_type_p (struct type *);
141
142 static struct type *ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *, const char *,
143 int, int);
144
145 static struct value *evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *, int *);
146
147 static struct type *ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *,
148 const char *);
149
150 static int is_dynamic_field (struct type *, int);
151
152 static struct type *to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *,
153 const gdb_byte *,
154 CORE_ADDR, struct value *);
155
156 static struct type *to_fixed_array_type (struct type *, struct value *, int);
157
158 static struct type *to_fixed_range_type (struct type *, struct value *);
159
160 static struct type *to_static_fixed_type (struct type *);
161 static struct type *static_unwrap_type (struct type *type);
162
163 static struct value *unwrap_value (struct value *);
164
165 static struct type *constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *, long *);
166
167 static struct type *decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
168
169 static long decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *);
170
171 static struct value *decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *);
172
173 static int ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *);
174
175 static int ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *);
176
177 static struct value *value_subscript_packed (struct value *, int,
178 struct value **);
179
180 static struct value *coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *,
181 struct type *);
182
183 static int lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *, struct symbol *);
184
185 static int equiv_types (struct type *, struct type *);
186
187 static int is_name_suffix (const char *);
188
189 static int advance_wild_match (const char **, const char *, int);
190
191 static bool wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn);
192
193 static struct value *ada_coerce_ref (struct value *);
194
195 static LONGEST pos_atr (struct value *);
196
197 static struct value *value_pos_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
198
199 static struct value *value_val_atr (struct type *, struct value *);
200
201 static struct symbol *standard_lookup (const char *, const struct block *,
202 domain_enum);
203
204 static struct value *ada_search_struct_field (const char *, struct value *, int,
205 struct type *);
206
207 static int find_struct_field (const char *, struct type *, int,
208 struct type **, int *, int *, int *, int *);
209
210 static int ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol *, int,
211 struct value **, int, const char *,
212 struct type *, int);
213
214 static int ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *);
215
216 static void ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *,
217 struct language_arch_info *);
218
219 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field (int, struct value *, int,
220 struct type *);
221
222 static struct value *assign_aggregate (struct value *, struct value *,
223 struct expression *,
224 int *, enum noside);
225
226 static void aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *, struct value *,
227 struct expression *,
228 int *, LONGEST *, int *,
229 int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
230
231 static void aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *, struct value *,
232 struct expression *,
233 int *, LONGEST *, int *, int,
234 LONGEST, LONGEST);
235
236
237 static void aggregate_assign_others (struct value *, struct value *,
238 struct expression *,
239 int *, LONGEST *, int, LONGEST, LONGEST);
240
241
242 static void add_component_interval (LONGEST, LONGEST, LONGEST *, int *, int);
243
244
245 static struct value *ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *, struct expression *,
246 int *, enum noside);
247
248 static void ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *, int, int *,
249 int *);
250
251 static struct type *ada_find_any_type (const char *name);
252
253 static symbol_name_matcher_ftype *ada_get_symbol_name_matcher
254 (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name);
255
256 \f
257
258 /* The result of a symbol lookup to be stored in our symbol cache. */
259
260 struct cache_entry
261 {
262 /* The name used to perform the lookup. */
263 const char *name;
264 /* The namespace used during the lookup. */
265 domain_enum domain;
266 /* The symbol returned by the lookup, or NULL if no matching symbol
267 was found. */
268 struct symbol *sym;
269 /* The block where the symbol was found, or NULL if no matching
270 symbol was found. */
271 const struct block *block;
272 /* A pointer to the next entry with the same hash. */
273 struct cache_entry *next;
274 };
275
276 /* The Ada symbol cache, used to store the result of Ada-mode symbol
277 lookups in the course of executing the user's commands.
278
279 The cache is implemented using a simple, fixed-sized hash.
280 The size is fixed on the grounds that there are not likely to be
281 all that many symbols looked up during any given session, regardless
282 of the size of the symbol table. If we decide to go to a resizable
283 table, let's just use the stuff from libiberty instead. */
284
285 #define HASH_SIZE 1009
286
287 struct ada_symbol_cache
288 {
289 /* An obstack used to store the entries in our cache. */
290 struct obstack cache_space;
291
292 /* The root of the hash table used to implement our symbol cache. */
293 struct cache_entry *root[HASH_SIZE];
294 };
295
296 static void ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache);
297
298 /* Maximum-sized dynamic type. */
299 static unsigned int varsize_limit;
300
301 static const char ada_completer_word_break_characters[] =
302 #ifdef VMS
303 " \t\n!@#%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
304 #else
305 " \t\n!@#$%^&*()+=|~`}{[]\";:?/,-";
306 #endif
307
308 /* The name of the symbol to use to get the name of the main subprogram. */
309 static const char ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME[]
310 = "__gnat_ada_main_program_name";
311
312 /* Limit on the number of warnings to raise per expression evaluation. */
313 static int warning_limit = 2;
314
315 /* Number of warning messages issued; reset to 0 by cleanups after
316 expression evaluation. */
317 static int warnings_issued = 0;
318
319 static const char *known_runtime_file_name_patterns[] = {
320 ADA_KNOWN_RUNTIME_FILE_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
321 };
322
323 static const char *known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[] = {
324 ADA_KNOWN_AUXILIARY_FUNCTION_NAME_PATTERNS NULL
325 };
326
327 /* Maintenance-related settings for this module. */
328
329 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_set_ada_cmdlist;
330 static struct cmd_list_element *maint_show_ada_cmdlist;
331
332 /* The "maintenance ada set/show ignore-descriptive-type" value. */
333
334 static bool ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p = false;
335
336 /* Inferior-specific data. */
337
338 /* Per-inferior data for this module. */
339
340 struct ada_inferior_data
341 {
342 /* The ada__tags__type_specific_data type, which is used when decoding
343 tagged types. With older versions of GNAT, this type was directly
344 accessible through a component ("tsd") in the object tag. But this
345 is no longer the case, so we cache it for each inferior. */
346 struct type *tsd_type = nullptr;
347
348 /* The exception_support_info data. This data is used to determine
349 how to implement support for Ada exception catchpoints in a given
350 inferior. */
351 const struct exception_support_info *exception_info = nullptr;
352 };
353
354 /* Our key to this module's inferior data. */
355 static const struct inferior_key<ada_inferior_data> ada_inferior_data;
356
357 /* Return our inferior data for the given inferior (INF).
358
359 This function always returns a valid pointer to an allocated
360 ada_inferior_data structure. If INF's inferior data has not
361 been previously set, this functions creates a new one with all
362 fields set to zero, sets INF's inferior to it, and then returns
363 a pointer to that newly allocated ada_inferior_data. */
364
365 static struct ada_inferior_data *
366 get_ada_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
367 {
368 struct ada_inferior_data *data;
369
370 data = ada_inferior_data.get (inf);
371 if (data == NULL)
372 data = ada_inferior_data.emplace (inf);
373
374 return data;
375 }
376
377 /* Perform all necessary cleanups regarding our module's inferior data
378 that is required after the inferior INF just exited. */
379
380 static void
381 ada_inferior_exit (struct inferior *inf)
382 {
383 ada_inferior_data.clear (inf);
384 }
385
386
387 /* program-space-specific data. */
388
389 /* This module's per-program-space data. */
390 struct ada_pspace_data
391 {
392 ~ada_pspace_data ()
393 {
394 if (sym_cache != NULL)
395 ada_free_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
396 }
397
398 /* The Ada symbol cache. */
399 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache = nullptr;
400 };
401
402 /* Key to our per-program-space data. */
403 static const struct program_space_key<ada_pspace_data> ada_pspace_data_handle;
404
405 /* Return this module's data for the given program space (PSPACE).
406 If not is found, add a zero'ed one now.
407
408 This function always returns a valid object. */
409
410 static struct ada_pspace_data *
411 get_ada_pspace_data (struct program_space *pspace)
412 {
413 struct ada_pspace_data *data;
414
415 data = ada_pspace_data_handle.get (pspace);
416 if (data == NULL)
417 data = ada_pspace_data_handle.emplace (pspace);
418
419 return data;
420 }
421
422 /* Utilities */
423
424 /* If TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF type, return the target type after
425 all typedef layers have been peeled. Otherwise, return TYPE.
426
427 Normally, we really expect a typedef type to only have 1 typedef layer.
428 In other words, we really expect the target type of a typedef type to be
429 a non-typedef type. This is particularly true for Ada units, because
430 the language does not have a typedef vs not-typedef distinction.
431 In that respect, the Ada compiler has been trying to eliminate as many
432 typedef definitions in the debugging information, since they generally
433 do not bring any extra information (we still use typedef under certain
434 circumstances related mostly to the GNAT encoding).
435
436 Unfortunately, we have seen situations where the debugging information
437 generated by the compiler leads to such multiple typedef layers. For
438 instance, consider the following example with stabs:
439
440 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:Tt(0,46)=s16P_ARRAY:(0,47)=[...]"[...]
441 .stabs "pck__float_array___XUP:t(0,36)=(0,46)",128,0,6,0
442
443 This is an error in the debugging information which causes type
444 pck__float_array___XUP to be defined twice, and the second time,
445 it is defined as a typedef of a typedef.
446
447 This is on the fringe of legality as far as debugging information is
448 concerned, and certainly unexpected. But it is easy to handle these
449 situations correctly, so we can afford to be lenient in this case. */
450
451 static struct type *
452 ada_typedef_target_type (struct type *type)
453 {
454 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
455 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
456 return type;
457 }
458
459 /* Given DECODED_NAME a string holding a symbol name in its
460 decoded form (ie using the Ada dotted notation), returns
461 its unqualified name. */
462
463 static const char *
464 ada_unqualified_name (const char *decoded_name)
465 {
466 const char *result;
467
468 /* If the decoded name starts with '<', it means that the encoded
469 name does not follow standard naming conventions, and thus that
470 it is not your typical Ada symbol name. Trying to unqualify it
471 is therefore pointless and possibly erroneous. */
472 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
473 return decoded_name;
474
475 result = strrchr (decoded_name, '.');
476 if (result != NULL)
477 result++; /* Skip the dot... */
478 else
479 result = decoded_name;
480
481 return result;
482 }
483
484 /* Return a string starting with '<', followed by STR, and '>'. */
485
486 static std::string
487 add_angle_brackets (const char *str)
488 {
489 return string_printf ("<%s>", str);
490 }
491
492 static const char *
493 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters (void)
494 {
495 return ada_completer_word_break_characters;
496 }
497
498 /* Print an array element index using the Ada syntax. */
499
500 static void
501 ada_print_array_index (struct value *index_value, struct ui_file *stream,
502 const struct value_print_options *options)
503 {
504 LA_VALUE_PRINT (index_value, stream, options);
505 fprintf_filtered (stream, " => ");
506 }
507
508 /* la_watch_location_expression for Ada. */
509
510 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
511 ada_watch_location_expression (struct type *type, CORE_ADDR addr)
512 {
513 type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (type)));
514 std::string name = type_to_string (type);
515 return gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
516 (xstrprintf ("{%s} %s", name.c_str (), core_addr_to_string (addr)));
517 }
518
519 /* Assuming V points to an array of S objects, make sure that it contains at
520 least M objects, updating V and S as necessary. */
521
522 #define GROW_VECT(v, s, m) \
523 if ((s) < (m)) (v) = (char *) grow_vect (v, &(s), m, sizeof *(v));
524
525 /* Assuming VECT points to an array of *SIZE objects of size
526 ELEMENT_SIZE, grow it to contain at least MIN_SIZE objects,
527 updating *SIZE as necessary and returning the (new) array. */
528
529 static void *
530 grow_vect (void *vect, size_t *size, size_t min_size, int element_size)
531 {
532 if (*size < min_size)
533 {
534 *size *= 2;
535 if (*size < min_size)
536 *size = min_size;
537 vect = xrealloc (vect, *size * element_size);
538 }
539 return vect;
540 }
541
542 /* True (non-zero) iff TARGET matches FIELD_NAME up to any trailing
543 suffix of FIELD_NAME beginning "___". */
544
545 static int
546 field_name_match (const char *field_name, const char *target)
547 {
548 int len = strlen (target);
549
550 return
551 (strncmp (field_name, target, len) == 0
552 && (field_name[len] == '\0'
553 || (startswith (field_name + len, "___")
554 && strcmp (field_name + strlen (field_name) - 6,
555 "___XVN") != 0)));
556 }
557
558
559 /* Assuming TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT or a TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF to
560 a TYPE_CODE_STRUCT, find the field whose name matches FIELD_NAME,
561 and return its index. This function also handles fields whose name
562 have ___ suffixes because the compiler sometimes alters their name
563 by adding such a suffix to represent fields with certain constraints.
564 If the field could not be found, return a negative number if
565 MAYBE_MISSING is set. Otherwise raise an error. */
566
567 int
568 ada_get_field_index (const struct type *type, const char *field_name,
569 int maybe_missing)
570 {
571 int fieldno;
572 struct type *struct_type = check_typedef ((struct type *) type);
573
574 for (fieldno = 0; fieldno < TYPE_NFIELDS (struct_type); fieldno++)
575 if (field_name_match (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (struct_type, fieldno), field_name))
576 return fieldno;
577
578 if (!maybe_missing)
579 error (_("Unable to find field %s in struct %s. Aborting"),
580 field_name, TYPE_NAME (struct_type));
581
582 return -1;
583 }
584
585 /* The length of the prefix of NAME prior to any "___" suffix. */
586
587 int
588 ada_name_prefix_len (const char *name)
589 {
590 if (name == NULL)
591 return 0;
592 else
593 {
594 const char *p = strstr (name, "___");
595
596 if (p == NULL)
597 return strlen (name);
598 else
599 return p - name;
600 }
601 }
602
603 /* Return non-zero if SUFFIX is a suffix of STR.
604 Return zero if STR is null. */
605
606 static int
607 is_suffix (const char *str, const char *suffix)
608 {
609 int len1, len2;
610
611 if (str == NULL)
612 return 0;
613 len1 = strlen (str);
614 len2 = strlen (suffix);
615 return (len1 >= len2 && strcmp (str + len1 - len2, suffix) == 0);
616 }
617
618 /* The contents of value VAL, treated as a value of type TYPE. The
619 result is an lval in memory if VAL is. */
620
621 static struct value *
622 coerce_unspec_val_to_type (struct value *val, struct type *type)
623 {
624 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
625 if (value_type (val) == type)
626 return val;
627 else
628 {
629 struct value *result;
630
631 /* Make sure that the object size is not unreasonable before
632 trying to allocate some memory for it. */
633 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
634
635 if (value_lazy (val)
636 || TYPE_LENGTH (type) > TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)))
637 result = allocate_value_lazy (type);
638 else
639 {
640 result = allocate_value (type);
641 value_contents_copy_raw (result, 0, val, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
642 }
643 set_value_component_location (result, val);
644 set_value_bitsize (result, value_bitsize (val));
645 set_value_bitpos (result, value_bitpos (val));
646 if (VALUE_LVAL (result) == lval_memory)
647 set_value_address (result, value_address (val));
648 return result;
649 }
650 }
651
652 static const gdb_byte *
653 cond_offset_host (const gdb_byte *valaddr, long offset)
654 {
655 if (valaddr == NULL)
656 return NULL;
657 else
658 return valaddr + offset;
659 }
660
661 static CORE_ADDR
662 cond_offset_target (CORE_ADDR address, long offset)
663 {
664 if (address == 0)
665 return 0;
666 else
667 return address + offset;
668 }
669
670 /* Issue a warning (as for the definition of warning in utils.c, but
671 with exactly one argument rather than ...), unless the limit on the
672 number of warnings has passed during the evaluation of the current
673 expression. */
674
675 /* FIXME: cagney/2004-10-10: This function is mimicking the behavior
676 provided by "complaint". */
677 static void lim_warning (const char *format, ...) ATTRIBUTE_PRINTF (1, 2);
678
679 static void
680 lim_warning (const char *format, ...)
681 {
682 va_list args;
683
684 va_start (args, format);
685 warnings_issued += 1;
686 if (warnings_issued <= warning_limit)
687 vwarning (format, args);
688
689 va_end (args);
690 }
691
692 /* Issue an error if the size of an object of type T is unreasonable,
693 i.e. if it would be a bad idea to allocate a value of this type in
694 GDB. */
695
696 void
697 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (const struct type *type)
698 {
699 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) > varsize_limit)
700 error (_("object size is larger than varsize-limit"));
701 }
702
703 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
704 static LONGEST
705 max_of_size (int size)
706 {
707 LONGEST top_bit = (LONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 2);
708
709 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
710 }
711
712 /* Minimum value of a SIZE-byte signed integer type. */
713 static LONGEST
714 min_of_size (int size)
715 {
716 return -max_of_size (size) - 1;
717 }
718
719 /* Maximum value of a SIZE-byte unsigned integer type. */
720 static ULONGEST
721 umax_of_size (int size)
722 {
723 ULONGEST top_bit = (ULONGEST) 1 << (size * 8 - 1);
724
725 return top_bit | (top_bit - 1);
726 }
727
728 /* Maximum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
729 static LONGEST
730 max_of_type (struct type *t)
731 {
732 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
733 return (LONGEST) umax_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
734 else
735 return max_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
736 }
737
738 /* Minimum value of integral type T, as a signed quantity. */
739 static LONGEST
740 min_of_type (struct type *t)
741 {
742 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (t))
743 return 0;
744 else
745 return min_of_size (TYPE_LENGTH (t));
746 }
747
748 /* The largest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
749 LONGEST
750 ada_discrete_type_high_bound (struct type *type)
751 {
752 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, {}, 0);
753 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
754 {
755 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
756 return TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type);
757 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
758 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, TYPE_NFIELDS (type) - 1);
759 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
760 return 1;
761 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
762 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
763 return max_of_type (type);
764 default:
765 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_high_bound."));
766 }
767 }
768
769 /* The smallest value in the domain of TYPE, a discrete type, as an integer. */
770 LONGEST
771 ada_discrete_type_low_bound (struct type *type)
772 {
773 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, {}, 0);
774 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
775 {
776 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
777 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type);
778 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
779 return TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, 0);
780 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
781 return 0;
782 case TYPE_CODE_CHAR:
783 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
784 return min_of_type (type);
785 default:
786 error (_("Unexpected type in ada_discrete_type_low_bound."));
787 }
788 }
789
790 /* The identity on non-range types. For range types, the underlying
791 non-range scalar type. */
792
793 static struct type *
794 get_base_type (struct type *type)
795 {
796 while (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
797 {
798 if (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) || TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
799 return type;
800 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
801 }
802 return type;
803 }
804
805 /* Return a decoded version of the given VALUE. This means returning
806 a value whose type is obtained by applying all the GNAT-specific
807 encodings, making the resulting type a static but standard description
808 of the initial type. */
809
810 struct value *
811 ada_get_decoded_value (struct value *value)
812 {
813 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (value));
814
815 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type)
816 || (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type)
817 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR))
818 {
819 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF) /* array access type. */
820 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (value);
821 else
822 value = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (value);
823 }
824 else
825 value = ada_to_fixed_value (value);
826
827 return value;
828 }
829
830 /* Same as ada_get_decoded_value, but with the given TYPE.
831 Because there is no associated actual value for this type,
832 the resulting type might be a best-effort approximation in
833 the case of dynamic types. */
834
835 struct type *
836 ada_get_decoded_type (struct type *type)
837 {
838 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
839 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
840 type = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (type);
841 return type;
842 }
843
844 \f
845
846 /* Language Selection */
847
848 /* If the main program is in Ada, return language_ada, otherwise return LANG
849 (the main program is in Ada iif the adainit symbol is found). */
850
851 static enum language
852 ada_update_initial_language (enum language lang)
853 {
854 if (lookup_minimal_symbol ("adainit", NULL, NULL).minsym != NULL)
855 return language_ada;
856
857 return lang;
858 }
859
860 /* If the main procedure is written in Ada, then return its name.
861 The result is good until the next call. Return NULL if the main
862 procedure doesn't appear to be in Ada. */
863
864 char *
865 ada_main_name (void)
866 {
867 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
868 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> main_program_name;
869
870 /* For Ada, the name of the main procedure is stored in a specific
871 string constant, generated by the binder. Look for that symbol,
872 extract its address, and then read that string. If we didn't find
873 that string, then most probably the main procedure is not written
874 in Ada. */
875 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol (ADA_MAIN_PROGRAM_SYMBOL_NAME, NULL, NULL);
876
877 if (msym.minsym != NULL)
878 {
879 CORE_ADDR main_program_name_addr;
880 int err_code;
881
882 main_program_name_addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msym);
883 if (main_program_name_addr == 0)
884 error (_("Invalid address for Ada main program name."));
885
886 target_read_string (main_program_name_addr, &main_program_name,
887 1024, &err_code);
888
889 if (err_code != 0)
890 return NULL;
891 return main_program_name.get ();
892 }
893
894 /* The main procedure doesn't seem to be in Ada. */
895 return NULL;
896 }
897 \f
898 /* Symbols */
899
900 /* Table of Ada operators and their GNAT-encoded names. Last entry is pair
901 of NULLs. */
902
903 const struct ada_opname_map ada_opname_table[] = {
904 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", BINOP_ADD},
905 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", BINOP_SUB},
906 {"Omultiply", "\"*\"", BINOP_MUL},
907 {"Odivide", "\"/\"", BINOP_DIV},
908 {"Omod", "\"mod\"", BINOP_MOD},
909 {"Orem", "\"rem\"", BINOP_REM},
910 {"Oexpon", "\"**\"", BINOP_EXP},
911 {"Olt", "\"<\"", BINOP_LESS},
912 {"Ole", "\"<=\"", BINOP_LEQ},
913 {"Ogt", "\">\"", BINOP_GTR},
914 {"Oge", "\">=\"", BINOP_GEQ},
915 {"Oeq", "\"=\"", BINOP_EQUAL},
916 {"One", "\"/=\"", BINOP_NOTEQUAL},
917 {"Oand", "\"and\"", BINOP_BITWISE_AND},
918 {"Oor", "\"or\"", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR},
919 {"Oxor", "\"xor\"", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR},
920 {"Oconcat", "\"&\"", BINOP_CONCAT},
921 {"Oabs", "\"abs\"", UNOP_ABS},
922 {"Onot", "\"not\"", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT},
923 {"Oadd", "\"+\"", UNOP_PLUS},
924 {"Osubtract", "\"-\"", UNOP_NEG},
925 {NULL, NULL}
926 };
927
928 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions. The
929 result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. If
930 THROW_ERRORS, throw an error if invalid operator name is found.
931 Otherwise, return NULL in that case. */
932
933 static char *
934 ada_encode_1 (const char *decoded, bool throw_errors)
935 {
936 static char *encoding_buffer = NULL;
937 static size_t encoding_buffer_size = 0;
938 const char *p;
939 int k;
940
941 if (decoded == NULL)
942 return NULL;
943
944 GROW_VECT (encoding_buffer, encoding_buffer_size,
945 2 * strlen (decoded) + 10);
946
947 k = 0;
948 for (p = decoded; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
949 {
950 if (*p == '.')
951 {
952 encoding_buffer[k] = encoding_buffer[k + 1] = '_';
953 k += 2;
954 }
955 else if (*p == '"')
956 {
957 const struct ada_opname_map *mapping;
958
959 for (mapping = ada_opname_table;
960 mapping->encoded != NULL
961 && !startswith (p, mapping->decoded); mapping += 1)
962 ;
963 if (mapping->encoded == NULL)
964 {
965 if (throw_errors)
966 error (_("invalid Ada operator name: %s"), p);
967 else
968 return NULL;
969 }
970 strcpy (encoding_buffer + k, mapping->encoded);
971 k += strlen (mapping->encoded);
972 break;
973 }
974 else
975 {
976 encoding_buffer[k] = *p;
977 k += 1;
978 }
979 }
980
981 encoding_buffer[k] = '\0';
982 return encoding_buffer;
983 }
984
985 /* The "encoded" form of DECODED, according to GNAT conventions.
986 The result is valid until the next call to ada_encode. */
987
988 char *
989 ada_encode (const char *decoded)
990 {
991 return ada_encode_1 (decoded, true);
992 }
993
994 /* Return NAME folded to lower case, or, if surrounded by single
995 quotes, unfolded, but with the quotes stripped away. Result good
996 to next call. */
997
998 static char *
999 ada_fold_name (gdb::string_view name)
1000 {
1001 static char *fold_buffer = NULL;
1002 static size_t fold_buffer_size = 0;
1003
1004 int len = name.size ();
1005 GROW_VECT (fold_buffer, fold_buffer_size, len + 1);
1006
1007 if (name[0] == '\'')
1008 {
1009 strncpy (fold_buffer, name.data () + 1, len - 2);
1010 fold_buffer[len - 2] = '\000';
1011 }
1012 else
1013 {
1014 int i;
1015
1016 for (i = 0; i <= len; i += 1)
1017 fold_buffer[i] = tolower (name[i]);
1018 }
1019
1020 return fold_buffer;
1021 }
1022
1023 /* Return nonzero if C is either a digit or a lowercase alphabet character. */
1024
1025 static int
1026 is_lower_alphanum (const char c)
1027 {
1028 return (isdigit (c) || (isalpha (c) && islower (c)));
1029 }
1030
1031 /* ENCODED is the linkage name of a symbol and LEN contains its length.
1032 This function saves in LEN the length of that same symbol name but
1033 without either of these suffixes:
1034 . .{DIGIT}+
1035 . ${DIGIT}+
1036 . ___{DIGIT}+
1037 . __{DIGIT}+.
1038
1039 These are suffixes introduced by the compiler for entities such as
1040 nested subprogram for instance, in order to avoid name clashes.
1041 They do not serve any purpose for the debugger. */
1042
1043 static void
1044 ada_remove_trailing_digits (const char *encoded, int *len)
1045 {
1046 if (*len > 1 && isdigit (encoded[*len - 1]))
1047 {
1048 int i = *len - 2;
1049
1050 while (i > 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1051 i--;
1052 if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '.')
1053 *len = i;
1054 else if (i >= 0 && encoded[i] == '$')
1055 *len = i;
1056 else if (i >= 2 && startswith (encoded + i - 2, "___"))
1057 *len = i - 2;
1058 else if (i >= 1 && startswith (encoded + i - 1, "__"))
1059 *len = i - 1;
1060 }
1061 }
1062
1063 /* Remove the suffix introduced by the compiler for protected object
1064 subprograms. */
1065
1066 static void
1067 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (const char *encoded, int *len)
1068 {
1069 /* Remove trailing N. */
1070
1071 /* Protected entry subprograms are broken into two
1072 separate subprograms: The first one is unprotected, and has
1073 a 'N' suffix; the second is the protected version, and has
1074 the 'P' suffix. The second calls the first one after handling
1075 the protection. Since the P subprograms are internally generated,
1076 we leave these names undecoded, giving the user a clue that this
1077 entity is internal. */
1078
1079 if (*len > 1
1080 && encoded[*len - 1] == 'N'
1081 && (isdigit (encoded[*len - 2]) || islower (encoded[*len - 2])))
1082 *len = *len - 1;
1083 }
1084
1085 /* If ENCODED follows the GNAT entity encoding conventions, then return
1086 the decoded form of ENCODED. Otherwise, return "<%s>" where "%s" is
1087 replaced by ENCODED. */
1088
1089 std::string
1090 ada_decode (const char *encoded)
1091 {
1092 int i, j;
1093 int len0;
1094 const char *p;
1095 int at_start_name;
1096 std::string decoded;
1097
1098 /* With function descriptors on PPC64, the value of a symbol named
1099 ".FN", if it exists, is the entry point of the function "FN". */
1100 if (encoded[0] == '.')
1101 encoded += 1;
1102
1103 /* The name of the Ada main procedure starts with "_ada_".
1104 This prefix is not part of the decoded name, so skip this part
1105 if we see this prefix. */
1106 if (startswith (encoded, "_ada_"))
1107 encoded += 5;
1108
1109 /* If the name starts with '_', then it is not a properly encoded
1110 name, so do not attempt to decode it. Similarly, if the name
1111 starts with '<', the name should not be decoded. */
1112 if (encoded[0] == '_' || encoded[0] == '<')
1113 goto Suppress;
1114
1115 len0 = strlen (encoded);
1116
1117 ada_remove_trailing_digits (encoded, &len0);
1118 ada_remove_po_subprogram_suffix (encoded, &len0);
1119
1120 /* Remove the ___X.* suffix if present. Do not forget to verify that
1121 the suffix is located before the current "end" of ENCODED. We want
1122 to avoid re-matching parts of ENCODED that have previously been
1123 marked as discarded (by decrementing LEN0). */
1124 p = strstr (encoded, "___");
1125 if (p != NULL && p - encoded < len0 - 3)
1126 {
1127 if (p[3] == 'X')
1128 len0 = p - encoded;
1129 else
1130 goto Suppress;
1131 }
1132
1133 /* Remove any trailing TKB suffix. It tells us that this symbol
1134 is for the body of a task, but that information does not actually
1135 appear in the decoded name. */
1136
1137 if (len0 > 3 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 3, "TKB"))
1138 len0 -= 3;
1139
1140 /* Remove any trailing TB suffix. The TB suffix is slightly different
1141 from the TKB suffix because it is used for non-anonymous task
1142 bodies. */
1143
1144 if (len0 > 2 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 2, "TB"))
1145 len0 -= 2;
1146
1147 /* Remove trailing "B" suffixes. */
1148 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-04-19: Not sure what this are used for... */
1149
1150 if (len0 > 1 && startswith (encoded + len0 - 1, "B"))
1151 len0 -= 1;
1152
1153 /* Make decoded big enough for possible expansion by operator name. */
1154
1155 decoded.resize (2 * len0 + 1, 'X');
1156
1157 /* Remove trailing __{digit}+ or trailing ${digit}+. */
1158
1159 if (len0 > 1 && isdigit (encoded[len0 - 1]))
1160 {
1161 i = len0 - 2;
1162 while ((i >= 0 && isdigit (encoded[i]))
1163 || (i >= 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && isdigit (encoded[i - 1])))
1164 i -= 1;
1165 if (i > 1 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i - 1] == '_')
1166 len0 = i - 1;
1167 else if (encoded[i] == '$')
1168 len0 = i;
1169 }
1170
1171 /* The first few characters that are not alphabetic are not part
1172 of any encoding we use, so we can copy them over verbatim. */
1173
1174 for (i = 0, j = 0; i < len0 && !isalpha (encoded[i]); i += 1, j += 1)
1175 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1176
1177 at_start_name = 1;
1178 while (i < len0)
1179 {
1180 /* Is this a symbol function? */
1181 if (at_start_name && encoded[i] == 'O')
1182 {
1183 int k;
1184
1185 for (k = 0; ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL; k += 1)
1186 {
1187 int op_len = strlen (ada_opname_table[k].encoded);
1188 if ((strncmp (ada_opname_table[k].encoded + 1, encoded + i + 1,
1189 op_len - 1) == 0)
1190 && !isalnum (encoded[i + op_len]))
1191 {
1192 strcpy (&decoded.front() + j, ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1193 at_start_name = 0;
1194 i += op_len;
1195 j += strlen (ada_opname_table[k].decoded);
1196 break;
1197 }
1198 }
1199 if (ada_opname_table[k].encoded != NULL)
1200 continue;
1201 }
1202 at_start_name = 0;
1203
1204 /* Replace "TK__" with "__", which will eventually be translated
1205 into "." (just below). */
1206
1207 if (i < len0 - 4 && startswith (encoded + i, "TK__"))
1208 i += 2;
1209
1210 /* Replace "__B_{DIGITS}+__" sequences by "__", which will eventually
1211 be translated into "." (just below). These are internal names
1212 generated for anonymous blocks inside which our symbol is nested. */
1213
1214 if (len0 - i > 5 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded [i+1] == '_'
1215 && encoded [i+2] == 'B' && encoded [i+3] == '_'
1216 && isdigit (encoded [i+4]))
1217 {
1218 int k = i + 5;
1219
1220 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1221 k++; /* Skip any extra digit. */
1222
1223 /* Double-check that the "__B_{DIGITS}+" sequence we found
1224 is indeed followed by "__". */
1225 if (len0 - k > 2 && encoded [k] == '_' && encoded [k+1] == '_')
1226 i = k;
1227 }
1228
1229 /* Remove _E{DIGITS}+[sb] */
1230
1231 /* Just as for protected object subprograms, there are 2 categories
1232 of subprograms created by the compiler for each entry. The first
1233 one implements the actual entry code, and has a suffix following
1234 the convention above; the second one implements the barrier and
1235 uses the same convention as above, except that the 'E' is replaced
1236 by a 'B'.
1237
1238 Just as above, we do not decode the name of barrier functions
1239 to give the user a clue that the code he is debugging has been
1240 internally generated. */
1241
1242 if (len0 - i > 3 && encoded [i] == '_' && encoded[i+1] == 'E'
1243 && isdigit (encoded[i+2]))
1244 {
1245 int k = i + 3;
1246
1247 while (k < len0 && isdigit (encoded[k]))
1248 k++;
1249
1250 if (k < len0
1251 && (encoded[k] == 'b' || encoded[k] == 's'))
1252 {
1253 k++;
1254 /* Just as an extra precaution, make sure that if this
1255 suffix is followed by anything else, it is a '_'.
1256 Otherwise, we matched this sequence by accident. */
1257 if (k == len0
1258 || (k < len0 && encoded[k] == '_'))
1259 i = k;
1260 }
1261 }
1262
1263 /* Remove trailing "N" in [a-z0-9]+N__. The N is added by
1264 the GNAT front-end in protected object subprograms. */
1265
1266 if (i < len0 + 3
1267 && encoded[i] == 'N' && encoded[i+1] == '_' && encoded[i+2] == '_')
1268 {
1269 /* Backtrack a bit up until we reach either the begining of
1270 the encoded name, or "__". Make sure that we only find
1271 digits or lowercase characters. */
1272 const char *ptr = encoded + i - 1;
1273
1274 while (ptr >= encoded && is_lower_alphanum (ptr[0]))
1275 ptr--;
1276 if (ptr < encoded
1277 || (ptr > encoded && ptr[0] == '_' && ptr[-1] == '_'))
1278 i++;
1279 }
1280
1281 if (encoded[i] == 'X' && i != 0 && isalnum (encoded[i - 1]))
1282 {
1283 /* This is a X[bn]* sequence not separated from the previous
1284 part of the name with a non-alpha-numeric character (in other
1285 words, immediately following an alpha-numeric character), then
1286 verify that it is placed at the end of the encoded name. If
1287 not, then the encoding is not valid and we should abort the
1288 decoding. Otherwise, just skip it, it is used in body-nested
1289 package names. */
1290 do
1291 i += 1;
1292 while (i < len0 && (encoded[i] == 'b' || encoded[i] == 'n'));
1293 if (i < len0)
1294 goto Suppress;
1295 }
1296 else if (i < len0 - 2 && encoded[i] == '_' && encoded[i + 1] == '_')
1297 {
1298 /* Replace '__' by '.'. */
1299 decoded[j] = '.';
1300 at_start_name = 1;
1301 i += 2;
1302 j += 1;
1303 }
1304 else
1305 {
1306 /* It's a character part of the decoded name, so just copy it
1307 over. */
1308 decoded[j] = encoded[i];
1309 i += 1;
1310 j += 1;
1311 }
1312 }
1313 decoded.resize (j);
1314
1315 /* Decoded names should never contain any uppercase character.
1316 Double-check this, and abort the decoding if we find one. */
1317
1318 for (i = 0; i < decoded.length(); ++i)
1319 if (isupper (decoded[i]) || decoded[i] == ' ')
1320 goto Suppress;
1321
1322 return decoded;
1323
1324 Suppress:
1325 if (encoded[0] == '<')
1326 decoded = encoded;
1327 else
1328 decoded = '<' + std::string(encoded) + '>';
1329 return decoded;
1330
1331 }
1332
1333 /* Table for keeping permanent unique copies of decoded names. Once
1334 allocated, names in this table are never released. While this is a
1335 storage leak, it should not be significant unless there are massive
1336 changes in the set of decoded names in successive versions of a
1337 symbol table loaded during a single session. */
1338 static struct htab *decoded_names_store;
1339
1340 /* Returns the decoded name of GSYMBOL, as for ada_decode, caching it
1341 in the language-specific part of GSYMBOL, if it has not been
1342 previously computed. Tries to save the decoded name in the same
1343 obstack as GSYMBOL, if possible, and otherwise on the heap (so that,
1344 in any case, the decoded symbol has a lifetime at least that of
1345 GSYMBOL).
1346 The GSYMBOL parameter is "mutable" in the C++ sense: logically
1347 const, but nevertheless modified to a semantically equivalent form
1348 when a decoded name is cached in it. */
1349
1350 const char *
1351 ada_decode_symbol (const struct general_symbol_info *arg)
1352 {
1353 struct general_symbol_info *gsymbol = (struct general_symbol_info *) arg;
1354 const char **resultp =
1355 &gsymbol->language_specific.demangled_name;
1356
1357 if (!gsymbol->ada_mangled)
1358 {
1359 std::string decoded = ada_decode (gsymbol->linkage_name ());
1360 struct obstack *obstack = gsymbol->language_specific.obstack;
1361
1362 gsymbol->ada_mangled = 1;
1363
1364 if (obstack != NULL)
1365 *resultp = obstack_strdup (obstack, decoded.c_str ());
1366 else
1367 {
1368 /* Sometimes, we can't find a corresponding objfile, in
1369 which case, we put the result on the heap. Since we only
1370 decode when needed, we hope this usually does not cause a
1371 significant memory leak (FIXME). */
1372
1373 char **slot = (char **) htab_find_slot (decoded_names_store,
1374 decoded.c_str (), INSERT);
1375
1376 if (*slot == NULL)
1377 *slot = xstrdup (decoded.c_str ());
1378 *resultp = *slot;
1379 }
1380 }
1381
1382 return *resultp;
1383 }
1384
1385 static char *
1386 ada_la_decode (const char *encoded, int options)
1387 {
1388 return xstrdup (ada_decode (encoded).c_str ());
1389 }
1390
1391 /* Implement la_sniff_from_mangled_name for Ada. */
1392
1393 static int
1394 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name (const char *mangled, char **out)
1395 {
1396 std::string demangled = ada_decode (mangled);
1397
1398 *out = NULL;
1399
1400 if (demangled != mangled && demangled[0] != '<')
1401 {
1402 /* Set the gsymbol language to Ada, but still return 0.
1403 Two reasons for that:
1404
1405 1. For Ada, we prefer computing the symbol's decoded name
1406 on the fly rather than pre-compute it, in order to save
1407 memory (Ada projects are typically very large).
1408
1409 2. There are some areas in the definition of the GNAT
1410 encoding where, with a bit of bad luck, we might be able
1411 to decode a non-Ada symbol, generating an incorrect
1412 demangled name (Eg: names ending with "TB" for instance
1413 are identified as task bodies and so stripped from
1414 the decoded name returned).
1415
1416 Returning 1, here, but not setting *DEMANGLED, helps us get a
1417 little bit of the best of both worlds. Because we're last,
1418 we should not affect any of the other languages that were
1419 able to demangle the symbol before us; we get to correctly
1420 tag Ada symbols as such; and even if we incorrectly tagged a
1421 non-Ada symbol, which should be rare, any routing through the
1422 Ada language should be transparent (Ada tries to behave much
1423 like C/C++ with non-Ada symbols). */
1424 return 1;
1425 }
1426
1427 return 0;
1428 }
1429
1430 \f
1431
1432 /* Arrays */
1433
1434 /* Assuming that INDEX_DESC_TYPE is an ___XA structure, a structure
1435 generated by the GNAT compiler to describe the index type used
1436 for each dimension of an array, check whether it follows the latest
1437 known encoding. If not, fix it up to conform to the latest encoding.
1438 Otherwise, do nothing. This function also does nothing if
1439 INDEX_DESC_TYPE is NULL.
1440
1441 The GNAT encoding used to describe the array index type evolved a bit.
1442 Initially, the information would be provided through the name of each
1443 field of the structure type only, while the type of these fields was
1444 described as unspecified and irrelevant. The debugger was then expected
1445 to perform a global type lookup using the name of that field in order
1446 to get access to the full index type description. Because these global
1447 lookups can be very expensive, the encoding was later enhanced to make
1448 the global lookup unnecessary by defining the field type as being
1449 the full index type description.
1450
1451 The purpose of this routine is to allow us to support older versions
1452 of the compiler by detecting the use of the older encoding, and by
1453 fixing up the INDEX_DESC_TYPE to follow the new one (at this point,
1454 we essentially replace each field's meaningless type by the associated
1455 index subtype). */
1456
1457 void
1458 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (struct type *index_desc_type)
1459 {
1460 int i;
1461
1462 if (index_desc_type == NULL)
1463 return;
1464 gdb_assert (TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type) > 0);
1465
1466 /* Check if INDEX_DESC_TYPE follows the older encoding (it is sufficient
1467 to check one field only, no need to check them all). If not, return
1468 now.
1469
1470 If our INDEX_DESC_TYPE was generated using the older encoding,
1471 the field type should be a meaningless integer type whose name
1472 is not equal to the field name. */
1473 if (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)) != NULL
1474 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, 0)),
1475 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, 0)) == 0)
1476 return;
1477
1478 /* Fixup each field of INDEX_DESC_TYPE. */
1479 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (index_desc_type); i++)
1480 {
1481 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (index_desc_type, i);
1482 struct type *raw_type = ada_check_typedef (ada_find_any_type (name));
1483
1484 if (raw_type)
1485 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_desc_type, i) = raw_type;
1486 }
1487 }
1488
1489 /* Names of MAX_ADA_DIMENS bounds in P_BOUNDS fields of array descriptors. */
1490
1491 static const char *bound_name[] = {
1492 "LB0", "UB0", "LB1", "UB1", "LB2", "UB2", "LB3", "UB3",
1493 "LB4", "UB4", "LB5", "UB5", "LB6", "UB6", "LB7", "UB7"
1494 };
1495
1496 /* Maximum number of array dimensions we are prepared to handle. */
1497
1498 #define MAX_ADA_DIMENS (sizeof(bound_name) / (2*sizeof(char *)))
1499
1500
1501 /* The desc_* routines return primitive portions of array descriptors
1502 (fat pointers). */
1503
1504 /* The descriptor or array type, if any, indicated by TYPE; removes
1505 level of indirection, if needed. */
1506
1507 static struct type *
1508 desc_base_type (struct type *type)
1509 {
1510 if (type == NULL)
1511 return NULL;
1512 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1513 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
1514 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
1515
1516 if (type != NULL
1517 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1518 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1519 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
1520 else
1521 return type;
1522 }
1523
1524 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thin" array pointer type. */
1525
1526 static int
1527 is_thin_pntr (struct type *type)
1528 {
1529 return
1530 is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT")
1531 || is_suffix (ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type)), "___XUT___XVE");
1532 }
1533
1534 /* The descriptor type for thin pointer type TYPE. */
1535
1536 static struct type *
1537 thin_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1538 {
1539 struct type *base_type = desc_base_type (type);
1540
1541 if (base_type == NULL)
1542 return NULL;
1543 if (is_suffix (ada_type_name (base_type), "___XVE"))
1544 return base_type;
1545 else
1546 {
1547 struct type *alt_type = ada_find_parallel_type (base_type, "___XVE");
1548
1549 if (alt_type == NULL)
1550 return base_type;
1551 else
1552 return alt_type;
1553 }
1554 }
1555
1556 /* A pointer to the array data for thin-pointer value VAL. */
1557
1558 static struct value *
1559 thin_data_pntr (struct value *val)
1560 {
1561 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
1562 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1563
1564 data_type = lookup_pointer_type (data_type);
1565
1566 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1567 return value_cast (data_type, value_copy (val));
1568 else
1569 return value_from_longest (data_type, value_address (val));
1570 }
1571
1572 /* True iff TYPE indicates a "thick" array pointer type. */
1573
1574 static int
1575 is_thick_pntr (struct type *type)
1576 {
1577 type = desc_base_type (type);
1578 return (type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1579 && lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL);
1580 }
1581
1582 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1583 pointer to one, the type of its bounds data; otherwise, NULL. */
1584
1585 static struct type *
1586 desc_bounds_type (struct type *type)
1587 {
1588 struct type *r;
1589
1590 type = desc_base_type (type);
1591
1592 if (type == NULL)
1593 return NULL;
1594 else if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1595 {
1596 type = thin_descriptor_type (type);
1597 if (type == NULL)
1598 return NULL;
1599 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "BOUNDS", 1);
1600 if (r != NULL)
1601 return ada_check_typedef (r);
1602 }
1603 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1604 {
1605 r = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1);
1606 if (r != NULL)
1607 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (r)));
1608 }
1609 return NULL;
1610 }
1611
1612 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), or pointer to
1613 one, a pointer to its bounds data. Otherwise NULL. */
1614
1615 static struct value *
1616 desc_bounds (struct value *arr)
1617 {
1618 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1619
1620 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1621 {
1622 struct type *bounds_type =
1623 desc_bounds_type (thin_descriptor_type (type));
1624 LONGEST addr;
1625
1626 if (bounds_type == NULL)
1627 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1628
1629 /* NOTE: The following calculation is not really kosher, but
1630 since desc_type is an XVE-encoded type (and shouldn't be),
1631 the correct calculation is a real pain. FIXME (and fix GCC). */
1632 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1633 addr = value_as_long (arr);
1634 else
1635 addr = value_address (arr);
1636
1637 return
1638 value_from_longest (lookup_pointer_type (bounds_type),
1639 addr - TYPE_LENGTH (bounds_type));
1640 }
1641
1642 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1643 {
1644 struct value *p_bounds = value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_BOUNDS", NULL,
1645 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1646 struct type *p_bounds_type = value_type (p_bounds);
1647
1648 if (p_bounds_type
1649 && TYPE_CODE (p_bounds_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1650 {
1651 struct type *target_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_bounds_type);
1652
1653 if (TYPE_STUB (target_type))
1654 p_bounds = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type
1655 (ada_check_typedef (target_type)),
1656 p_bounds);
1657 }
1658 else
1659 error (_("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1660
1661 return p_bounds;
1662 }
1663 else
1664 return NULL;
1665 }
1666
1667 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1668 position of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1669
1670 static int
1671 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (struct type *type)
1672 {
1673 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 1);
1674 }
1675
1676 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1677 size of the field containing the address of the bounds data. */
1678
1679 static int
1680 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (struct type *type)
1681 {
1682 type = desc_base_type (type);
1683
1684 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1) > 0)
1685 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 1);
1686 else
1687 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 1)));
1688 }
1689
1690 /* If TYPE is the type of an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer) or a
1691 pointer to one, the type of its array data (a array-with-no-bounds type);
1692 otherwise, NULL. Use ada_type_of_array to get an array type with bounds
1693 data. */
1694
1695 static struct type *
1696 desc_data_target_type (struct type *type)
1697 {
1698 type = desc_base_type (type);
1699
1700 /* NOTE: The following is bogus; see comment in desc_bounds. */
1701 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1702 return desc_base_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (thin_descriptor_type (type), 1));
1703 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1704 {
1705 struct type *data_type = lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1);
1706
1707 if (data_type
1708 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (data_type)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
1709 return ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (data_type));
1710 }
1711
1712 return NULL;
1713 }
1714
1715 /* If ARR is an array descriptor (fat or thin pointer), a pointer to
1716 its array data. */
1717
1718 static struct value *
1719 desc_data (struct value *arr)
1720 {
1721 struct type *type = value_type (arr);
1722
1723 if (is_thin_pntr (type))
1724 return thin_data_pntr (arr);
1725 else if (is_thick_pntr (type))
1726 return value_struct_elt (&arr, NULL, "P_ARRAY", NULL,
1727 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor"));
1728 else
1729 return NULL;
1730 }
1731
1732
1733 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1734 position of the field containing the address of the data. */
1735
1736 static int
1737 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (struct type *type)
1738 {
1739 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 0);
1740 }
1741
1742 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-descriptor (fat pointer), the bit
1743 size of the field containing the address of the data. */
1744
1745 static int
1746 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (struct type *type)
1747 {
1748 type = desc_base_type (type);
1749
1750 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
1751 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0);
1752 else
1753 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
1754 }
1755
1756 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure (or pointer to one), return
1757 the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1758 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1759
1760 static struct value *
1761 desc_one_bound (struct value *bounds, int i, int which)
1762 {
1763 return value_struct_elt (&bounds, NULL, bound_name[2 * i + which - 2], NULL,
1764 _("Bad GNAT array descriptor bounds"));
1765 }
1766
1767 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit position
1768 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1769 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1770
1771 static int
1772 desc_bound_bitpos (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1773 {
1774 return TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (desc_base_type (type), 2 * i + which - 2);
1775 }
1776
1777 /* If BOUNDS is an array-bounds structure type, return the bit field size
1778 of the Ith lower bound stored in it, if WHICH is 0, and the Ith upper
1779 bound, if WHICH is 1. The first bound is I=1. */
1780
1781 static int
1782 desc_bound_bitsize (struct type *type, int i, int which)
1783 {
1784 type = desc_base_type (type);
1785
1786 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2) > 0)
1787 return TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 2 * i + which - 2);
1788 else
1789 return 8 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 2 * i + which - 2));
1790 }
1791
1792 /* If TYPE is the type of an array-bounds structure, the type of its
1793 Ith bound (numbering from 1). Otherwise, NULL. */
1794
1795 static struct type *
1796 desc_index_type (struct type *type, int i)
1797 {
1798 type = desc_base_type (type);
1799
1800 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
1801 return lookup_struct_elt_type (type, bound_name[2 * i - 2], 1);
1802 else
1803 return NULL;
1804 }
1805
1806 /* The number of index positions in the array-bounds type TYPE.
1807 Return 0 if TYPE is NULL. */
1808
1809 static int
1810 desc_arity (struct type *type)
1811 {
1812 type = desc_base_type (type);
1813
1814 if (type != NULL)
1815 return TYPE_NFIELDS (type) / 2;
1816 return 0;
1817 }
1818
1819 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type (not a pointer to one) or
1820 an array descriptor type (representing an unconstrained array
1821 type). */
1822
1823 static int
1824 ada_is_direct_array_type (struct type *type)
1825 {
1826 if (type == NULL)
1827 return 0;
1828 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1829 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1830 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type));
1831 }
1832
1833 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents any kind of array in Ada, or a pointer
1834 * to one. */
1835
1836 static int
1837 ada_is_array_type (struct type *type)
1838 {
1839 while (type != NULL
1840 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1841 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF))
1842 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
1843 return ada_is_direct_array_type (type);
1844 }
1845
1846 /* Non-zero iff TYPE is a simple array type or pointer to one. */
1847
1848 int
1849 ada_is_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
1850 {
1851 if (type == NULL)
1852 return 0;
1853 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1854 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1855 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
1856 && TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
1857 == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY));
1858 }
1859
1860 /* Non-zero iff TYPE belongs to a GNAT array descriptor. */
1861
1862 int
1863 ada_is_array_descriptor_type (struct type *type)
1864 {
1865 struct type *data_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
1866
1867 if (type == NULL)
1868 return 0;
1869 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
1870 return (data_type != NULL
1871 && TYPE_CODE (data_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
1872 && desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type)) > 0);
1873 }
1874
1875 /* Non-zero iff type is a partially mal-formed GNAT array
1876 descriptor. FIXME: This is to compensate for some problems with
1877 debugging output from GNAT. Re-examine periodically to see if it
1878 is still needed. */
1879
1880 int
1881 ada_is_bogus_array_descriptor (struct type *type)
1882 {
1883 return
1884 type != NULL
1885 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1886 && (lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_BOUNDS", 1) != NULL
1887 || lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "P_ARRAY", 1) != NULL)
1888 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
1889 }
1890
1891
1892 /* If ARR has a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array descriptor,
1893 (fat pointer) returns the type of the array data described---specifically,
1894 a pointer-to-array type. If BOUNDS is non-zero, the bounds data are filled
1895 in from the descriptor; otherwise, they are left unspecified. If
1896 the ARR denotes a null array descriptor and BOUNDS is non-zero,
1897 returns NULL. The result is simply the type of ARR if ARR is not
1898 a descriptor. */
1899
1900 static struct type *
1901 ada_type_of_array (struct value *arr, int bounds)
1902 {
1903 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1904 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
1905
1906 if (!ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1907 return value_type (arr);
1908
1909 if (!bounds)
1910 {
1911 struct type *array_type =
1912 ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (value_type (arr)));
1913
1914 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1915 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (array_type, 0) =
1916 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1917
1918 return array_type;
1919 }
1920 else
1921 {
1922 struct type *elt_type;
1923 int arity;
1924 struct value *descriptor;
1925
1926 elt_type = ada_array_element_type (value_type (arr), -1);
1927 arity = ada_array_arity (value_type (arr));
1928
1929 if (elt_type == NULL || arity == 0)
1930 return ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
1931
1932 descriptor = desc_bounds (arr);
1933 if (value_as_long (descriptor) == 0)
1934 return NULL;
1935 while (arity > 0)
1936 {
1937 struct type *range_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1938 struct type *array_type = alloc_type_copy (value_type (arr));
1939 struct value *low = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 0);
1940 struct value *high = desc_one_bound (descriptor, arity, 1);
1941
1942 arity -= 1;
1943 create_static_range_type (range_type, value_type (low),
1944 longest_to_int (value_as_long (low)),
1945 longest_to_int (value_as_long (high)));
1946 elt_type = create_array_type (array_type, elt_type, range_type);
1947
1948 if (ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1949 {
1950 /* We need to store the element packed bitsize, as well as
1951 recompute the array size, because it was previously
1952 computed based on the unpacked element size. */
1953 LONGEST lo = value_as_long (low);
1954 LONGEST hi = value_as_long (high);
1955
1956 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) =
1957 decode_packed_array_bitsize (value_type (arr));
1958 /* If the array has no element, then the size is already
1959 zero, and does not need to be recomputed. */
1960 if (lo < hi)
1961 {
1962 int array_bitsize =
1963 (hi - lo + 1) * TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
1964
1965 TYPE_LENGTH (array_type) = (array_bitsize + 7) / 8;
1966 }
1967 }
1968 }
1969
1970 return lookup_pointer_type (elt_type);
1971 }
1972 }
1973
1974 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1975 Otherwise, returns either a standard GDB array with bounds set
1976 appropriately or, if ARR is a non-null fat pointer, a pointer to a standard
1977 GDB array. Returns NULL if ARR is a null fat pointer. */
1978
1979 struct value *
1980 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (struct value *arr)
1981 {
1982 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
1983 {
1984 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arr, 1);
1985
1986 if (arrType == NULL)
1987 return NULL;
1988 return value_cast (arrType, value_copy (desc_data (arr)));
1989 }
1990 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
1991 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
1992 else
1993 return arr;
1994 }
1995
1996 /* If ARR does not represent an array, returns ARR unchanged.
1997 Otherwise, returns a standard GDB array describing ARR (which may
1998 be ARR itself if it already is in the proper form). */
1999
2000 struct value *
2001 ada_coerce_to_simple_array (struct value *arr)
2002 {
2003 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (value_type (arr)))
2004 {
2005 struct value *arrVal = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (arr);
2006
2007 if (arrVal == NULL)
2008 error (_("Bounds unavailable for null array pointer."));
2009 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (arrVal)));
2010 return value_ind (arrVal);
2011 }
2012 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr)))
2013 return decode_constrained_packed_array (arr);
2014 else
2015 return arr;
2016 }
2017
2018 /* If TYPE represents a GNAT array type, return it translated to an
2019 ordinary GDB array type (possibly with BITSIZE fields indicating
2020 packing). For other types, is the identity. */
2021
2022 struct type *
2023 ada_coerce_to_simple_array_type (struct type *type)
2024 {
2025 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
2026 return decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type);
2027
2028 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
2029 return ada_check_typedef (desc_data_target_type (type));
2030
2031 return type;
2032 }
2033
2034 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT packed-array type. */
2035
2036 static int
2037 ada_is_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2038 {
2039 if (type == NULL)
2040 return 0;
2041 type = desc_base_type (type);
2042 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2043 return
2044 ada_type_name (type) != NULL
2045 && strstr (ada_type_name (type), "___XP") != NULL;
2046 }
2047
2048 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents a standard GNAT constrained
2049 packed-array type. */
2050
2051 int
2052 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2053 {
2054 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2055 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2056 }
2057
2058 /* Non-zero iff TYPE represents an array descriptor for a
2059 unconstrained packed-array type. */
2060
2061 static int
2062 ada_is_unconstrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2063 {
2064 return ada_is_packed_array_type (type)
2065 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type);
2066 }
2067
2068 /* Given that TYPE encodes a packed array type (constrained or unconstrained),
2069 return the size of its elements in bits. */
2070
2071 static long
2072 decode_packed_array_bitsize (struct type *type)
2073 {
2074 const char *raw_name;
2075 const char *tail;
2076 long bits;
2077
2078 /* Access to arrays implemented as fat pointers are encoded as a typedef
2079 of the fat pointer type. We need the name of the fat pointer type
2080 to do the decoding, so strip the typedef layer. */
2081 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2082 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
2083
2084 raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2085 if (!raw_name)
2086 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2087
2088 if (!raw_name)
2089 return 0;
2090
2091 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2092 gdb_assert (tail != NULL);
2093
2094 if (sscanf (tail + sizeof ("___XP") - 1, "%ld", &bits) != 1)
2095 {
2096 lim_warning
2097 (_("could not understand bit size information on packed array"));
2098 return 0;
2099 }
2100
2101 return bits;
2102 }
2103
2104 /* Given that TYPE is a standard GDB array type with all bounds filled
2105 in, and that the element size of its ultimate scalar constituents
2106 (that is, either its elements, or, if it is an array of arrays, its
2107 elements' elements, etc.) is *ELT_BITS, return an identical type,
2108 but with the bit sizes of its elements (and those of any
2109 constituent arrays) recorded in the BITSIZE components of its
2110 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE values, and with *ELT_BITS set to its total size
2111 in bits.
2112
2113 Note that, for arrays whose index type has an XA encoding where
2114 a bound references a record discriminant, getting that discriminant,
2115 and therefore the actual value of that bound, is not possible
2116 because none of the given parameters gives us access to the record.
2117 This function assumes that it is OK in the context where it is being
2118 used to return an array whose bounds are still dynamic and where
2119 the length is arbitrary. */
2120
2121 static struct type *
2122 constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type, long *elt_bits)
2123 {
2124 struct type *new_elt_type;
2125 struct type *new_type;
2126 struct type *index_type_desc;
2127 struct type *index_type;
2128 LONGEST low_bound, high_bound;
2129
2130 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2131 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2132 return type;
2133
2134 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
2135 if (index_type_desc)
2136 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, 0),
2137 NULL);
2138 else
2139 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type);
2140
2141 new_type = alloc_type_copy (type);
2142 new_elt_type =
2143 constrained_packed_array_type (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2144 elt_bits);
2145 create_array_type (new_type, new_elt_type, index_type);
2146 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (new_type, 0) = *elt_bits;
2147 TYPE_NAME (new_type) = ada_type_name (type);
2148
2149 if ((TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (index_type)) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
2150 && is_dynamic_type (check_typedef (index_type)))
2151 || get_discrete_bounds (index_type, &low_bound, &high_bound) < 0)
2152 low_bound = high_bound = 0;
2153 if (high_bound < low_bound)
2154 *elt_bits = TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) = 0;
2155 else
2156 {
2157 *elt_bits *= (high_bound - low_bound + 1);
2158 TYPE_LENGTH (new_type) =
2159 (*elt_bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2160 }
2161
2162 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (new_type) = 1;
2163 return new_type;
2164 }
2165
2166 /* The array type encoded by TYPE, where
2167 ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (TYPE). */
2168
2169 static struct type *
2170 decode_constrained_packed_array_type (struct type *type)
2171 {
2172 const char *raw_name = ada_type_name (ada_check_typedef (type));
2173 char *name;
2174 const char *tail;
2175 struct type *shadow_type;
2176 long bits;
2177
2178 if (!raw_name)
2179 raw_name = ada_type_name (desc_base_type (type));
2180
2181 if (!raw_name)
2182 return NULL;
2183
2184 name = (char *) alloca (strlen (raw_name) + 1);
2185 tail = strstr (raw_name, "___XP");
2186 type = desc_base_type (type);
2187
2188 memcpy (name, raw_name, tail - raw_name);
2189 name[tail - raw_name] = '\000';
2190
2191 shadow_type = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
2192
2193 if (shadow_type == NULL)
2194 {
2195 lim_warning (_("could not find bounds information on packed array"));
2196 return NULL;
2197 }
2198 shadow_type = check_typedef (shadow_type);
2199
2200 if (TYPE_CODE (shadow_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2201 {
2202 lim_warning (_("could not understand bounds "
2203 "information on packed array"));
2204 return NULL;
2205 }
2206
2207 bits = decode_packed_array_bitsize (type);
2208 return constrained_packed_array_type (shadow_type, &bits);
2209 }
2210
2211 /* Given that ARR is a struct value *indicating a GNAT constrained packed
2212 array, returns a simple array that denotes that array. Its type is a
2213 standard GDB array type except that the BITSIZEs of the array
2214 target types are set to the number of bits in each element, and the
2215 type length is set appropriately. */
2216
2217 static struct value *
2218 decode_constrained_packed_array (struct value *arr)
2219 {
2220 struct type *type;
2221
2222 /* If our value is a pointer, then dereference it. Likewise if
2223 the value is a reference. Make sure that this operation does not
2224 cause the target type to be fixed, as this would indirectly cause
2225 this array to be decoded. The rest of the routine assumes that
2226 the array hasn't been decoded yet, so we use the basic "coerce_ref"
2227 and "value_ind" routines to perform the dereferencing, as opposed
2228 to using "ada_coerce_ref" or "ada_value_ind". */
2229 arr = coerce_ref (arr);
2230 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2231 arr = value_ind (arr);
2232
2233 type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arr));
2234 if (type == NULL)
2235 {
2236 error (_("can't unpack array"));
2237 return NULL;
2238 }
2239
2240 if (type_byte_order (value_type (arr)) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG
2241 && ada_is_modular_type (value_type (arr)))
2242 {
2243 /* This is a (right-justified) modular type representing a packed
2244 array with no wrapper. In order to interpret the value through
2245 the (left-justified) packed array type we just built, we must
2246 first left-justify it. */
2247 int bit_size, bit_pos;
2248 ULONGEST mod;
2249
2250 mod = ada_modulus (value_type (arr)) - 1;
2251 bit_size = 0;
2252 while (mod > 0)
2253 {
2254 bit_size += 1;
2255 mod >>= 1;
2256 }
2257 bit_pos = HOST_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (arr)) - bit_size;
2258 arr = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL,
2259 bit_pos / HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2260 bit_pos % HOST_CHAR_BIT,
2261 bit_size,
2262 type);
2263 }
2264
2265 return coerce_unspec_val_to_type (arr, type);
2266 }
2267
2268
2269 /* The value of the element of packed array ARR at the ARITY indices
2270 given in IND. ARR must be a simple array. */
2271
2272 static struct value *
2273 value_subscript_packed (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2274 {
2275 int i;
2276 int bits, elt_off, bit_off;
2277 long elt_total_bit_offset;
2278 struct type *elt_type;
2279 struct value *v;
2280
2281 bits = 0;
2282 elt_total_bit_offset = 0;
2283 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr));
2284 for (i = 0; i < arity; i += 1)
2285 {
2286 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2287 || TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) == 0)
2288 error
2289 (_("attempt to do packed indexing of "
2290 "something other than a packed array"));
2291 else
2292 {
2293 struct type *range_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
2294 LONGEST lowerbound, upperbound;
2295 LONGEST idx;
2296
2297 if (get_discrete_bounds (range_type, &lowerbound, &upperbound) < 0)
2298 {
2299 lim_warning (_("don't know bounds of array"));
2300 lowerbound = upperbound = 0;
2301 }
2302
2303 idx = pos_atr (ind[i]);
2304 if (idx < lowerbound || idx > upperbound)
2305 lim_warning (_("packed array index %ld out of bounds"),
2306 (long) idx);
2307 bits = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0);
2308 elt_total_bit_offset += (idx - lowerbound) * bits;
2309 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
2310 }
2311 }
2312 elt_off = elt_total_bit_offset / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2313 bit_off = elt_total_bit_offset % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2314
2315 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arr, NULL, elt_off, bit_off,
2316 bits, elt_type);
2317 return v;
2318 }
2319
2320 /* Non-zero iff TYPE includes negative integer values. */
2321
2322 static int
2323 has_negatives (struct type *type)
2324 {
2325 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
2326 {
2327 default:
2328 return 0;
2329 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
2330 return !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
2331 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
2332 return TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type) - TYPE_RANGE_DATA (type)->bias < 0;
2333 }
2334 }
2335
2336 /* With SRC being a buffer containing BIT_SIZE bits of data at BIT_OFFSET,
2337 unpack that data into UNPACKED. UNPACKED_LEN is the size in bytes of
2338 the unpacked buffer.
2339
2340 The size of the unpacked buffer (UNPACKED_LEN) is expected to be large
2341 enough to contain at least BIT_OFFSET bits. If not, an error is raised.
2342
2343 IS_BIG_ENDIAN is nonzero if the data is stored in big endian mode,
2344 zero otherwise.
2345
2346 IS_SIGNED_TYPE is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type.
2347
2348 IS_SCALAR is nonzero if the data corresponds to a signed type. */
2349
2350 static void
2351 ada_unpack_from_contents (const gdb_byte *src, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2352 gdb_byte *unpacked, int unpacked_len,
2353 int is_big_endian, int is_signed_type,
2354 int is_scalar)
2355 {
2356 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2357 int src_idx; /* Index into the source area */
2358 int src_bytes_left; /* Number of source bytes left to process. */
2359 int srcBitsLeft; /* Number of source bits left to move */
2360 int unusedLS; /* Number of bits in next significant
2361 byte of source that are unused */
2362
2363 int unpacked_idx; /* Index into the unpacked buffer */
2364 int unpacked_bytes_left; /* Number of bytes left to set in unpacked. */
2365
2366 unsigned long accum; /* Staging area for bits being transferred */
2367 int accumSize; /* Number of meaningful bits in accum */
2368 unsigned char sign;
2369
2370 /* Transmit bytes from least to most significant; delta is the direction
2371 the indices move. */
2372 int delta = is_big_endian ? -1 : 1;
2373
2374 /* Make sure that unpacked is large enough to receive the BIT_SIZE
2375 bits from SRC. .*/
2376 if ((bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT > unpacked_len)
2377 error (_("Cannot unpack %d bits into buffer of %d bytes"),
2378 bit_size, unpacked_len);
2379
2380 srcBitsLeft = bit_size;
2381 src_bytes_left = src_len;
2382 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_len;
2383 sign = 0;
2384
2385 if (is_big_endian)
2386 {
2387 src_idx = src_len - 1;
2388 if (is_signed_type
2389 && ((src[0] << bit_offset) & (1 << (HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1))))
2390 sign = ~0;
2391
2392 unusedLS =
2393 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - (bit_size + bit_offset) % HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2394 % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2395
2396 if (is_scalar)
2397 {
2398 accumSize = 0;
2399 unpacked_idx = unpacked_len - 1;
2400 }
2401 else
2402 {
2403 /* Non-scalar values must be aligned at a byte boundary... */
2404 accumSize =
2405 (HOST_CHAR_BIT - bit_size % HOST_CHAR_BIT) % HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2406 /* ... And are placed at the beginning (most-significant) bytes
2407 of the target. */
2408 unpacked_idx = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1;
2409 unpacked_bytes_left = unpacked_idx + 1;
2410 }
2411 }
2412 else
2413 {
2414 int sign_bit_offset = (bit_size + bit_offset - 1) % 8;
2415
2416 src_idx = unpacked_idx = 0;
2417 unusedLS = bit_offset;
2418 accumSize = 0;
2419
2420 if (is_signed_type && (src[src_len - 1] & (1 << sign_bit_offset)))
2421 sign = ~0;
2422 }
2423
2424 accum = 0;
2425 while (src_bytes_left > 0)
2426 {
2427 /* Mask for removing bits of the next source byte that are not
2428 part of the value. */
2429 unsigned int unusedMSMask =
2430 (1 << (srcBitsLeft >= HOST_CHAR_BIT ? HOST_CHAR_BIT : srcBitsLeft)) -
2431 1;
2432 /* Sign-extend bits for this byte. */
2433 unsigned int signMask = sign & ~unusedMSMask;
2434
2435 accum |=
2436 (((src[src_idx] >> unusedLS) & unusedMSMask) | signMask) << accumSize;
2437 accumSize += HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2438 if (accumSize >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2439 {
2440 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2441 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2442 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2443 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1;
2444 unpacked_idx += delta;
2445 }
2446 srcBitsLeft -= HOST_CHAR_BIT - unusedLS;
2447 unusedLS = 0;
2448 src_bytes_left -= 1;
2449 src_idx += delta;
2450 }
2451 while (unpacked_bytes_left > 0)
2452 {
2453 accum |= sign << accumSize;
2454 unpacked[unpacked_idx] = accum & ~(~0UL << HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2455 accumSize -= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2456 if (accumSize < 0)
2457 accumSize = 0;
2458 accum >>= HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2459 unpacked_bytes_left -= 1;
2460 unpacked_idx += delta;
2461 }
2462 }
2463
2464 /* Create a new value of type TYPE from the contents of OBJ starting
2465 at byte OFFSET, and bit offset BIT_OFFSET within that byte,
2466 proceeding for BIT_SIZE bits. If OBJ is an lval in memory, then
2467 assigning through the result will set the field fetched from.
2468 VALADDR is ignored unless OBJ is NULL, in which case,
2469 VALADDR+OFFSET must address the start of storage containing the
2470 packed value. The value returned in this case is never an lval.
2471 Assumes 0 <= BIT_OFFSET < HOST_CHAR_BIT. */
2472
2473 struct value *
2474 ada_value_primitive_packed_val (struct value *obj, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
2475 long offset, int bit_offset, int bit_size,
2476 struct type *type)
2477 {
2478 struct value *v;
2479 const gdb_byte *src; /* First byte containing data to unpack */
2480 gdb_byte *unpacked;
2481 const int is_scalar = is_scalar_type (type);
2482 const int is_big_endian = type_byte_order (type) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG;
2483 gdb::byte_vector staging;
2484
2485 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
2486
2487 if (obj == NULL)
2488 src = valaddr + offset;
2489 else
2490 src = value_contents (obj) + offset;
2491
2492 if (is_dynamic_type (type))
2493 {
2494 /* The length of TYPE might by dynamic, so we need to resolve
2495 TYPE in order to know its actual size, which we then use
2496 to create the contents buffer of the value we return.
2497 The difficulty is that the data containing our object is
2498 packed, and therefore maybe not at a byte boundary. So, what
2499 we do, is unpack the data into a byte-aligned buffer, and then
2500 use that buffer as our object's value for resolving the type. */
2501 int staging_len = (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2502 staging.resize (staging_len);
2503
2504 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size,
2505 staging.data (), staging.size (),
2506 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type),
2507 is_scalar);
2508 type = resolve_dynamic_type (type, staging, 0);
2509 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) < (bit_size + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2510 {
2511 /* This happens when the length of the object is dynamic,
2512 and is actually smaller than the space reserved for it.
2513 For instance, in an array of variant records, the bit_size
2514 we're given is the array stride, which is constant and
2515 normally equal to the maximum size of its element.
2516 But, in reality, each element only actually spans a portion
2517 of that stride. */
2518 bit_size = TYPE_LENGTH (type) * HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2519 }
2520 }
2521
2522 if (obj == NULL)
2523 {
2524 v = allocate_value (type);
2525 src = valaddr + offset;
2526 }
2527 else if (VALUE_LVAL (obj) == lval_memory && value_lazy (obj))
2528 {
2529 int src_len = (bit_size + bit_offset + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / 8;
2530 gdb_byte *buf;
2531
2532 v = value_at (type, value_address (obj) + offset);
2533 buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (src_len);
2534 read_memory (value_address (v), buf, src_len);
2535 src = buf;
2536 }
2537 else
2538 {
2539 v = allocate_value (type);
2540 src = value_contents (obj) + offset;
2541 }
2542
2543 if (obj != NULL)
2544 {
2545 long new_offset = offset;
2546
2547 set_value_component_location (v, obj);
2548 set_value_bitpos (v, bit_offset + value_bitpos (obj));
2549 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2550 if (value_bitpos (v) >= HOST_CHAR_BIT)
2551 {
2552 ++new_offset;
2553 set_value_bitpos (v, value_bitpos (v) - HOST_CHAR_BIT);
2554 }
2555 set_value_offset (v, new_offset);
2556
2557 /* Also set the parent value. This is needed when trying to
2558 assign a new value (in inferior memory). */
2559 set_value_parent (v, obj);
2560 }
2561 else
2562 set_value_bitsize (v, bit_size);
2563 unpacked = value_contents_writeable (v);
2564
2565 if (bit_size == 0)
2566 {
2567 memset (unpacked, 0, TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2568 return v;
2569 }
2570
2571 if (staging.size () == TYPE_LENGTH (type))
2572 {
2573 /* Small short-cut: If we've unpacked the data into a buffer
2574 of the same size as TYPE's length, then we can reuse that,
2575 instead of doing the unpacking again. */
2576 memcpy (unpacked, staging.data (), staging.size ());
2577 }
2578 else
2579 ada_unpack_from_contents (src, bit_offset, bit_size,
2580 unpacked, TYPE_LENGTH (type),
2581 is_big_endian, has_negatives (type), is_scalar);
2582
2583 return v;
2584 }
2585
2586 /* Store the contents of FROMVAL into the location of TOVAL.
2587 Return a new value with the location of TOVAL and contents of
2588 FROMVAL. Handles assignment into packed fields that have
2589 floating-point or non-scalar types. */
2590
2591 static struct value *
2592 ada_value_assign (struct value *toval, struct value *fromval)
2593 {
2594 struct type *type = value_type (toval);
2595 int bits = value_bitsize (toval);
2596
2597 toval = ada_coerce_ref (toval);
2598 fromval = ada_coerce_ref (fromval);
2599
2600 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (toval)))
2601 toval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (toval);
2602 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (fromval)))
2603 fromval = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (fromval);
2604
2605 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (toval))
2606 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
2607
2608 if (VALUE_LVAL (toval) == lval_memory
2609 && bits > 0
2610 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT
2611 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT))
2612 {
2613 int len = (value_bitpos (toval)
2614 + bits + HOST_CHAR_BIT - 1) / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
2615 int from_size;
2616 gdb_byte *buffer = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
2617 struct value *val;
2618 CORE_ADDR to_addr = value_address (toval);
2619
2620 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
2621 fromval = value_cast (type, fromval);
2622
2623 read_memory (to_addr, buffer, len);
2624 from_size = value_bitsize (fromval);
2625 if (from_size == 0)
2626 from_size = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (fromval)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
2627
2628 const int is_big_endian = type_byte_order (type) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG;
2629 ULONGEST from_offset = 0;
2630 if (is_big_endian && is_scalar_type (value_type (fromval)))
2631 from_offset = from_size - bits;
2632 copy_bitwise (buffer, value_bitpos (toval),
2633 value_contents (fromval), from_offset,
2634 bits, is_big_endian);
2635 write_memory_with_notification (to_addr, buffer, len);
2636
2637 val = value_copy (toval);
2638 memcpy (value_contents_raw (val), value_contents (fromval),
2639 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
2640 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
2641
2642 return val;
2643 }
2644
2645 return value_assign (toval, fromval);
2646 }
2647
2648
2649 /* Given that COMPONENT is a memory lvalue that is part of the lvalue
2650 CONTAINER, assign the contents of VAL to COMPONENTS's place in
2651 CONTAINER. Modifies the VALUE_CONTENTS of CONTAINER only, not
2652 COMPONENT, and not the inferior's memory. The current contents
2653 of COMPONENT are ignored.
2654
2655 Although not part of the initial design, this function also works
2656 when CONTAINER and COMPONENT are not_lval's: it works as if CONTAINER
2657 had a null address, and COMPONENT had an address which is equal to
2658 its offset inside CONTAINER. */
2659
2660 static void
2661 value_assign_to_component (struct value *container, struct value *component,
2662 struct value *val)
2663 {
2664 LONGEST offset_in_container =
2665 (LONGEST) (value_address (component) - value_address (container));
2666 int bit_offset_in_container =
2667 value_bitpos (component) - value_bitpos (container);
2668 int bits;
2669
2670 val = value_cast (value_type (component), val);
2671
2672 if (value_bitsize (component) == 0)
2673 bits = TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component));
2674 else
2675 bits = value_bitsize (component);
2676
2677 if (type_byte_order (value_type (container)) == BFD_ENDIAN_BIG)
2678 {
2679 int src_offset;
2680
2681 if (is_scalar_type (check_typedef (value_type (component))))
2682 src_offset
2683 = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (component)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT - bits;
2684 else
2685 src_offset = 0;
2686 copy_bitwise (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2687 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2688 value_contents (val), src_offset, bits, 1);
2689 }
2690 else
2691 copy_bitwise (value_contents_writeable (container) + offset_in_container,
2692 value_bitpos (container) + bit_offset_in_container,
2693 value_contents (val), 0, bits, 0);
2694 }
2695
2696 /* Determine if TYPE is an access to an unconstrained array. */
2697
2698 bool
2699 ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (struct type *type)
2700 {
2701 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
2702 && is_thick_pntr (ada_typedef_target_type (type)));
2703 }
2704
2705 /* The value of the element of array ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2706 ARR may be either a simple array, GNAT array descriptor, or pointer
2707 thereto. */
2708
2709 struct value *
2710 ada_value_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2711 {
2712 int k;
2713 struct value *elt;
2714 struct type *elt_type;
2715
2716 elt = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arr);
2717
2718 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2719 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2720 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (elt_type, 0) > 0)
2721 return value_subscript_packed (elt, arity, ind);
2722
2723 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2724 {
2725 struct type *saved_elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type);
2726
2727 if (TYPE_CODE (elt_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2728 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2729
2730 elt = value_subscript (elt, pos_atr (ind[k]));
2731
2732 if (ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (saved_elt_type)
2733 && TYPE_CODE (value_type (elt)) != TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
2734 {
2735 /* The element is a typedef to an unconstrained array,
2736 except that the value_subscript call stripped the
2737 typedef layer. The typedef layer is GNAT's way to
2738 specify that the element is, at the source level, an
2739 access to the unconstrained array, rather than the
2740 unconstrained array. So, we need to restore that
2741 typedef layer, which we can do by forcing the element's
2742 type back to its original type. Otherwise, the returned
2743 value is going to be printed as the array, rather
2744 than as an access. Another symptom of the same issue
2745 would be that an expression trying to dereference the
2746 element would also be improperly rejected. */
2747 deprecated_set_value_type (elt, saved_elt_type);
2748 }
2749
2750 elt_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (elt));
2751 }
2752
2753 return elt;
2754 }
2755
2756 /* Assuming ARR is a pointer to a GDB array, the value of the element
2757 of *ARR at the ARITY indices given in IND.
2758 Does not read the entire array into memory.
2759
2760 Note: Unlike what one would expect, this function is used instead of
2761 ada_value_subscript for basically all non-packed array types. The reason
2762 for this is that a side effect of doing our own pointer arithmetics instead
2763 of relying on value_subscript is that there is no implicit typedef peeling.
2764 This is important for arrays of array accesses, where it allows us to
2765 preserve the fact that the array's element is an array access, where the
2766 access part os encoded in a typedef layer. */
2767
2768 static struct value *
2769 ada_value_ptr_subscript (struct value *arr, int arity, struct value **ind)
2770 {
2771 int k;
2772 struct value *array_ind = ada_value_ind (arr);
2773 struct type *type
2774 = check_typedef (value_enclosing_type (array_ind));
2775
2776 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
2777 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0) > 0)
2778 return value_subscript_packed (array_ind, arity, ind);
2779
2780 for (k = 0; k < arity; k += 1)
2781 {
2782 LONGEST lwb, upb;
2783 struct value *lwb_value;
2784
2785 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2786 error (_("too many subscripts (%d expected)"), k);
2787 arr = value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)),
2788 value_copy (arr));
2789 get_discrete_bounds (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), &lwb, &upb);
2790 lwb_value = value_from_longest (value_type(ind[k]), lwb);
2791 arr = value_ptradd (arr, pos_atr (ind[k]) - pos_atr (lwb_value));
2792 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2793 }
2794
2795 return value_ind (arr);
2796 }
2797
2798 /* Given that ARRAY_PTR is a pointer or reference to an array of type TYPE (the
2799 actual type of ARRAY_PTR is ignored), returns the Ada slice of
2800 HIGH'Pos-LOW'Pos+1 elements starting at index LOW. The lower bound of
2801 this array is LOW, as per Ada rules. */
2802 static struct value *
2803 ada_value_slice_from_ptr (struct value *array_ptr, struct type *type,
2804 int low, int high)
2805 {
2806 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (type);
2807 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2808 struct type *index_type
2809 = create_static_range_type (NULL, base_index_type, low, high);
2810 struct type *slice_type = create_array_type_with_stride
2811 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), index_type,
2812 type0->dyn_prop (DYN_PROP_BYTE_STRIDE),
2813 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0));
2814 int base_low = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
2815 LONGEST base_low_pos, low_pos;
2816 CORE_ADDR base;
2817
2818 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2819 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, base_low, &base_low_pos))
2820 {
2821 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2822 low_pos = low;
2823 base_low_pos = base_low;
2824 }
2825
2826 base = value_as_address (array_ptr)
2827 + ((low_pos - base_low_pos)
2828 * TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0)));
2829 return value_at_lazy (slice_type, base);
2830 }
2831
2832
2833 static struct value *
2834 ada_value_slice (struct value *array, int low, int high)
2835 {
2836 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
2837 struct type *base_index_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2838 struct type *index_type
2839 = create_static_range_type (NULL, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type), low, high);
2840 struct type *slice_type = create_array_type_with_stride
2841 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), index_type,
2842 type->dyn_prop (DYN_PROP_BYTE_STRIDE),
2843 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, 0));
2844 LONGEST low_pos, high_pos;
2845
2846 if (!discrete_position (base_index_type, low, &low_pos)
2847 || !discrete_position (base_index_type, high, &high_pos))
2848 {
2849 warning (_("unable to get positions in slice, use bounds instead"));
2850 low_pos = low;
2851 high_pos = high;
2852 }
2853
2854 return value_cast (slice_type,
2855 value_slice (array, low, high_pos - low_pos + 1));
2856 }
2857
2858 /* If type is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2859 descriptor, returns the number of dimensions for type. If arr is a
2860 simple array, returns the number of "array of"s that prefix its
2861 type designation. Otherwise, returns 0. */
2862
2863 int
2864 ada_array_arity (struct type *type)
2865 {
2866 int arity;
2867
2868 if (type == NULL)
2869 return 0;
2870
2871 type = desc_base_type (type);
2872
2873 arity = 0;
2874 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2875 return desc_arity (desc_bounds_type (type));
2876 else
2877 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2878 {
2879 arity += 1;
2880 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
2881 }
2882
2883 return arity;
2884 }
2885
2886 /* If TYPE is a record type in the form of a standard GNAT array
2887 descriptor or a simple array type, returns the element type for
2888 TYPE after indexing by NINDICES indices, or by all indices if
2889 NINDICES is -1. Otherwise, returns NULL. */
2890
2891 struct type *
2892 ada_array_element_type (struct type *type, int nindices)
2893 {
2894 type = desc_base_type (type);
2895
2896 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
2897 {
2898 int k;
2899 struct type *p_array_type;
2900
2901 p_array_type = desc_data_target_type (type);
2902
2903 k = ada_array_arity (type);
2904 if (k == 0)
2905 return NULL;
2906
2907 /* Initially p_array_type = elt_type(*)[]...(k times)...[]. */
2908 if (nindices >= 0 && k > nindices)
2909 k = nindices;
2910 while (k > 0 && p_array_type != NULL)
2911 {
2912 p_array_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (p_array_type));
2913 k -= 1;
2914 }
2915 return p_array_type;
2916 }
2917 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2918 {
2919 while (nindices != 0 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
2920 {
2921 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2922 nindices -= 1;
2923 }
2924 return type;
2925 }
2926
2927 return NULL;
2928 }
2929
2930 /* The type of nth index in arrays of given type (n numbering from 1).
2931 Does not examine memory. Throws an error if N is invalid or TYPE
2932 is not an array type. NAME is the name of the Ada attribute being
2933 evaluated ('range, 'first, 'last, or 'length); it is used in building
2934 the error message. */
2935
2936 static struct type *
2937 ada_index_type (struct type *type, int n, const char *name)
2938 {
2939 struct type *result_type;
2940
2941 type = desc_base_type (type);
2942
2943 if (n < 0 || n > ada_array_arity (type))
2944 error (_("invalid dimension number to '%s"), name);
2945
2946 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (type))
2947 {
2948 int i;
2949
2950 for (i = 1; i < n; i += 1)
2951 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
2952 result_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type));
2953 /* FIXME: The stabs type r(0,0);bound;bound in an array type
2954 has a target type of TYPE_CODE_UNDEF. We compensate here, but
2955 perhaps stabsread.c would make more sense. */
2956 if (result_type && TYPE_CODE (result_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF)
2957 result_type = NULL;
2958 }
2959 else
2960 {
2961 result_type = desc_index_type (desc_bounds_type (type), n);
2962 if (result_type == NULL)
2963 error (_("attempt to take bound of something that is not an array"));
2964 }
2965
2966 return result_type;
2967 }
2968
2969 /* Given that arr is an array type, returns the lower bound of the
2970 Nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
2971 WHICH is 1. This returns bounds 0 .. -1 if ARR_TYPE is an
2972 array-descriptor type. It works for other arrays with bounds supplied
2973 by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
2974
2975 static LONGEST
2976 ada_array_bound_from_type (struct type *arr_type, int n, int which)
2977 {
2978 struct type *type, *index_type_desc, *index_type;
2979 int i;
2980
2981 gdb_assert (which == 0 || which == 1);
2982
2983 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
2984 arr_type = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type);
2985
2986 if (arr_type == NULL || !ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
2987 return (LONGEST) - which;
2988
2989 if (TYPE_CODE (arr_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
2990 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (arr_type);
2991 else
2992 type = arr_type;
2993
2994 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type))
2995 {
2996 /* The array has already been fixed, so we do not need to
2997 check the parallel ___XA type again. That encoding has
2998 already been applied, so ignore it now. */
2999 index_type_desc = NULL;
3000 }
3001 else
3002 {
3003 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XA");
3004 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
3005 }
3006
3007 if (index_type_desc != NULL)
3008 index_type = to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, n - 1),
3009 NULL);
3010 else
3011 {
3012 struct type *elt_type = check_typedef (type);
3013
3014 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
3015 elt_type = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type));
3016
3017 index_type = TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (elt_type);
3018 }
3019
3020 return
3021 (LONGEST) (which == 0
3022 ? ada_discrete_type_low_bound (index_type)
3023 : ada_discrete_type_high_bound (index_type));
3024 }
3025
3026 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the lower bound of the
3027 nth index (numbering from 1) if WHICH is 0, and the upper bound if
3028 WHICH is 1. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3029 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants. */
3030
3031 static LONGEST
3032 ada_array_bound (struct value *arr, int n, int which)
3033 {
3034 struct type *arr_type;
3035
3036 if (TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3037 arr = value_ind (arr);
3038 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3039
3040 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3041 return ada_array_bound (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n, which);
3042 else if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3043 return ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, which);
3044 else
3045 return value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, which));
3046 }
3047
3048 /* Given that arr is an array value, returns the length of the
3049 nth index. This routine will also work for arrays with bounds
3050 supplied by run-time quantities other than discriminants.
3051 Does not work for arrays indexed by enumeration types with representation
3052 clauses at the moment. */
3053
3054 static LONGEST
3055 ada_array_length (struct value *arr, int n)
3056 {
3057 struct type *arr_type, *index_type;
3058 int low, high;
3059
3060 if (TYPE_CODE (check_typedef (value_type (arr))) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3061 arr = value_ind (arr);
3062 arr_type = value_enclosing_type (arr);
3063
3064 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (arr_type))
3065 return ada_array_length (decode_constrained_packed_array (arr), n);
3066
3067 if (ada_is_simple_array_type (arr_type))
3068 {
3069 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 0);
3070 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (arr_type, n, 1);
3071 }
3072 else
3073 {
3074 low = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 0));
3075 high = value_as_long (desc_one_bound (desc_bounds (arr), n, 1));
3076 }
3077
3078 arr_type = check_typedef (arr_type);
3079 index_type = ada_index_type (arr_type, n, "length");
3080 if (index_type != NULL)
3081 {
3082 struct type *base_type;
3083 if (TYPE_CODE (index_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
3084 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (index_type);
3085 else
3086 base_type = index_type;
3087
3088 low = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, low));
3089 high = pos_atr (value_from_longest (base_type, high));
3090 }
3091 return high - low + 1;
3092 }
3093
3094 /* An array whose type is that of ARR_TYPE (an array type), with
3095 bounds LOW to HIGH, but whose contents are unimportant. If HIGH is
3096 less than LOW, then LOW-1 is used. */
3097
3098 static struct value *
3099 empty_array (struct type *arr_type, int low, int high)
3100 {
3101 struct type *arr_type0 = ada_check_typedef (arr_type);
3102 struct type *index_type
3103 = create_static_range_type
3104 (NULL, TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (arr_type0)), low,
3105 high < low ? low - 1 : high);
3106 struct type *elt_type = ada_array_element_type (arr_type0, 1);
3107
3108 return allocate_value (create_array_type (NULL, elt_type, index_type));
3109 }
3110 \f
3111
3112 /* Name resolution */
3113
3114 /* The "decoded" name for the user-definable Ada operator corresponding
3115 to OP. */
3116
3117 static const char *
3118 ada_decoded_op_name (enum exp_opcode op)
3119 {
3120 int i;
3121
3122 for (i = 0; ada_opname_table[i].encoded != NULL; i += 1)
3123 {
3124 if (ada_opname_table[i].op == op)
3125 return ada_opname_table[i].decoded;
3126 }
3127 error (_("Could not find operator name for opcode"));
3128 }
3129
3130 /* Returns true (non-zero) iff decoded name N0 should appear before N1
3131 in a listing of choices during disambiguation (see sort_choices, below).
3132 The idea is that overloadings of a subprogram name from the
3133 same package should sort in their source order. We settle for ordering
3134 such symbols by their trailing number (__N or $N). */
3135
3136 static int
3137 encoded_ordered_before (const char *N0, const char *N1)
3138 {
3139 if (N1 == NULL)
3140 return 0;
3141 else if (N0 == NULL)
3142 return 1;
3143 else
3144 {
3145 int k0, k1;
3146
3147 for (k0 = strlen (N0) - 1; k0 > 0 && isdigit (N0[k0]); k0 -= 1)
3148 ;
3149 for (k1 = strlen (N1) - 1; k1 > 0 && isdigit (N1[k1]); k1 -= 1)
3150 ;
3151 if ((N0[k0] == '_' || N0[k0] == '$') && N0[k0 + 1] != '\000'
3152 && (N1[k1] == '_' || N1[k1] == '$') && N1[k1 + 1] != '\000')
3153 {
3154 int n0, n1;
3155
3156 n0 = k0;
3157 while (N0[n0] == '_' && n0 > 0 && N0[n0 - 1] == '_')
3158 n0 -= 1;
3159 n1 = k1;
3160 while (N1[n1] == '_' && n1 > 0 && N1[n1 - 1] == '_')
3161 n1 -= 1;
3162 if (n0 == n1 && strncmp (N0, N1, n0) == 0)
3163 return (atoi (N0 + k0 + 1) < atoi (N1 + k1 + 1));
3164 }
3165 return (strcmp (N0, N1) < 0);
3166 }
3167 }
3168
3169 /* Sort SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] to put the choices in a canonical order by the
3170 encoded names. */
3171
3172 static void
3173 sort_choices (struct block_symbol syms[], int nsyms)
3174 {
3175 int i;
3176
3177 for (i = 1; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3178 {
3179 struct block_symbol sym = syms[i];
3180 int j;
3181
3182 for (j = i - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
3183 {
3184 if (encoded_ordered_before (syms[j].symbol->linkage_name (),
3185 sym.symbol->linkage_name ()))
3186 break;
3187 syms[j + 1] = syms[j];
3188 }
3189 syms[j + 1] = sym;
3190 }
3191 }
3192
3193 /* Whether GDB should display formals and return types for functions in the
3194 overloads selection menu. */
3195 static bool print_signatures = true;
3196
3197 /* Print the signature for SYM on STREAM according to the FLAGS options. For
3198 all but functions, the signature is just the name of the symbol. For
3199 functions, this is the name of the function, the list of types for formals
3200 and the return type (if any). */
3201
3202 static void
3203 ada_print_symbol_signature (struct ui_file *stream, struct symbol *sym,
3204 const struct type_print_options *flags)
3205 {
3206 struct type *type = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
3207
3208 fprintf_filtered (stream, "%s", sym->print_name ());
3209 if (!print_signatures
3210 || type == NULL
3211 || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3212 return;
3213
3214 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (type) > 0)
3215 {
3216 int i;
3217
3218 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
3219 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); ++i)
3220 {
3221 if (i > 0)
3222 fprintf_filtered (stream, "; ");
3223 ada_print_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), NULL, stream, -1, 0,
3224 flags);
3225 }
3226 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
3227 }
3228 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != NULL
3229 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
3230 {
3231 fprintf_filtered (stream, " return ");
3232 ada_print_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, stream, -1, 0, flags);
3233 }
3234 }
3235
3236 /* Read and validate a set of numeric choices from the user in the
3237 range 0 .. N_CHOICES-1. Place the results in increasing
3238 order in CHOICES[0 .. N-1], and return N.
3239
3240 The user types choices as a sequence of numbers on one line
3241 separated by blanks, encoding them as follows:
3242
3243 + A choice of 0 means to cancel the selection, throwing an error.
3244 + If IS_ALL_CHOICE, a choice of 1 selects the entire set 0 .. N_CHOICES-1.
3245 + The user chooses k by typing k+IS_ALL_CHOICE+1.
3246
3247 The user is not allowed to choose more than MAX_RESULTS values.
3248
3249 ANNOTATION_SUFFIX, if present, is used to annotate the input
3250 prompts (for use with the -f switch). */
3251
3252 static int
3253 get_selections (int *choices, int n_choices, int max_results,
3254 int is_all_choice, const char *annotation_suffix)
3255 {
3256 const char *args;
3257 const char *prompt;
3258 int n_chosen;
3259 int first_choice = is_all_choice ? 2 : 1;
3260
3261 prompt = getenv ("PS2");
3262 if (prompt == NULL)
3263 prompt = "> ";
3264
3265 args = command_line_input (prompt, annotation_suffix);
3266
3267 if (args == NULL)
3268 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3269
3270 n_chosen = 0;
3271
3272 /* Set choices[0 .. n_chosen-1] to the users' choices in ascending
3273 order, as given in args. Choices are validated. */
3274 while (1)
3275 {
3276 char *args2;
3277 int choice, j;
3278
3279 args = skip_spaces (args);
3280 if (*args == '\0' && n_chosen == 0)
3281 error_no_arg (_("one or more choice numbers"));
3282 else if (*args == '\0')
3283 break;
3284
3285 choice = strtol (args, &args2, 10);
3286 if (args == args2 || choice < 0
3287 || choice > n_choices + first_choice - 1)
3288 error (_("Argument must be choice number"));
3289 args = args2;
3290
3291 if (choice == 0)
3292 error (_("cancelled"));
3293
3294 if (choice < first_choice)
3295 {
3296 n_chosen = n_choices;
3297 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
3298 choices[j] = j;
3299 break;
3300 }
3301 choice -= first_choice;
3302
3303 for (j = n_chosen - 1; j >= 0 && choice < choices[j]; j -= 1)
3304 {
3305 }
3306
3307 if (j < 0 || choice != choices[j])
3308 {
3309 int k;
3310
3311 for (k = n_chosen - 1; k > j; k -= 1)
3312 choices[k + 1] = choices[k];
3313 choices[j + 1] = choice;
3314 n_chosen += 1;
3315 }
3316 }
3317
3318 if (n_chosen > max_results)
3319 error (_("Select no more than %d of the above"), max_results);
3320
3321 return n_chosen;
3322 }
3323
3324 /* Given a list of NSYMS symbols in SYMS, select up to MAX_RESULTS>0
3325 by asking the user (if necessary), returning the number selected,
3326 and setting the first elements of SYMS items. Error if no symbols
3327 selected. */
3328
3329 /* NOTE: Adapted from decode_line_2 in symtab.c, with which it ought
3330 to be re-integrated one of these days. */
3331
3332 static int
3333 user_select_syms (struct block_symbol *syms, int nsyms, int max_results)
3334 {
3335 int i;
3336 int *chosen = XALLOCAVEC (int , nsyms);
3337 int n_chosen;
3338 int first_choice = (max_results == 1) ? 1 : 2;
3339 const char *select_mode = multiple_symbols_select_mode ();
3340
3341 if (max_results < 1)
3342 error (_("Request to select 0 symbols!"));
3343 if (nsyms <= 1)
3344 return nsyms;
3345
3346 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_cancel)
3347 error (_("\
3348 canceled because the command is ambiguous\n\
3349 See set/show multiple-symbol."));
3350
3351 /* If select_mode is "all", then return all possible symbols.
3352 Only do that if more than one symbol can be selected, of course.
3353 Otherwise, display the menu as usual. */
3354 if (select_mode == multiple_symbols_all && max_results > 1)
3355 return nsyms;
3356
3357 printf_filtered (_("[0] cancel\n"));
3358 if (max_results > 1)
3359 printf_filtered (_("[1] all\n"));
3360
3361 sort_choices (syms, nsyms);
3362
3363 for (i = 0; i < nsyms; i += 1)
3364 {
3365 if (syms[i].symbol == NULL)
3366 continue;
3367
3368 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_BLOCK)
3369 {
3370 struct symtab_and_line sal =
3371 find_function_start_sal (syms[i].symbol, 1);
3372
3373 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3374 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3375 &type_print_raw_options);
3376 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
3377 printf_filtered (_(" at %p[<no source file available>%p]:%d\n"),
3378 metadata_style.style ().ptr (), nullptr, sal.line);
3379 else
3380 printf_filtered
3381 (_(" at %ps:%d\n"),
3382 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
3383 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal.symtab)),
3384 sal.line);
3385 continue;
3386 }
3387 else
3388 {
3389 int is_enumeral =
3390 (SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) == LOC_CONST
3391 && SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol) != NULL
3392 && TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM);
3393 struct symtab *symtab = NULL;
3394
3395 if (SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (syms[i].symbol))
3396 symtab = symbol_symtab (syms[i].symbol);
3397
3398 if (SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol) != 0 && symtab != NULL)
3399 {
3400 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3401 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3402 &type_print_raw_options);
3403 printf_filtered (_(" at %s:%d\n"),
3404 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab),
3405 SYMBOL_LINE (syms[i].symbol));
3406 }
3407 else if (is_enumeral
3408 && TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != NULL)
3409 {
3410 printf_filtered (("[%d] "), i + first_choice);
3411 ada_print_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol), NULL,
3412 gdb_stdout, -1, 0, &type_print_raw_options);
3413 printf_filtered (_("'(%s) (enumeral)\n"),
3414 syms[i].symbol->print_name ());
3415 }
3416 else
3417 {
3418 printf_filtered ("[%d] ", i + first_choice);
3419 ada_print_symbol_signature (gdb_stdout, syms[i].symbol,
3420 &type_print_raw_options);
3421
3422 if (symtab != NULL)
3423 printf_filtered (is_enumeral
3424 ? _(" in %s (enumeral)\n")
3425 : _(" at %s:?\n"),
3426 symtab_to_filename_for_display (symtab));
3427 else
3428 printf_filtered (is_enumeral
3429 ? _(" (enumeral)\n")
3430 : _(" at ?\n"));
3431 }
3432 }
3433 }
3434
3435 n_chosen = get_selections (chosen, nsyms, max_results, max_results > 1,
3436 "overload-choice");
3437
3438 for (i = 0; i < n_chosen; i += 1)
3439 syms[i] = syms[chosen[i]];
3440
3441 return n_chosen;
3442 }
3443
3444 /* Same as evaluate_type (*EXP), but resolves ambiguous symbol
3445 references (marked by OP_VAR_VALUE nodes in which the symbol has an
3446 undefined namespace) and converts operators that are
3447 user-defined into appropriate function calls. If CONTEXT_TYPE is
3448 non-null, it provides a preferred result type [at the moment, only
3449 type void has any effect---causing procedures to be preferred over
3450 functions in calls]. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates that a non-void
3451 return type is preferred. May change (expand) *EXP. */
3452
3453 static void
3454 resolve (expression_up *expp, int void_context_p, int parse_completion,
3455 innermost_block_tracker *tracker)
3456 {
3457 struct type *context_type = NULL;
3458 int pc = 0;
3459
3460 if (void_context_p)
3461 context_type = builtin_type ((*expp)->gdbarch)->builtin_void;
3462
3463 resolve_subexp (expp, &pc, 1, context_type, parse_completion, tracker);
3464 }
3465
3466 /* Resolve the operator of the subexpression beginning at
3467 position *POS of *EXPP. "Resolving" consists of replacing
3468 the symbols that have undefined namespaces in OP_VAR_VALUE nodes
3469 with their resolutions, replacing built-in operators with
3470 function calls to user-defined operators, where appropriate, and,
3471 when DEPROCEDURE_P is non-zero, converting function-valued variables
3472 into parameterless calls. May expand *EXPP. The CONTEXT_TYPE functions
3473 are as in ada_resolve, above. */
3474
3475 static struct value *
3476 resolve_subexp (expression_up *expp, int *pos, int deprocedure_p,
3477 struct type *context_type, int parse_completion,
3478 innermost_block_tracker *tracker)
3479 {
3480 int pc = *pos;
3481 int i;
3482 struct expression *exp; /* Convenience: == *expp. */
3483 enum exp_opcode op = (*expp)->elts[pc].opcode;
3484 struct value **argvec; /* Vector of operand types (alloca'ed). */
3485 int nargs; /* Number of operands. */
3486 int oplen;
3487
3488 argvec = NULL;
3489 nargs = 0;
3490 exp = expp->get ();
3491
3492 /* Pass one: resolve operands, saving their types and updating *pos,
3493 if needed. */
3494 switch (op)
3495 {
3496 case OP_FUNCALL:
3497 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3498 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3499 *pos += 7;
3500 else
3501 {
3502 *pos += 3;
3503 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3504 }
3505 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
3506 break;
3507
3508 case UNOP_ADDR:
3509 *pos += 1;
3510 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3511 break;
3512
3513 case UNOP_QUAL:
3514 *pos += 3;
3515 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type),
3516 parse_completion, tracker);
3517 break;
3518
3519 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
3520 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
3521 case OP_ATR_TAG:
3522 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
3523 case OP_ATR_LAST:
3524 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
3525 case OP_ATR_POS:
3526 case OP_ATR_VAL:
3527 case OP_ATR_MIN:
3528 case OP_ATR_MAX:
3529 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
3530 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
3531 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
3532 case OP_AGGREGATE:
3533 case OP_OTHERS:
3534 case OP_CHOICES:
3535 case OP_POSITIONAL:
3536 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
3537 case OP_NAME:
3538 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
3539 *pos += oplen;
3540 break;
3541
3542 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
3543 {
3544 struct value *arg1;
3545
3546 *pos += 1;
3547 arg1 = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 0, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3548 if (arg1 == NULL)
3549 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL, parse_completion, tracker);
3550 else
3551 resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, value_type (arg1), parse_completion,
3552 tracker);
3553 break;
3554 }
3555
3556 case UNOP_CAST:
3557 *pos += 3;
3558 nargs = 1;
3559 break;
3560
3561 case BINOP_ADD:
3562 case BINOP_SUB:
3563 case BINOP_MUL:
3564 case BINOP_DIV:
3565 case BINOP_REM:
3566 case BINOP_MOD:
3567 case BINOP_EXP:
3568 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3569 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
3570 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
3571 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3572 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3573 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3574
3575 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3576 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3577 case BINOP_LESS:
3578 case BINOP_GTR:
3579 case BINOP_LEQ:
3580 case BINOP_GEQ:
3581
3582 case BINOP_REPEAT:
3583 case BINOP_SUBSCRIPT:
3584 case BINOP_COMMA:
3585 *pos += 1;
3586 nargs = 2;
3587 break;
3588
3589 case UNOP_NEG:
3590 case UNOP_PLUS:
3591 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3592 case UNOP_ABS:
3593 case UNOP_IND:
3594 *pos += 1;
3595 nargs = 1;
3596 break;
3597
3598 case OP_LONG:
3599 case OP_FLOAT:
3600 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3601 case OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE:
3602 *pos += 4;
3603 break;
3604
3605 case OP_TYPE:
3606 case OP_BOOL:
3607 case OP_LAST:
3608 case OP_INTERNALVAR:
3609 *pos += 3;
3610 break;
3611
3612 case UNOP_MEMVAL:
3613 *pos += 3;
3614 nargs = 1;
3615 break;
3616
3617 case OP_REGISTER:
3618 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3619 break;
3620
3621 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
3622 *pos += 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst + 1);
3623 nargs = 1;
3624 break;
3625
3626 case TERNOP_SLICE:
3627 *pos += 1;
3628 nargs = 3;
3629 break;
3630
3631 case OP_STRING:
3632 break;
3633
3634 default:
3635 error (_("Unexpected operator during name resolution"));
3636 }
3637
3638 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 1);
3639 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
3640 argvec[i] = resolve_subexp (expp, pos, 1, NULL, parse_completion,
3641 tracker);
3642 argvec[i] = NULL;
3643 exp = expp->get ();
3644
3645 /* Pass two: perform any resolution on principal operator. */
3646 switch (op)
3647 {
3648 default:
3649 break;
3650
3651 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
3652 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3653 {
3654 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3655 int n_candidates;
3656
3657 n_candidates =
3658 ada_lookup_symbol_list (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->linkage_name (),
3659 exp->elts[pc + 1].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3660 &candidates);
3661
3662 if (n_candidates > 1)
3663 {
3664 /* Types tend to get re-introduced locally, so if there
3665 are any local symbols that are not types, first filter
3666 out all types. */
3667 int j;
3668 for (j = 0; j < n_candidates; j += 1)
3669 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol))
3670 {
3671 case LOC_REGISTER:
3672 case LOC_ARG:
3673 case LOC_REF_ARG:
3674 case LOC_REGPARM_ADDR:
3675 case LOC_LOCAL:
3676 case LOC_COMPUTED:
3677 goto FoundNonType;
3678 default:
3679 break;
3680 }
3681 FoundNonType:
3682 if (j < n_candidates)
3683 {
3684 j = 0;
3685 while (j < n_candidates)
3686 {
3687 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (candidates[j].symbol) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
3688 {
3689 candidates[j] = candidates[n_candidates - 1];
3690 n_candidates -= 1;
3691 }
3692 else
3693 j += 1;
3694 }
3695 }
3696 }
3697
3698 if (n_candidates == 0)
3699 error (_("No definition found for %s"),
3700 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3701 else if (n_candidates == 1)
3702 i = 0;
3703 else if (deprocedure_p
3704 && !is_nonfunction (candidates.data (), n_candidates))
3705 {
3706 i = ada_resolve_function
3707 (candidates.data (), n_candidates, NULL, 0,
3708 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->linkage_name (),
3709 context_type, parse_completion);
3710 if (i < 0)
3711 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3712 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3713 }
3714 else
3715 {
3716 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"),
3717 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
3718 user_select_syms (candidates.data (), n_candidates, 1);
3719 i = 0;
3720 }
3721
3722 exp->elts[pc + 1].block = candidates[i].block;
3723 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol = candidates[i].symbol;
3724 tracker->update (candidates[i]);
3725 }
3726
3727 if (deprocedure_p
3728 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol))
3729 == TYPE_CODE_FUNC))
3730 {
3731 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, 0, 4,
3732 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol,
3733 exp->elts[pc + 1].block);
3734 exp = expp->get ();
3735 }
3736 break;
3737
3738 case OP_FUNCALL:
3739 {
3740 if (exp->elts[pc + 3].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
3741 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
3742 {
3743 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3744 int n_candidates;
3745
3746 n_candidates =
3747 ada_lookup_symbol_list (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->linkage_name (),
3748 exp->elts[pc + 4].block, VAR_DOMAIN,
3749 &candidates);
3750
3751 if (n_candidates == 1)
3752 i = 0;
3753 else
3754 {
3755 i = ada_resolve_function
3756 (candidates.data (), n_candidates,
3757 argvec, nargs,
3758 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->linkage_name (),
3759 context_type, parse_completion);
3760 if (i < 0)
3761 error (_("Could not find a match for %s"),
3762 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->print_name ());
3763 }
3764
3765 exp->elts[pc + 4].block = candidates[i].block;
3766 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = candidates[i].symbol;
3767 tracker->update (candidates[i]);
3768 }
3769 }
3770 break;
3771 case BINOP_ADD:
3772 case BINOP_SUB:
3773 case BINOP_MUL:
3774 case BINOP_DIV:
3775 case BINOP_REM:
3776 case BINOP_MOD:
3777 case BINOP_CONCAT:
3778 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
3779 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
3780 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
3781 case BINOP_EQUAL:
3782 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
3783 case BINOP_LESS:
3784 case BINOP_GTR:
3785 case BINOP_LEQ:
3786 case BINOP_GEQ:
3787 case BINOP_EXP:
3788 case UNOP_NEG:
3789 case UNOP_PLUS:
3790 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
3791 case UNOP_ABS:
3792 if (possible_user_operator_p (op, argvec))
3793 {
3794 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
3795 int n_candidates;
3796
3797 n_candidates =
3798 ada_lookup_symbol_list (ada_decoded_op_name (op),
3799 NULL, VAR_DOMAIN,
3800 &candidates);
3801
3802 i = ada_resolve_function (candidates.data (), n_candidates, argvec,
3803 nargs, ada_decoded_op_name (op), NULL,
3804 parse_completion);
3805 if (i < 0)
3806 break;
3807
3808 replace_operator_with_call (expp, pc, nargs, 1,
3809 candidates[i].symbol,
3810 candidates[i].block);
3811 exp = expp->get ();
3812 }
3813 break;
3814
3815 case OP_TYPE:
3816 case OP_REGISTER:
3817 return NULL;
3818 }
3819
3820 *pos = pc;
3821 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE)
3822 return evaluate_var_msym_value (EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS,
3823 exp->elts[pc + 1].objfile,
3824 exp->elts[pc + 2].msymbol);
3825 else
3826 return evaluate_subexp_type (exp, pos);
3827 }
3828
3829 /* Return non-zero if formal type FTYPE matches actual type ATYPE. If
3830 MAY_DEREF is non-zero, the formal may be a pointer and the actual
3831 a non-pointer. */
3832 /* The term "match" here is rather loose. The match is heuristic and
3833 liberal. */
3834
3835 static int
3836 ada_type_match (struct type *ftype, struct type *atype, int may_deref)
3837 {
3838 ftype = ada_check_typedef (ftype);
3839 atype = ada_check_typedef (atype);
3840
3841 if (TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3842 ftype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype);
3843 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
3844 atype = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype);
3845
3846 switch (TYPE_CODE (ftype))
3847 {
3848 default:
3849 return TYPE_CODE (ftype) == TYPE_CODE (atype);
3850 case TYPE_CODE_PTR:
3851 if (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
3852 return ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype),
3853 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (atype), 0);
3854 else
3855 return (may_deref
3856 && ada_type_match (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (ftype), atype, 0));
3857 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3858 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3859 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3860 switch (TYPE_CODE (atype))
3861 {
3862 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
3863 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
3864 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
3865 return 1;
3866 default:
3867 return 0;
3868 }
3869
3870 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
3871 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3872 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3873
3874 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
3875 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ftype))
3876 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
3877 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3878 else
3879 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
3880 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (atype));
3881
3882 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
3883 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
3884 return (TYPE_CODE (atype) == TYPE_CODE (ftype));
3885 }
3886 }
3887
3888 /* Return non-zero if the formals of FUNC "sufficiently match" the
3889 vector of actual argument types ACTUALS of size N_ACTUALS. FUNC
3890 may also be an enumeral, in which case it is treated as a 0-
3891 argument function. */
3892
3893 static int
3894 ada_args_match (struct symbol *func, struct value **actuals, int n_actuals)
3895 {
3896 int i;
3897 struct type *func_type = SYMBOL_TYPE (func);
3898
3899 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (func) == LOC_CONST
3900 && TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3901 return (n_actuals == 0);
3902 else if (func_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (func_type) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3903 return 0;
3904
3905 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (func_type) != n_actuals)
3906 return 0;
3907
3908 for (i = 0; i < n_actuals; i += 1)
3909 {
3910 if (actuals[i] == NULL)
3911 return 0;
3912 else
3913 {
3914 struct type *ftype = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (func_type,
3915 i));
3916 struct type *atype = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actuals[i]));
3917
3918 if (!ada_type_match (ftype, atype, 1))
3919 return 0;
3920 }
3921 }
3922 return 1;
3923 }
3924
3925 /* False iff function type FUNC_TYPE definitely does not produce a value
3926 compatible with type CONTEXT_TYPE. Conservatively returns 1 if
3927 FUNC_TYPE is not a valid function type with a non-null return type
3928 or an enumerated type. A null CONTEXT_TYPE indicates any non-void type. */
3929
3930 static int
3931 return_match (struct type *func_type, struct type *context_type)
3932 {
3933 struct type *return_type;
3934
3935 if (func_type == NULL)
3936 return 1;
3937
3938 if (TYPE_CODE (func_type) == TYPE_CODE_FUNC)
3939 return_type = get_base_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (func_type));
3940 else
3941 return_type = get_base_type (func_type);
3942 if (return_type == NULL)
3943 return 1;
3944
3945 context_type = get_base_type (context_type);
3946
3947 if (TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
3948 return context_type == NULL || return_type == context_type;
3949 else if (context_type == NULL)
3950 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID;
3951 else
3952 return TYPE_CODE (return_type) == TYPE_CODE (context_type);
3953 }
3954
3955
3956 /* Returns the index in SYMS[0..NSYMS-1] that contains the symbol for the
3957 function (if any) that matches the types of the NARGS arguments in
3958 ARGS. If CONTEXT_TYPE is non-null and there is at least one match
3959 that returns that type, then eliminate matches that don't. If
3960 CONTEXT_TYPE is void and there is at least one match that does not
3961 return void, eliminate all matches that do.
3962
3963 Asks the user if there is more than one match remaining. Returns -1
3964 if there is no such symbol or none is selected. NAME is used
3965 solely for messages. May re-arrange and modify SYMS in
3966 the process; the index returned is for the modified vector. */
3967
3968 static int
3969 ada_resolve_function (struct block_symbol syms[],
3970 int nsyms, struct value **args, int nargs,
3971 const char *name, struct type *context_type,
3972 int parse_completion)
3973 {
3974 int fallback;
3975 int k;
3976 int m; /* Number of hits */
3977
3978 m = 0;
3979 /* In the first pass of the loop, we only accept functions matching
3980 context_type. If none are found, we add a second pass of the loop
3981 where every function is accepted. */
3982 for (fallback = 0; m == 0 && fallback < 2; fallback++)
3983 {
3984 for (k = 0; k < nsyms; k += 1)
3985 {
3986 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[k].symbol));
3987
3988 if (ada_args_match (syms[k].symbol, args, nargs)
3989 && (fallback || return_match (type, context_type)))
3990 {
3991 syms[m] = syms[k];
3992 m += 1;
3993 }
3994 }
3995 }
3996
3997 /* If we got multiple matches, ask the user which one to use. Don't do this
3998 interactive thing during completion, though, as the purpose of the
3999 completion is providing a list of all possible matches. Prompting the
4000 user to filter it down would be completely unexpected in this case. */
4001 if (m == 0)
4002 return -1;
4003 else if (m > 1 && !parse_completion)
4004 {
4005 printf_filtered (_("Multiple matches for %s\n"), name);
4006 user_select_syms (syms, m, 1);
4007 return 0;
4008 }
4009 return 0;
4010 }
4011
4012 /* Replace the operator of length OPLEN at position PC in *EXPP with a call
4013 on the function identified by SYM and BLOCK, and taking NARGS
4014 arguments. Update *EXPP as needed to hold more space. */
4015
4016 static void
4017 replace_operator_with_call (expression_up *expp, int pc, int nargs,
4018 int oplen, struct symbol *sym,
4019 const struct block *block)
4020 {
4021 /* A new expression, with 6 more elements (3 for funcall, 4 for function
4022 symbol, -oplen for operator being replaced). */
4023 struct expression *newexp = (struct expression *)
4024 xzalloc (sizeof (struct expression)
4025 + EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES ((*expp)->nelts + 7 - oplen));
4026 struct expression *exp = expp->get ();
4027
4028 newexp->nelts = exp->nelts + 7 - oplen;
4029 newexp->language_defn = exp->language_defn;
4030 newexp->gdbarch = exp->gdbarch;
4031 memcpy (newexp->elts, exp->elts, EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (pc));
4032 memcpy (newexp->elts + pc + 7, exp->elts + pc + oplen,
4033 EXP_ELEM_TO_BYTES (exp->nelts - pc - oplen));
4034
4035 newexp->elts[pc].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 2].opcode = OP_FUNCALL;
4036 newexp->elts[pc + 1].longconst = (LONGEST) nargs;
4037
4038 newexp->elts[pc + 3].opcode = newexp->elts[pc + 6].opcode = OP_VAR_VALUE;
4039 newexp->elts[pc + 4].block = block;
4040 newexp->elts[pc + 5].symbol = sym;
4041
4042 expp->reset (newexp);
4043 }
4044
4045 /* Type-class predicates */
4046
4047 /* True iff TYPE is numeric (i.e., an INT, RANGE (of numeric type),
4048 or FLOAT). */
4049
4050 static int
4051 numeric_type_p (struct type *type)
4052 {
4053 if (type == NULL)
4054 return 0;
4055 else
4056 {
4057 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
4058 {
4059 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4060 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4061 return 1;
4062 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4063 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4064 || numeric_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4065 default:
4066 return 0;
4067 }
4068 }
4069 }
4070
4071 /* True iff TYPE is integral (an INT or RANGE of INTs). */
4072
4073 static int
4074 integer_type_p (struct type *type)
4075 {
4076 if (type == NULL)
4077 return 0;
4078 else
4079 {
4080 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
4081 {
4082 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4083 return 1;
4084 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4085 return (type == TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)
4086 || integer_type_p (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
4087 default:
4088 return 0;
4089 }
4090 }
4091 }
4092
4093 /* True iff TYPE is scalar (INT, RANGE, FLOAT, ENUM). */
4094
4095 static int
4096 scalar_type_p (struct type *type)
4097 {
4098 if (type == NULL)
4099 return 0;
4100 else
4101 {
4102 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
4103 {
4104 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4105 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4106 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4107 case TYPE_CODE_FLT:
4108 return 1;
4109 default:
4110 return 0;
4111 }
4112 }
4113 }
4114
4115 /* True iff TYPE is discrete (INT, RANGE, ENUM). */
4116
4117 static int
4118 discrete_type_p (struct type *type)
4119 {
4120 if (type == NULL)
4121 return 0;
4122 else
4123 {
4124 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
4125 {
4126 case TYPE_CODE_INT:
4127 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
4128 case TYPE_CODE_ENUM:
4129 case TYPE_CODE_BOOL:
4130 return 1;
4131 default:
4132 return 0;
4133 }
4134 }
4135 }
4136
4137 /* Returns non-zero if OP with operands in the vector ARGS could be
4138 a user-defined function. Errs on the side of pre-defined operators
4139 (i.e., result 0). */
4140
4141 static int
4142 possible_user_operator_p (enum exp_opcode op, struct value *args[])
4143 {
4144 struct type *type0 =
4145 (args[0] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[0]));
4146 struct type *type1 =
4147 (args[1] == NULL) ? NULL : ada_check_typedef (value_type (args[1]));
4148
4149 if (type0 == NULL)
4150 return 0;
4151
4152 switch (op)
4153 {
4154 default:
4155 return 0;
4156
4157 case BINOP_ADD:
4158 case BINOP_SUB:
4159 case BINOP_MUL:
4160 case BINOP_DIV:
4161 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && numeric_type_p (type1)));
4162
4163 case BINOP_REM:
4164 case BINOP_MOD:
4165 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
4166 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
4167 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
4168 return (!(integer_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4169
4170 case BINOP_EQUAL:
4171 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
4172 case BINOP_LESS:
4173 case BINOP_GTR:
4174 case BINOP_LEQ:
4175 case BINOP_GEQ:
4176 return (!(scalar_type_p (type0) && scalar_type_p (type1)));
4177
4178 case BINOP_CONCAT:
4179 return !ada_is_array_type (type0) || !ada_is_array_type (type1);
4180
4181 case BINOP_EXP:
4182 return (!(numeric_type_p (type0) && integer_type_p (type1)));
4183
4184 case UNOP_NEG:
4185 case UNOP_PLUS:
4186 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
4187 case UNOP_ABS:
4188 return (!numeric_type_p (type0));
4189
4190 }
4191 }
4192 \f
4193 /* Renaming */
4194
4195 /* NOTES:
4196
4197 1. In the following, we assume that a renaming type's name may
4198 have an ___XD suffix. It would be nice if this went away at some
4199 point.
4200 2. We handle both the (old) purely type-based representation of
4201 renamings and the (new) variable-based encoding. At some point,
4202 it is devoutly to be hoped that the former goes away
4203 (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09).
4204 3. Subprogram renamings are not implemented, although the XRS
4205 suffix is recognized (FIXME: hilfinger-2007-07-09). */
4206
4207 /* If SYM encodes a renaming,
4208
4209 <renaming> renames <renamed entity>,
4210
4211 sets *LEN to the length of the renamed entity's name,
4212 *RENAMED_ENTITY to that name (not null-terminated), and *RENAMING_EXPR to
4213 the string describing the subcomponent selected from the renamed
4214 entity. Returns ADA_NOT_RENAMING if SYM does not encode a renaming
4215 (in which case, the values of *RENAMED_ENTITY, *LEN, and *RENAMING_EXPR
4216 are undefined). Otherwise, returns a value indicating the category
4217 of entity renamed: an object (ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING), exception
4218 (ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING), package (ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING), or
4219 subprogram (ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING). Does no allocation; the
4220 strings returned in *RENAMED_ENTITY and *RENAMING_EXPR should not be
4221 deallocated. The values of RENAMED_ENTITY, LEN, or RENAMING_EXPR
4222 may be NULL, in which case they are not assigned.
4223
4224 [Currently, however, GCC does not generate subprogram renamings.] */
4225
4226 enum ada_renaming_category
4227 ada_parse_renaming (struct symbol *sym,
4228 const char **renamed_entity, int *len,
4229 const char **renaming_expr)
4230 {
4231 enum ada_renaming_category kind;
4232 const char *info;
4233 const char *suffix;
4234
4235 if (sym == NULL)
4236 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4237 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
4238 {
4239 default:
4240 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4241 case LOC_LOCAL:
4242 case LOC_STATIC:
4243 case LOC_COMPUTED:
4244 case LOC_OPTIMIZED_OUT:
4245 info = strstr (sym->linkage_name (), "___XR");
4246 if (info == NULL)
4247 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4248 switch (info[5])
4249 {
4250 case '_':
4251 kind = ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING;
4252 info += 6;
4253 break;
4254 case 'E':
4255 kind = ADA_EXCEPTION_RENAMING;
4256 info += 7;
4257 break;
4258 case 'P':
4259 kind = ADA_PACKAGE_RENAMING;
4260 info += 7;
4261 break;
4262 case 'S':
4263 kind = ADA_SUBPROGRAM_RENAMING;
4264 info += 7;
4265 break;
4266 default:
4267 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4268 }
4269 }
4270
4271 if (renamed_entity != NULL)
4272 *renamed_entity = info;
4273 suffix = strstr (info, "___XE");
4274 if (suffix == NULL || suffix == info)
4275 return ADA_NOT_RENAMING;
4276 if (len != NULL)
4277 *len = strlen (info) - strlen (suffix);
4278 suffix += 5;
4279 if (renaming_expr != NULL)
4280 *renaming_expr = suffix;
4281 return kind;
4282 }
4283
4284 /* Compute the value of the given RENAMING_SYM, which is expected to
4285 be a symbol encoding a renaming expression. BLOCK is the block
4286 used to evaluate the renaming. */
4287
4288 static struct value *
4289 ada_read_renaming_var_value (struct symbol *renaming_sym,
4290 const struct block *block)
4291 {
4292 const char *sym_name;
4293
4294 sym_name = renaming_sym->linkage_name ();
4295 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&sym_name, 0, block, 0);
4296 return evaluate_expression (expr.get ());
4297 }
4298 \f
4299
4300 /* Evaluation: Function Calls */
4301
4302 /* Return an lvalue containing the value VAL. This is the identity on
4303 lvalues, and otherwise has the side-effect of allocating memory
4304 in the inferior where a copy of the value contents is copied. */
4305
4306 static struct value *
4307 ensure_lval (struct value *val)
4308 {
4309 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == not_lval
4310 || VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_internalvar)
4311 {
4312 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (value_type (val)));
4313 const CORE_ADDR addr =
4314 value_as_long (value_allocate_space_in_inferior (len));
4315
4316 VALUE_LVAL (val) = lval_memory;
4317 set_value_address (val, addr);
4318 write_memory (addr, value_contents (val), len);
4319 }
4320
4321 return val;
4322 }
4323
4324 /* Given ARG, a value of type (pointer or reference to a)*
4325 structure/union, extract the component named NAME from the ultimate
4326 target structure/union and return it as a value with its
4327 appropriate type.
4328
4329 The routine searches for NAME among all members of the structure itself
4330 and (recursively) among all members of any wrapper members
4331 (e.g., '_parent').
4332
4333 If NO_ERR, then simply return NULL in case of error, rather than
4334 calling error. */
4335
4336 static struct value *
4337 ada_value_struct_elt (struct value *arg, const char *name, int no_err)
4338 {
4339 struct type *t, *t1;
4340 struct value *v;
4341 int check_tag;
4342
4343 v = NULL;
4344 t1 = t = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg));
4345 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4346 {
4347 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
4348 if (t1 == NULL)
4349 goto BadValue;
4350 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
4351 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4352 {
4353 arg = coerce_ref (arg);
4354 t = t1;
4355 }
4356 }
4357
4358 while (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4359 {
4360 t1 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t);
4361 if (t1 == NULL)
4362 goto BadValue;
4363 t1 = ada_check_typedef (t1);
4364 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4365 {
4366 arg = value_ind (arg);
4367 t = t1;
4368 }
4369 else
4370 break;
4371 }
4372
4373 if (TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT && TYPE_CODE (t1) != TYPE_CODE_UNION)
4374 goto BadValue;
4375
4376 if (t1 == t)
4377 v = ada_search_struct_field (name, arg, 0, t);
4378 else
4379 {
4380 int bit_offset, bit_size, byte_offset;
4381 struct type *field_type;
4382 CORE_ADDR address;
4383
4384 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4385 address = value_address (ada_value_ind (arg));
4386 else
4387 address = value_address (ada_coerce_ref (arg));
4388
4389 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
4390 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
4391 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
4392 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
4393 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
4394
4395 if (ada_is_tagged_type (t1, 0)
4396 || (TYPE_CODE (t1) == TYPE_CODE_REF
4397 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (t1), 0)))
4398 {
4399 /* We first try to find the searched field in the current type.
4400 If not found then let's look in the fixed type. */
4401
4402 if (!find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
4403 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
4404 &bit_size, NULL))
4405 check_tag = 1;
4406 else
4407 check_tag = 0;
4408 }
4409 else
4410 check_tag = 0;
4411
4412 /* Convert to fixed type in all cases, so that we have proper
4413 offsets to each field in unconstrained record types. */
4414 t1 = ada_to_fixed_type (ada_get_base_type (t1), NULL,
4415 address, NULL, check_tag);
4416
4417 if (find_struct_field (name, t1, 0,
4418 &field_type, &byte_offset, &bit_offset,
4419 &bit_size, NULL))
4420 {
4421 if (bit_size != 0)
4422 {
4423 if (TYPE_CODE (t) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4424 arg = ada_coerce_ref (arg);
4425 else
4426 arg = ada_value_ind (arg);
4427 v = ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg, NULL, byte_offset,
4428 bit_offset, bit_size,
4429 field_type);
4430 }
4431 else
4432 v = value_at_lazy (field_type, address + byte_offset);
4433 }
4434 }
4435
4436 if (v != NULL || no_err)
4437 return v;
4438 else
4439 error (_("There is no member named %s."), name);
4440
4441 BadValue:
4442 if (no_err)
4443 return NULL;
4444 else
4445 error (_("Attempt to extract a component of "
4446 "a value that is not a record."));
4447 }
4448
4449 /* Return the value ACTUAL, converted to be an appropriate value for a
4450 formal of type FORMAL_TYPE. Use *SP as a stack pointer for
4451 allocating any necessary descriptors (fat pointers), or copies of
4452 values not residing in memory, updating it as needed. */
4453
4454 struct value *
4455 ada_convert_actual (struct value *actual, struct type *formal_type0)
4456 {
4457 struct type *actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4458 struct type *formal_type = ada_check_typedef (formal_type0);
4459 struct type *formal_target =
4460 TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4461 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (formal_type)) : formal_type;
4462 struct type *actual_target =
4463 TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4464 ? ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (actual_type)) : actual_type;
4465
4466 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (formal_target)
4467 && TYPE_CODE (actual_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
4468 return make_array_descriptor (formal_type, actual);
4469 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
4470 || TYPE_CODE (formal_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
4471 {
4472 struct value *result;
4473
4474 if (TYPE_CODE (formal_target) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
4475 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (actual_target))
4476 result = desc_data (actual);
4477 else if (TYPE_CODE (formal_type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4478 {
4479 if (VALUE_LVAL (actual) != lval_memory)
4480 {
4481 struct value *val;
4482
4483 actual_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (actual));
4484 val = allocate_value (actual_type);
4485 memcpy ((char *) value_contents_raw (val),
4486 (char *) value_contents (actual),
4487 TYPE_LENGTH (actual_type));
4488 actual = ensure_lval (val);
4489 }
4490 result = value_addr (actual);
4491 }
4492 else
4493 return actual;
4494 return value_cast_pointers (formal_type, result, 0);
4495 }
4496 else if (TYPE_CODE (actual_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4497 return ada_value_ind (actual);
4498 else if (ada_is_aligner_type (formal_type))
4499 {
4500 /* We need to turn this parameter into an aligner type
4501 as well. */
4502 struct value *aligner = allocate_value (formal_type);
4503 struct value *component = ada_value_struct_elt (aligner, "F", 0);
4504
4505 value_assign_to_component (aligner, component, actual);
4506 return aligner;
4507 }
4508
4509 return actual;
4510 }
4511
4512 /* Convert VALUE (which must be an address) to a CORE_ADDR that is a pointer of
4513 type TYPE. This is usually an inefficient no-op except on some targets
4514 (such as AVR) where the representation of a pointer and an address
4515 differs. */
4516
4517 static CORE_ADDR
4518 value_pointer (struct value *value, struct type *type)
4519 {
4520 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_type_arch (type);
4521 unsigned len = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
4522 gdb_byte *buf = (gdb_byte *) alloca (len);
4523 CORE_ADDR addr;
4524
4525 addr = value_address (value);
4526 gdbarch_address_to_pointer (gdbarch, type, buf, addr);
4527 addr = extract_unsigned_integer (buf, len, type_byte_order (type));
4528 return addr;
4529 }
4530
4531
4532 /* Push a descriptor of type TYPE for array value ARR on the stack at
4533 *SP, updating *SP to reflect the new descriptor. Return either
4534 an lvalue representing the new descriptor, or (if TYPE is a pointer-
4535 to-descriptor type rather than a descriptor type), a struct value *
4536 representing a pointer to this descriptor. */
4537
4538 static struct value *
4539 make_array_descriptor (struct type *type, struct value *arr)
4540 {
4541 struct type *bounds_type = desc_bounds_type (type);
4542 struct type *desc_type = desc_base_type (type);
4543 struct value *descriptor = allocate_value (desc_type);
4544 struct value *bounds = allocate_value (bounds_type);
4545 int i;
4546
4547 for (i = ada_array_arity (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arr)));
4548 i > 0; i -= 1)
4549 {
4550 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4551 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 0),
4552 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 0),
4553 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 0));
4554 modify_field (value_type (bounds), value_contents_writeable (bounds),
4555 ada_array_bound (arr, i, 1),
4556 desc_bound_bitpos (bounds_type, i, 1),
4557 desc_bound_bitsize (bounds_type, i, 1));
4558 }
4559
4560 bounds = ensure_lval (bounds);
4561
4562 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4563 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4564 value_pointer (ensure_lval (arr),
4565 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 0)),
4566 fat_pntr_data_bitpos (desc_type),
4567 fat_pntr_data_bitsize (desc_type));
4568
4569 modify_field (value_type (descriptor),
4570 value_contents_writeable (descriptor),
4571 value_pointer (bounds,
4572 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, 1)),
4573 fat_pntr_bounds_bitpos (desc_type),
4574 fat_pntr_bounds_bitsize (desc_type));
4575
4576 descriptor = ensure_lval (descriptor);
4577
4578 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
4579 return value_addr (descriptor);
4580 else
4581 return descriptor;
4582 }
4583 \f
4584 /* Symbol Cache Module */
4585
4586 /* Performance measurements made as of 2010-01-15 indicate that
4587 this cache does bring some noticeable improvements. Depending
4588 on the type of entity being printed, the cache can make it as much
4589 as an order of magnitude faster than without it.
4590
4591 The descriptive type DWARF extension has significantly reduced
4592 the need for this cache, at least when DWARF is being used. However,
4593 even in this case, some expensive name-based symbol searches are still
4594 sometimes necessary - to find an XVZ variable, mostly. */
4595
4596 /* Initialize the contents of SYM_CACHE. */
4597
4598 static void
4599 ada_init_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4600 {
4601 obstack_init (&sym_cache->cache_space);
4602 memset (sym_cache->root, '\000', sizeof (sym_cache->root));
4603 }
4604
4605 /* Free the memory used by SYM_CACHE. */
4606
4607 static void
4608 ada_free_symbol_cache (struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache)
4609 {
4610 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4611 xfree (sym_cache);
4612 }
4613
4614 /* Return the symbol cache associated to the given program space PSPACE.
4615 If not allocated for this PSPACE yet, allocate and initialize one. */
4616
4617 static struct ada_symbol_cache *
4618 ada_get_symbol_cache (struct program_space *pspace)
4619 {
4620 struct ada_pspace_data *pspace_data = get_ada_pspace_data (pspace);
4621
4622 if (pspace_data->sym_cache == NULL)
4623 {
4624 pspace_data->sym_cache = XCNEW (struct ada_symbol_cache);
4625 ada_init_symbol_cache (pspace_data->sym_cache);
4626 }
4627
4628 return pspace_data->sym_cache;
4629 }
4630
4631 /* Clear all entries from the symbol cache. */
4632
4633 static void
4634 ada_clear_symbol_cache (void)
4635 {
4636 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4637 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4638
4639 obstack_free (&sym_cache->cache_space, NULL);
4640 ada_init_symbol_cache (sym_cache);
4641 }
4642
4643 /* Search our cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4644 Return it if found, or NULL otherwise. */
4645
4646 static struct cache_entry **
4647 find_entry (const char *name, domain_enum domain)
4648 {
4649 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4650 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4651 int h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4652 struct cache_entry **e;
4653
4654 for (e = &sym_cache->root[h]; *e != NULL; e = &(*e)->next)
4655 {
4656 if (domain == (*e)->domain && strcmp (name, (*e)->name) == 0)
4657 return e;
4658 }
4659 return NULL;
4660 }
4661
4662 /* Search the symbol cache for an entry matching NAME and DOMAIN.
4663 Return 1 if found, 0 otherwise.
4664
4665 If an entry was found and SYM is not NULL, set *SYM to the entry's
4666 SYM. Same principle for BLOCK if not NULL. */
4667
4668 static int
4669 lookup_cached_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain,
4670 struct symbol **sym, const struct block **block)
4671 {
4672 struct cache_entry **e = find_entry (name, domain);
4673
4674 if (e == NULL)
4675 return 0;
4676 if (sym != NULL)
4677 *sym = (*e)->sym;
4678 if (block != NULL)
4679 *block = (*e)->block;
4680 return 1;
4681 }
4682
4683 /* Assuming that (SYM, BLOCK) is the result of the lookup of NAME
4684 in domain DOMAIN, save this result in our symbol cache. */
4685
4686 static void
4687 cache_symbol (const char *name, domain_enum domain, struct symbol *sym,
4688 const struct block *block)
4689 {
4690 struct ada_symbol_cache *sym_cache
4691 = ada_get_symbol_cache (current_program_space);
4692 int h;
4693 struct cache_entry *e;
4694
4695 /* Symbols for builtin types don't have a block.
4696 For now don't cache such symbols. */
4697 if (sym != NULL && !SYMBOL_OBJFILE_OWNED (sym))
4698 return;
4699
4700 /* If the symbol is a local symbol, then do not cache it, as a search
4701 for that symbol depends on the context. To determine whether
4702 the symbol is local or not, we check the block where we found it
4703 against the global and static blocks of its associated symtab. */
4704 if (sym
4705 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4706 GLOBAL_BLOCK) != block
4707 && BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (SYMTAB_BLOCKVECTOR (symbol_symtab (sym)),
4708 STATIC_BLOCK) != block)
4709 return;
4710
4711 h = msymbol_hash (name) % HASH_SIZE;
4712 e = XOBNEW (&sym_cache->cache_space, cache_entry);
4713 e->next = sym_cache->root[h];
4714 sym_cache->root[h] = e;
4715 e->name = obstack_strdup (&sym_cache->cache_space, name);
4716 e->sym = sym;
4717 e->domain = domain;
4718 e->block = block;
4719 }
4720 \f
4721 /* Symbol Lookup */
4722
4723 /* Return the symbol name match type that should be used used when
4724 searching for all symbols matching LOOKUP_NAME.
4725
4726 LOOKUP_NAME is expected to be a symbol name after transformation
4727 for Ada lookups. */
4728
4729 static symbol_name_match_type
4730 name_match_type_from_name (const char *lookup_name)
4731 {
4732 return (strstr (lookup_name, "__") == NULL
4733 ? symbol_name_match_type::WILD
4734 : symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
4735 }
4736
4737 /* Return the result of a standard (literal, C-like) lookup of NAME in
4738 given DOMAIN, visible from lexical block BLOCK. */
4739
4740 static struct symbol *
4741 standard_lookup (const char *name, const struct block *block,
4742 domain_enum domain)
4743 {
4744 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
4745 struct block_symbol sym = {};
4746
4747 if (lookup_cached_symbol (name, domain, &sym.symbol, NULL))
4748 return sym.symbol;
4749 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (name, block, domain, &sym);
4750 cache_symbol (name, domain, sym.symbol, sym.block);
4751 return sym.symbol;
4752 }
4753
4754
4755 /* Non-zero iff there is at least one non-function/non-enumeral symbol
4756 in the symbol fields of SYMS[0..N-1]. We treat enumerals as functions,
4757 since they contend in overloading in the same way. */
4758 static int
4759 is_nonfunction (struct block_symbol syms[], int n)
4760 {
4761 int i;
4762
4763 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
4764 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != TYPE_CODE_FUNC
4765 && (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4766 || SYMBOL_CLASS (syms[i].symbol) != LOC_CONST))
4767 return 1;
4768
4769 return 0;
4770 }
4771
4772 /* If true (non-zero), then TYPE0 and TYPE1 represent equivalent
4773 struct types. Otherwise, they may not. */
4774
4775 static int
4776 equiv_types (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
4777 {
4778 if (type0 == type1)
4779 return 1;
4780 if (type0 == NULL || type1 == NULL
4781 || TYPE_CODE (type0) != TYPE_CODE (type1))
4782 return 0;
4783 if ((TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
4784 || TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
4785 && ada_type_name (type0) != NULL && ada_type_name (type1) != NULL
4786 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type0), ada_type_name (type1)) == 0)
4787 return 1;
4788
4789 return 0;
4790 }
4791
4792 /* True iff SYM0 represents the same entity as SYM1, or one that is
4793 no more defined than that of SYM1. */
4794
4795 static int
4796 lesseq_defined_than (struct symbol *sym0, struct symbol *sym1)
4797 {
4798 if (sym0 == sym1)
4799 return 1;
4800 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym0) != SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym1)
4801 || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0) != SYMBOL_CLASS (sym1))
4802 return 0;
4803
4804 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym0))
4805 {
4806 case LOC_UNDEF:
4807 return 1;
4808 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
4809 {
4810 struct type *type0 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0);
4811 struct type *type1 = SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1);
4812 const char *name0 = sym0->linkage_name ();
4813 const char *name1 = sym1->linkage_name ();
4814 int len0 = strlen (name0);
4815
4816 return
4817 TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE (type1)
4818 && (equiv_types (type0, type1)
4819 || (len0 < strlen (name1) && strncmp (name0, name1, len0) == 0
4820 && startswith (name1 + len0, "___XV")));
4821 }
4822 case LOC_CONST:
4823 return SYMBOL_VALUE (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE (sym1)
4824 && equiv_types (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym0), SYMBOL_TYPE (sym1));
4825
4826 case LOC_STATIC:
4827 {
4828 const char *name0 = sym0->linkage_name ();
4829 const char *name1 = sym1->linkage_name ();
4830 return (strcmp (name0, name1) == 0
4831 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym0) == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym1));
4832 }
4833
4834 default:
4835 return 0;
4836 }
4837 }
4838
4839 /* Append (SYM,BLOCK,SYMTAB) to the end of the array of struct block_symbol
4840 records in OBSTACKP. Do nothing if SYM is a duplicate. */
4841
4842 static void
4843 add_defn_to_vec (struct obstack *obstackp,
4844 struct symbol *sym,
4845 const struct block *block)
4846 {
4847 int i;
4848 struct block_symbol *prevDefns = defns_collected (obstackp, 0);
4849
4850 /* Do not try to complete stub types, as the debugger is probably
4851 already scanning all symbols matching a certain name at the
4852 time when this function is called. Trying to replace the stub
4853 type by its associated full type will cause us to restart a scan
4854 which may lead to an infinite recursion. Instead, the client
4855 collecting the matching symbols will end up collecting several
4856 matches, with at least one of them complete. It can then filter
4857 out the stub ones if needed. */
4858
4859 for (i = num_defns_collected (obstackp) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
4860 {
4861 if (lesseq_defined_than (sym, prevDefns[i].symbol))
4862 return;
4863 else if (lesseq_defined_than (prevDefns[i].symbol, sym))
4864 {
4865 prevDefns[i].symbol = sym;
4866 prevDefns[i].block = block;
4867 return;
4868 }
4869 }
4870
4871 {
4872 struct block_symbol info;
4873
4874 info.symbol = sym;
4875 info.block = block;
4876 obstack_grow (obstackp, &info, sizeof (struct block_symbol));
4877 }
4878 }
4879
4880 /* Number of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in
4881 OBSTACKP. */
4882
4883 static int
4884 num_defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp)
4885 {
4886 return obstack_object_size (obstackp) / sizeof (struct block_symbol);
4887 }
4888
4889 /* Vector of block_symbol structures currently collected in current vector in
4890 OBSTACKP. If FINISH, close off the vector and return its final address. */
4891
4892 static struct block_symbol *
4893 defns_collected (struct obstack *obstackp, int finish)
4894 {
4895 if (finish)
4896 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_finish (obstackp);
4897 else
4898 return (struct block_symbol *) obstack_base (obstackp);
4899 }
4900
4901 /* Return a bound minimal symbol matching NAME according to Ada
4902 decoding rules. Returns an invalid symbol if there is no such
4903 minimal symbol. Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled
4904 specially: "standard__" is first stripped off, and only static and
4905 global symbols are searched. */
4906
4907 struct bound_minimal_symbol
4908 ada_lookup_simple_minsym (const char *name)
4909 {
4910 struct bound_minimal_symbol result;
4911
4912 memset (&result, 0, sizeof (result));
4913
4914 symbol_name_match_type match_type = name_match_type_from_name (name);
4915 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, match_type);
4916
4917 symbol_name_matcher_ftype *match_name
4918 = ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (lookup_name);
4919
4920 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
4921 {
4922 for (minimal_symbol *msymbol : objfile->msymbols ())
4923 {
4924 if (match_name (msymbol->linkage_name (), lookup_name, NULL)
4925 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msymbol) != mst_solib_trampoline)
4926 {
4927 result.minsym = msymbol;
4928 result.objfile = objfile;
4929 break;
4930 }
4931 }
4932 }
4933
4934 return result;
4935 }
4936
4937 /* For all subprograms that statically enclose the subprogram of the
4938 selected frame, add symbols matching identifier NAME in DOMAIN
4939 and their blocks to the list of data in OBSTACKP, as for
4940 ada_add_block_symbols (q.v.). If WILD_MATCH_P, treat as NAME
4941 with a wildcard prefix. */
4942
4943 static void
4944 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (struct obstack *obstackp,
4945 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
4946 domain_enum domain)
4947 {
4948 }
4949
4950 /* True if TYPE is definitely an artificial type supplied to a symbol
4951 for which no debugging information was given in the symbol file. */
4952
4953 static int
4954 is_nondebugging_type (struct type *type)
4955 {
4956 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
4957
4958 return (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "<variable, no debug info>") == 0);
4959 }
4960
4961 /* Return nonzero if TYPE1 and TYPE2 are two enumeration types
4962 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes.
4963
4964 This function assumes that TYPE1 and TYPE2 are both TYPE_CODE_ENUM
4965 types and that their number of enumerals is identical (in other
4966 words, TYPE_NFIELDS (type1) == TYPE_NFIELDS (type2)). */
4967
4968 static int
4969 ada_identical_enum_types_p (struct type *type1, struct type *type2)
4970 {
4971 int i;
4972
4973 /* The heuristic we use here is fairly conservative. We consider
4974 that 2 enumerate types are identical if they have the same
4975 number of enumerals and that all enumerals have the same
4976 underlying value and name. */
4977
4978 /* All enums in the type should have an identical underlying value. */
4979 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4980 if (TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type1, i) != TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type2, i))
4981 return 0;
4982
4983 /* All enumerals should also have the same name (modulo any numerical
4984 suffix). */
4985 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type1); i++)
4986 {
4987 const char *name_1 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i);
4988 const char *name_2 = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i);
4989 int len_1 = strlen (name_1);
4990 int len_2 = strlen (name_2);
4991
4992 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i), &len_1);
4993 ada_remove_trailing_digits (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i), &len_2);
4994 if (len_1 != len_2
4995 || strncmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type1, i),
4996 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type2, i),
4997 len_1) != 0)
4998 return 0;
4999 }
5000
5001 return 1;
5002 }
5003
5004 /* Return nonzero if all the symbols in SYMS are all enumeral symbols
5005 that are deemed "identical" for practical purposes. Sometimes,
5006 enumerals are not strictly identical, but their types are so similar
5007 that they can be considered identical.
5008
5009 For instance, consider the following code:
5010
5011 type Color is (Black, Red, Green, Blue, White);
5012 type RGB_Color is new Color range Red .. Blue;
5013
5014 Type RGB_Color is a subrange of an implicit type which is a copy
5015 of type Color. If we call that implicit type RGB_ColorB ("B" is
5016 for "Base Type"), then type RGB_ColorB is a copy of type Color.
5017 As a result, when an expression references any of the enumeral
5018 by name (Eg. "print green"), the expression is technically
5019 ambiguous and the user should be asked to disambiguate. But
5020 doing so would only hinder the user, since it wouldn't matter
5021 what choice he makes, the outcome would always be the same.
5022 So, for practical purposes, we consider them as the same. */
5023
5024 static int
5025 symbols_are_identical_enums (const std::vector<struct block_symbol> &syms)
5026 {
5027 int i;
5028
5029 /* Before performing a thorough comparison check of each type,
5030 we perform a series of inexpensive checks. We expect that these
5031 checks will quickly fail in the vast majority of cases, and thus
5032 help prevent the unnecessary use of a more expensive comparison.
5033 Said comparison also expects us to make some of these checks
5034 (see ada_identical_enum_types_p). */
5035
5036 /* Quick check: All symbols should have an enum type. */
5037 for (i = 0; i < syms.size (); i++)
5038 if (TYPE_CODE (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol)) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
5039 return 0;
5040
5041 /* Quick check: They should all have the same value. */
5042 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5043 if (SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[i].symbol) != SYMBOL_VALUE (syms[0].symbol))
5044 return 0;
5045
5046 /* Quick check: They should all have the same number of enumerals. */
5047 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5048 if (TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol))
5049 != TYPE_NFIELDS (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol)))
5050 return 0;
5051
5052 /* All the sanity checks passed, so we might have a set of
5053 identical enumeration types. Perform a more complete
5054 comparison of the type of each symbol. */
5055 for (i = 1; i < syms.size (); i++)
5056 if (!ada_identical_enum_types_p (SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[i].symbol),
5057 SYMBOL_TYPE (syms[0].symbol)))
5058 return 0;
5059
5060 return 1;
5061 }
5062
5063 /* Remove any non-debugging symbols in SYMS that definitely
5064 duplicate other symbols in the list (The only case I know of where
5065 this happens is when object files containing stabs-in-ecoff are
5066 linked with files containing ordinary ecoff debugging symbols (or no
5067 debugging symbols)). Modifies SYMS to squeeze out deleted entries.
5068 Returns the number of items in the modified list. */
5069
5070 static int
5071 remove_extra_symbols (std::vector<struct block_symbol> *syms)
5072 {
5073 int i, j;
5074
5075 /* We should never be called with less than 2 symbols, as there
5076 cannot be any extra symbol in that case. But it's easy to
5077 handle, since we have nothing to do in that case. */
5078 if (syms->size () < 2)
5079 return syms->size ();
5080
5081 i = 0;
5082 while (i < syms->size ())
5083 {
5084 int remove_p = 0;
5085
5086 /* If two symbols have the same name and one of them is a stub type,
5087 the get rid of the stub. */
5088
5089 if (TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[i].symbol))
5090 && (*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL)
5091 {
5092 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j++)
5093 {
5094 if (j != i
5095 && !TYPE_STUB (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[j].symbol))
5096 && (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5097 && strcmp ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name (),
5098 (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name ()) == 0)
5099 remove_p = 1;
5100 }
5101 }
5102
5103 /* Two symbols with the same name, same class and same address
5104 should be identical. */
5105
5106 else if ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5107 && SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[i].symbol) == LOC_STATIC
5108 && is_nondebugging_type (SYMBOL_TYPE ((*syms)[i].symbol)))
5109 {
5110 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5111 {
5112 if (i != j
5113 && (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name () != NULL
5114 && strcmp ((*syms)[i].symbol->linkage_name (),
5115 (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name ()) == 0
5116 && SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[i].symbol)
5117 == SYMBOL_CLASS ((*syms)[j].symbol)
5118 && SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS ((*syms)[i].symbol)
5119 == SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS ((*syms)[j].symbol))
5120 remove_p = 1;
5121 }
5122 }
5123
5124 if (remove_p)
5125 syms->erase (syms->begin () + i);
5126
5127 i += 1;
5128 }
5129
5130 /* If all the remaining symbols are identical enumerals, then
5131 just keep the first one and discard the rest.
5132
5133 Unlike what we did previously, we do not discard any entry
5134 unless they are ALL identical. This is because the symbol
5135 comparison is not a strict comparison, but rather a practical
5136 comparison. If all symbols are considered identical, then
5137 we can just go ahead and use the first one and discard the rest.
5138 But if we cannot reduce the list to a single element, we have
5139 to ask the user to disambiguate anyways. And if we have to
5140 present a multiple-choice menu, it's less confusing if the list
5141 isn't missing some choices that were identical and yet distinct. */
5142 if (symbols_are_identical_enums (*syms))
5143 syms->resize (1);
5144
5145 return syms->size ();
5146 }
5147
5148 /* Given a type that corresponds to a renaming entity, use the type name
5149 to extract the scope (package name or function name, fully qualified,
5150 and following the GNAT encoding convention) where this renaming has been
5151 defined. */
5152
5153 static std::string
5154 xget_renaming_scope (struct type *renaming_type)
5155 {
5156 /* The renaming types adhere to the following convention:
5157 <scope>__<rename>___<XR extension>.
5158 So, to extract the scope, we search for the "___XR" extension,
5159 and then backtrack until we find the first "__". */
5160
5161 const char *name = TYPE_NAME (renaming_type);
5162 const char *suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5163 const char *last;
5164
5165 /* Now, backtrack a bit until we find the first "__". Start looking
5166 at suffix - 3, as the <rename> part is at least one character long. */
5167
5168 for (last = suffix - 3; last > name; last--)
5169 if (last[0] == '_' && last[1] == '_')
5170 break;
5171
5172 /* Make a copy of scope and return it. */
5173 return std::string (name, last);
5174 }
5175
5176 /* Return nonzero if NAME corresponds to a package name. */
5177
5178 static int
5179 is_package_name (const char *name)
5180 {
5181 /* Here, We take advantage of the fact that no symbols are generated
5182 for packages, while symbols are generated for each function.
5183 So the condition for NAME represent a package becomes equivalent
5184 to NAME not existing in our list of symbols. There is only one
5185 small complication with library-level functions (see below). */
5186
5187 /* If it is a function that has not been defined at library level,
5188 then we should be able to look it up in the symbols. */
5189 if (standard_lookup (name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) != NULL)
5190 return 0;
5191
5192 /* Library-level function names start with "_ada_". See if function
5193 "_ada_" followed by NAME can be found. */
5194
5195 /* Do a quick check that NAME does not contain "__", since library-level
5196 functions names cannot contain "__" in them. */
5197 if (strstr (name, "__") != NULL)
5198 return 0;
5199
5200 std::string fun_name = string_printf ("_ada_%s", name);
5201
5202 return (standard_lookup (fun_name.c_str (), NULL, VAR_DOMAIN) == NULL);
5203 }
5204
5205 /* Return nonzero if SYM corresponds to a renaming entity that is
5206 not visible from FUNCTION_NAME. */
5207
5208 static int
5209 old_renaming_is_invisible (const struct symbol *sym, const char *function_name)
5210 {
5211 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF)
5212 return 0;
5213
5214 std::string scope = xget_renaming_scope (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
5215
5216 /* If the rename has been defined in a package, then it is visible. */
5217 if (is_package_name (scope.c_str ()))
5218 return 0;
5219
5220 /* Check that the rename is in the current function scope by checking
5221 that its name starts with SCOPE. */
5222
5223 /* If the function name starts with "_ada_", it means that it is
5224 a library-level function. Strip this prefix before doing the
5225 comparison, as the encoding for the renaming does not contain
5226 this prefix. */
5227 if (startswith (function_name, "_ada_"))
5228 function_name += 5;
5229
5230 return !startswith (function_name, scope.c_str ());
5231 }
5232
5233 /* Remove entries from SYMS that corresponds to a renaming entity that
5234 is not visible from the function associated with CURRENT_BLOCK or
5235 that is superfluous due to the presence of more specific renaming
5236 information. Places surviving symbols in the initial entries of
5237 SYMS and returns the number of surviving symbols.
5238
5239 Rationale:
5240 First, in cases where an object renaming is implemented as a
5241 reference variable, GNAT may produce both the actual reference
5242 variable and the renaming encoding. In this case, we discard the
5243 latter.
5244
5245 Second, GNAT emits a type following a specified encoding for each renaming
5246 entity. Unfortunately, STABS currently does not support the definition
5247 of types that are local to a given lexical block, so all renamings types
5248 are emitted at library level. As a consequence, if an application
5249 contains two renaming entities using the same name, and a user tries to
5250 print the value of one of these entities, the result of the ada symbol
5251 lookup will also contain the wrong renaming type.
5252
5253 This function partially covers for this limitation by attempting to
5254 remove from the SYMS list renaming symbols that should be visible
5255 from CURRENT_BLOCK. However, there does not seem be a 100% reliable
5256 method with the current information available. The implementation
5257 below has a couple of limitations (FIXME: brobecker-2003-05-12):
5258
5259 - When the user tries to print a rename in a function while there
5260 is another rename entity defined in a package: Normally, the
5261 rename in the function has precedence over the rename in the
5262 package, so the latter should be removed from the list. This is
5263 currently not the case.
5264
5265 - This function will incorrectly remove valid renames if
5266 the CURRENT_BLOCK corresponds to a function which symbol name
5267 has been changed by an "Export" pragma. As a consequence,
5268 the user will be unable to print such rename entities. */
5269
5270 static int
5271 remove_irrelevant_renamings (std::vector<struct block_symbol> *syms,
5272 const struct block *current_block)
5273 {
5274 struct symbol *current_function;
5275 const char *current_function_name;
5276 int i;
5277 int is_new_style_renaming;
5278
5279 /* If there is both a renaming foo___XR... encoded as a variable and
5280 a simple variable foo in the same block, discard the latter.
5281 First, zero out such symbols, then compress. */
5282 is_new_style_renaming = 0;
5283 for (i = 0; i < syms->size (); i += 1)
5284 {
5285 struct symbol *sym = (*syms)[i].symbol;
5286 const struct block *block = (*syms)[i].block;
5287 const char *name;
5288 const char *suffix;
5289
5290 if (sym == NULL || SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
5291 continue;
5292 name = sym->linkage_name ();
5293 suffix = strstr (name, "___XR");
5294
5295 if (suffix != NULL)
5296 {
5297 int name_len = suffix - name;
5298 int j;
5299
5300 is_new_style_renaming = 1;
5301 for (j = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5302 if (i != j && (*syms)[j].symbol != NULL
5303 && strncmp (name, (*syms)[j].symbol->linkage_name (),
5304 name_len) == 0
5305 && block == (*syms)[j].block)
5306 (*syms)[j].symbol = NULL;
5307 }
5308 }
5309 if (is_new_style_renaming)
5310 {
5311 int j, k;
5312
5313 for (j = k = 0; j < syms->size (); j += 1)
5314 if ((*syms)[j].symbol != NULL)
5315 {
5316 (*syms)[k] = (*syms)[j];
5317 k += 1;
5318 }
5319 return k;
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Extract the function name associated to CURRENT_BLOCK.
5323 Abort if unable to do so. */
5324
5325 if (current_block == NULL)
5326 return syms->size ();
5327
5328 current_function = block_linkage_function (current_block);
5329 if (current_function == NULL)
5330 return syms->size ();
5331
5332 current_function_name = current_function->linkage_name ();
5333 if (current_function_name == NULL)
5334 return syms->size ();
5335
5336 /* Check each of the symbols, and remove it from the list if it is
5337 a type corresponding to a renaming that is out of the scope of
5338 the current block. */
5339
5340 i = 0;
5341 while (i < syms->size ())
5342 {
5343 if (ada_parse_renaming ((*syms)[i].symbol, NULL, NULL, NULL)
5344 == ADA_OBJECT_RENAMING
5345 && old_renaming_is_invisible ((*syms)[i].symbol,
5346 current_function_name))
5347 syms->erase (syms->begin () + i);
5348 else
5349 i += 1;
5350 }
5351
5352 return syms->size ();
5353 }
5354
5355 /* Add to OBSTACKP all symbols from BLOCK (and its super-blocks)
5356 whose name and domain match NAME and DOMAIN respectively.
5357 If no match was found, then extend the search to "enclosing"
5358 routines (in other words, if we're inside a nested function,
5359 search the symbols defined inside the enclosing functions).
5360 If WILD_MATCH_P is nonzero, perform the naming matching in
5361 "wild" mode (see function "wild_match" for more info).
5362
5363 Note: This function assumes that OBSTACKP has 0 (zero) element in it. */
5364
5365 static void
5366 ada_add_local_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5367 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5368 const struct block *block, domain_enum domain)
5369 {
5370 int block_depth = 0;
5371
5372 while (block != NULL)
5373 {
5374 block_depth += 1;
5375 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain, NULL);
5376
5377 /* If we found a non-function match, assume that's the one. */
5378 if (is_nonfunction (defns_collected (obstackp, 0),
5379 num_defns_collected (obstackp)))
5380 return;
5381
5382 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
5383 }
5384
5385 /* If no luck so far, try to find NAME as a local symbol in some lexically
5386 enclosing subprogram. */
5387 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && block_depth > 2)
5388 add_symbols_from_enclosing_procs (obstackp, lookup_name, domain);
5389 }
5390
5391 /* An object of this type is used as the user_data argument when
5392 calling the map_matching_symbols method. */
5393
5394 struct match_data
5395 {
5396 struct objfile *objfile;
5397 struct obstack *obstackp;
5398 struct symbol *arg_sym;
5399 int found_sym;
5400 };
5401
5402 /* A callback for add_nonlocal_symbols that adds symbol, found in BSYM,
5403 to a list of symbols. DATA is a pointer to a struct match_data *
5404 containing the obstack that collects the symbol list, the file that SYM
5405 must come from, a flag indicating whether a non-argument symbol has
5406 been found in the current block, and the last argument symbol
5407 passed in SYM within the current block (if any). When SYM is null,
5408 marking the end of a block, the argument symbol is added if no
5409 other has been found. */
5410
5411 static bool
5412 aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (struct block_symbol *bsym,
5413 struct match_data *data)
5414 {
5415 const struct block *block = bsym->block;
5416 struct symbol *sym = bsym->symbol;
5417
5418 if (sym == NULL)
5419 {
5420 if (!data->found_sym && data->arg_sym != NULL)
5421 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5422 fixup_symbol_section (data->arg_sym, data->objfile),
5423 block);
5424 data->found_sym = 0;
5425 data->arg_sym = NULL;
5426 }
5427 else
5428 {
5429 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_UNRESOLVED)
5430 return true;
5431 else if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
5432 data->arg_sym = sym;
5433 else
5434 {
5435 data->found_sym = 1;
5436 add_defn_to_vec (data->obstackp,
5437 fixup_symbol_section (sym, data->objfile),
5438 block);
5439 }
5440 }
5441 return true;
5442 }
5443
5444 /* Helper for add_nonlocal_symbols. Find symbols in DOMAIN which are
5445 targeted by renamings matching LOOKUP_NAME in BLOCK. Add these
5446 symbols to OBSTACKP. Return whether we found such symbols. */
5447
5448 static int
5449 ada_add_block_renamings (struct obstack *obstackp,
5450 const struct block *block,
5451 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5452 domain_enum domain)
5453 {
5454 struct using_direct *renaming;
5455 int defns_mark = num_defns_collected (obstackp);
5456
5457 symbol_name_matcher_ftype *name_match
5458 = ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (lookup_name);
5459
5460 for (renaming = block_using (block);
5461 renaming != NULL;
5462 renaming = renaming->next)
5463 {
5464 const char *r_name;
5465
5466 /* Avoid infinite recursions: skip this renaming if we are actually
5467 already traversing it.
5468
5469 Currently, symbol lookup in Ada don't use the namespace machinery from
5470 C++/Fortran support: skip namespace imports that use them. */
5471 if (renaming->searched
5472 || (renaming->import_src != NULL
5473 && renaming->import_src[0] != '\0')
5474 || (renaming->import_dest != NULL
5475 && renaming->import_dest[0] != '\0'))
5476 continue;
5477 renaming->searched = 1;
5478
5479 /* TODO: here, we perform another name-based symbol lookup, which can
5480 pull its own multiple overloads. In theory, we should be able to do
5481 better in this case since, in DWARF, DW_AT_import is a DIE reference,
5482 not a simple name. But in order to do this, we would need to enhance
5483 the DWARF reader to associate a symbol to this renaming, instead of a
5484 name. So, for now, we do something simpler: re-use the C++/Fortran
5485 namespace machinery. */
5486 r_name = (renaming->alias != NULL
5487 ? renaming->alias
5488 : renaming->declaration);
5489 if (name_match (r_name, lookup_name, NULL))
5490 {
5491 lookup_name_info decl_lookup_name (renaming->declaration,
5492 lookup_name.match_type ());
5493 ada_add_all_symbols (obstackp, block, decl_lookup_name, domain,
5494 1, NULL);
5495 }
5496 renaming->searched = 0;
5497 }
5498 return num_defns_collected (obstackp) != defns_mark;
5499 }
5500
5501 /* Implements compare_names, but only applying the comparision using
5502 the given CASING. */
5503
5504 static int
5505 compare_names_with_case (const char *string1, const char *string2,
5506 enum case_sensitivity casing)
5507 {
5508 while (*string1 != '\0' && *string2 != '\0')
5509 {
5510 char c1, c2;
5511
5512 if (isspace (*string1) || isspace (*string2))
5513 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5514
5515 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5516 {
5517 c1 = tolower (*string1);
5518 c2 = tolower (*string2);
5519 }
5520 else
5521 {
5522 c1 = *string1;
5523 c2 = *string2;
5524 }
5525 if (c1 != c2)
5526 break;
5527
5528 string1 += 1;
5529 string2 += 1;
5530 }
5531
5532 switch (*string1)
5533 {
5534 case '(':
5535 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5536 case '_':
5537 if (*string2 == '\0')
5538 {
5539 if (is_name_suffix (string1))
5540 return 0;
5541 else
5542 return 1;
5543 }
5544 /* FALLTHROUGH */
5545 default:
5546 if (*string2 == '(')
5547 return strcmp_iw_ordered (string1, string2);
5548 else
5549 {
5550 if (casing == case_sensitive_off)
5551 return tolower (*string1) - tolower (*string2);
5552 else
5553 return *string1 - *string2;
5554 }
5555 }
5556 }
5557
5558 /* Compare STRING1 to STRING2, with results as for strcmp.
5559 Compatible with strcmp_iw_ordered in that...
5560
5561 strcmp_iw_ordered (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5562
5563 ... implies...
5564
5565 compare_names (STRING1, STRING2) <= 0
5566
5567 (they may differ as to what symbols compare equal). */
5568
5569 static int
5570 compare_names (const char *string1, const char *string2)
5571 {
5572 int result;
5573
5574 /* Similar to what strcmp_iw_ordered does, we need to perform
5575 a case-insensitive comparison first, and only resort to
5576 a second, case-sensitive, comparison if the first one was
5577 not sufficient to differentiate the two strings. */
5578
5579 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_off);
5580 if (result == 0)
5581 result = compare_names_with_case (string1, string2, case_sensitive_on);
5582
5583 return result;
5584 }
5585
5586 /* Convenience function to get at the Ada encoded lookup name for
5587 LOOKUP_NAME, as a C string. */
5588
5589 static const char *
5590 ada_lookup_name (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
5591 {
5592 return lookup_name.ada ().lookup_name ().c_str ();
5593 }
5594
5595 /* Add to OBSTACKP all non-local symbols whose name and domain match
5596 LOOKUP_NAME and DOMAIN respectively. The search is performed on
5597 GLOBAL_BLOCK symbols if GLOBAL is non-zero, or on STATIC_BLOCK
5598 symbols otherwise. */
5599
5600 static void
5601 add_nonlocal_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5602 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5603 domain_enum domain, int global)
5604 {
5605 struct match_data data;
5606
5607 memset (&data, 0, sizeof data);
5608 data.obstackp = obstackp;
5609
5610 bool is_wild_match = lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ();
5611
5612 auto callback = [&] (struct block_symbol *bsym)
5613 {
5614 return aux_add_nonlocal_symbols (bsym, &data);
5615 };
5616
5617 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
5618 {
5619 data.objfile = objfile;
5620
5621 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, lookup_name,
5622 domain, global, callback,
5623 (is_wild_match
5624 ? NULL : compare_names));
5625
5626 for (compunit_symtab *cu : objfile->compunits ())
5627 {
5628 const struct block *global_block
5629 = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (cu), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
5630
5631 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, global_block, lookup_name,
5632 domain))
5633 data.found_sym = 1;
5634 }
5635 }
5636
5637 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0 && global && !is_wild_match)
5638 {
5639 const char *name = ada_lookup_name (lookup_name);
5640 std::string bracket_name = std::string ("<_ada_") + name + '>';
5641 lookup_name_info name1 (bracket_name, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
5642
5643 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
5644 {
5645 data.objfile = objfile;
5646 objfile->sf->qf->map_matching_symbols (objfile, name1,
5647 domain, global, callback,
5648 compare_names);
5649 }
5650 }
5651 }
5652
5653 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching LOOKUP_NAME, in BLOCK and, if
5654 FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes,
5655 returning the number of matches. Add these to OBSTACKP.
5656
5657 When FULL_SEARCH is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5658 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK,
5659 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5660 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5661 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned.
5662
5663 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially:
5664 "standard__" is first stripped off (by the lookup_name
5665 constructor), and only static and global symbols are searched.
5666
5667 If MADE_GLOBAL_LOOKUP_P is non-null, set it before return to whether we had
5668 to lookup global symbols. */
5669
5670 static void
5671 ada_add_all_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
5672 const struct block *block,
5673 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5674 domain_enum domain,
5675 int full_search,
5676 int *made_global_lookup_p)
5677 {
5678 struct symbol *sym;
5679
5680 if (made_global_lookup_p)
5681 *made_global_lookup_p = 0;
5682
5683 /* Special case: If the user specifies a symbol name inside package
5684 Standard, do a non-wild matching of the symbol name without
5685 the "standard__" prefix. This was primarily introduced in order
5686 to allow the user to specifically access the standard exceptions
5687 using, for instance, Standard.Constraint_Error when Constraint_Error
5688 is ambiguous (due to the user defining its own Constraint_Error
5689 entity inside its program). */
5690 if (lookup_name.ada ().standard_p ())
5691 block = NULL;
5692
5693 /* Check the non-global symbols. If we have ANY match, then we're done. */
5694
5695 if (block != NULL)
5696 {
5697 if (full_search)
5698 ada_add_local_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, block, domain);
5699 else
5700 {
5701 /* In the !full_search case we're are being called by
5702 ada_iterate_over_symbols, and we don't want to search
5703 superblocks. */
5704 ada_add_block_symbols (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain, NULL);
5705 }
5706 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) > 0 || !full_search)
5707 return;
5708 }
5709
5710 /* No non-global symbols found. Check our cache to see if we have
5711 already performed this search before. If we have, then return
5712 the same result. */
5713
5714 if (lookup_cached_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name),
5715 domain, &sym, &block))
5716 {
5717 if (sym != NULL)
5718 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp, sym, block);
5719 return;
5720 }
5721
5722 if (made_global_lookup_p)
5723 *made_global_lookup_p = 1;
5724
5725 /* Search symbols from all global blocks. */
5726
5727 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, domain, 1);
5728
5729 /* Now add symbols from all per-file blocks if we've gotten no hits
5730 (not strictly correct, but perhaps better than an error). */
5731
5732 if (num_defns_collected (obstackp) == 0)
5733 add_nonlocal_symbols (obstackp, lookup_name, domain, 0);
5734 }
5735
5736 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching LOOKUP_NAME, in BLOCK and, if FULL_SEARCH
5737 is non-zero, enclosing scope and in global scopes, returning the number of
5738 matches.
5739 Fills *RESULTS with (SYM,BLOCK) tuples, indicating the symbols
5740 found and the blocks and symbol tables (if any) in which they were
5741 found.
5742
5743 When full_search is non-zero, any non-function/non-enumeral
5744 symbol match within the nest of blocks whose innermost member is BLOCK,
5745 is the one match returned (no other matches in that or
5746 enclosing blocks is returned). If there are any matches in or
5747 surrounding BLOCK, then these alone are returned.
5748
5749 Names prefixed with "standard__" are handled specially: "standard__"
5750 is first stripped off, and only static and global symbols are searched. */
5751
5752 static int
5753 ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
5754 const struct block *block,
5755 domain_enum domain,
5756 std::vector<struct block_symbol> *results,
5757 int full_search)
5758 {
5759 int syms_from_global_search;
5760 int ndefns;
5761 auto_obstack obstack;
5762
5763 ada_add_all_symbols (&obstack, block, lookup_name,
5764 domain, full_search, &syms_from_global_search);
5765
5766 ndefns = num_defns_collected (&obstack);
5767
5768 struct block_symbol *base = defns_collected (&obstack, 1);
5769 for (int i = 0; i < ndefns; ++i)
5770 results->push_back (base[i]);
5771
5772 ndefns = remove_extra_symbols (results);
5773
5774 if (ndefns == 0 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5775 cache_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name), domain, NULL, NULL);
5776
5777 if (ndefns == 1 && full_search && syms_from_global_search)
5778 cache_symbol (ada_lookup_name (lookup_name), domain,
5779 (*results)[0].symbol, (*results)[0].block);
5780
5781 ndefns = remove_irrelevant_renamings (results, block);
5782
5783 return ndefns;
5784 }
5785
5786 /* Find symbols in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK and enclosing scope and
5787 in global scopes, returning the number of matches, and filling *RESULTS
5788 with (SYM,BLOCK) tuples.
5789
5790 See ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker for further details. */
5791
5792 int
5793 ada_lookup_symbol_list (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5794 domain_enum domain,
5795 std::vector<struct block_symbol> *results)
5796 {
5797 symbol_name_match_type name_match_type = name_match_type_from_name (name);
5798 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, name_match_type);
5799
5800 return ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (lookup_name, block, domain, results, 1);
5801 }
5802
5803 /* Implementation of the la_iterate_over_symbols method. */
5804
5805 static bool
5806 ada_iterate_over_symbols
5807 (const struct block *block, const lookup_name_info &name,
5808 domain_enum domain,
5809 gdb::function_view<symbol_found_callback_ftype> callback)
5810 {
5811 int ndefs, i;
5812 std::vector<struct block_symbol> results;
5813
5814 ndefs = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (name, block, domain, &results, 0);
5815
5816 for (i = 0; i < ndefs; ++i)
5817 {
5818 if (!callback (&results[i]))
5819 return false;
5820 }
5821
5822 return true;
5823 }
5824
5825 /* The result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list with FULL_SEARCH set
5826 to 1, but choosing the first symbol found if there are multiple
5827 choices.
5828
5829 The result is stored in *INFO, which must be non-NULL.
5830 If no match is found, INFO->SYM is set to NULL. */
5831
5832 void
5833 ada_lookup_encoded_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block,
5834 domain_enum domain,
5835 struct block_symbol *info)
5836 {
5837 /* Since we already have an encoded name, wrap it in '<>' to force a
5838 verbatim match. Otherwise, if the name happens to not look like
5839 an encoded name (because it doesn't include a "__"),
5840 ada_lookup_name_info would re-encode/fold it again, and that
5841 would e.g., incorrectly lowercase object renaming names like
5842 "R28b" -> "r28b". */
5843 std::string verbatim = std::string ("<") + name + '>';
5844
5845 gdb_assert (info != NULL);
5846 *info = ada_lookup_symbol (verbatim.c_str (), block, domain);
5847 }
5848
5849 /* Return a symbol in DOMAIN matching NAME, in BLOCK0 and enclosing
5850 scope and in global scopes, or NULL if none. NAME is folded and
5851 encoded first. Otherwise, the result is as for ada_lookup_symbol_list,
5852 choosing the first symbol if there are multiple choices. */
5853
5854 struct block_symbol
5855 ada_lookup_symbol (const char *name, const struct block *block0,
5856 domain_enum domain)
5857 {
5858 std::vector<struct block_symbol> candidates;
5859 int n_candidates;
5860
5861 n_candidates = ada_lookup_symbol_list (name, block0, domain, &candidates);
5862
5863 if (n_candidates == 0)
5864 return {};
5865
5866 block_symbol info = candidates[0];
5867 info.symbol = fixup_symbol_section (info.symbol, NULL);
5868 return info;
5869 }
5870
5871 static struct block_symbol
5872 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal (const struct language_defn *langdef,
5873 const char *name,
5874 const struct block *block,
5875 const domain_enum domain)
5876 {
5877 struct block_symbol sym;
5878
5879 sym = ada_lookup_symbol (name, block_static_block (block), domain);
5880 if (sym.symbol != NULL)
5881 return sym;
5882
5883 /* If we haven't found a match at this point, try the primitive
5884 types. In other languages, this search is performed before
5885 searching for global symbols in order to short-circuit that
5886 global-symbol search if it happens that the name corresponds
5887 to a primitive type. But we cannot do the same in Ada, because
5888 it is perfectly legitimate for a program to declare a type which
5889 has the same name as a standard type. If looking up a type in
5890 that situation, we have traditionally ignored the primitive type
5891 in favor of user-defined types. This is why, unlike most other
5892 languages, we search the primitive types this late and only after
5893 having searched the global symbols without success. */
5894
5895 if (domain == VAR_DOMAIN)
5896 {
5897 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5898
5899 if (block == NULL)
5900 gdbarch = target_gdbarch ();
5901 else
5902 gdbarch = block_gdbarch (block);
5903 sym.symbol = language_lookup_primitive_type_as_symbol (langdef, gdbarch, name);
5904 if (sym.symbol != NULL)
5905 return sym;
5906 }
5907
5908 return {};
5909 }
5910
5911
5912 /* True iff STR is a possible encoded suffix of a normal Ada name
5913 that is to be ignored for matching purposes. Suffixes of parallel
5914 names (e.g., XVE) are not included here. Currently, the possible suffixes
5915 are given by any of the regular expressions:
5916
5917 [.$][0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as GNU/Linux]
5918 ___[0-9]+ [nested subprogram suffix, on platforms such as HP/UX]
5919 TKB [subprogram suffix for task bodies]
5920 _E[0-9]+[bs]$ [protected object entry suffixes]
5921 (X[nb]*)?((\$|__)[0-9](_?[0-9]+)|___(JM|LJM|X([FDBUP].*|R[^T]?)))?$
5922
5923 Also, any leading "__[0-9]+" sequence is skipped before the suffix
5924 match is performed. This sequence is used to differentiate homonyms,
5925 is an optional part of a valid name suffix. */
5926
5927 static int
5928 is_name_suffix (const char *str)
5929 {
5930 int k;
5931 const char *matching;
5932 const int len = strlen (str);
5933
5934 /* Skip optional leading __[0-9]+. */
5935
5936 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && isdigit (str[2]))
5937 {
5938 str += 3;
5939 while (isdigit (str[0]))
5940 str += 1;
5941 }
5942
5943 /* [.$][0-9]+ */
5944
5945 if (str[0] == '.' || str[0] == '$')
5946 {
5947 matching = str + 1;
5948 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5949 matching += 1;
5950 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5951 return 1;
5952 }
5953
5954 /* ___[0-9]+ */
5955
5956 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str[1] == '_' && str[2] == '_')
5957 {
5958 matching = str + 3;
5959 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5960 matching += 1;
5961 if (matching[0] == '\0')
5962 return 1;
5963 }
5964
5965 /* "TKB" suffixes are used for subprograms implementing task bodies. */
5966
5967 if (strcmp (str, "TKB") == 0)
5968 return 1;
5969
5970 #if 0
5971 /* FIXME: brobecker/2005-09-23: Protected Object subprograms end
5972 with a N at the end. Unfortunately, the compiler uses the same
5973 convention for other internal types it creates. So treating
5974 all entity names that end with an "N" as a name suffix causes
5975 some regressions. For instance, consider the case of an enumerated
5976 type. To support the 'Image attribute, it creates an array whose
5977 name ends with N.
5978 Having a single character like this as a suffix carrying some
5979 information is a bit risky. Perhaps we should change the encoding
5980 to be something like "_N" instead. In the meantime, do not do
5981 the following check. */
5982 /* Protected Object Subprograms */
5983 if (len == 1 && str [0] == 'N')
5984 return 1;
5985 #endif
5986
5987 /* _E[0-9]+[bs]$ */
5988 if (len > 3 && str[0] == '_' && str [1] == 'E' && isdigit (str[2]))
5989 {
5990 matching = str + 3;
5991 while (isdigit (matching[0]))
5992 matching += 1;
5993 if ((matching[0] == 'b' || matching[0] == 's')
5994 && matching [1] == '\0')
5995 return 1;
5996 }
5997
5998 /* ??? We should not modify STR directly, as we are doing below. This
5999 is fine in this case, but may become problematic later if we find
6000 that this alternative did not work, and want to try matching
6001 another one from the begining of STR. Since we modified it, we
6002 won't be able to find the begining of the string anymore! */
6003 if (str[0] == 'X')
6004 {
6005 str += 1;
6006 while (str[0] != '_' && str[0] != '\0')
6007 {
6008 if (str[0] != 'n' && str[0] != 'b')
6009 return 0;
6010 str += 1;
6011 }
6012 }
6013
6014 if (str[0] == '\000')
6015 return 1;
6016
6017 if (str[0] == '_')
6018 {
6019 if (str[1] != '_' || str[2] == '\000')
6020 return 0;
6021 if (str[2] == '_')
6022 {
6023 if (strcmp (str + 3, "JM") == 0)
6024 return 1;
6025 /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-09-30: GNAT will soon stop using
6026 the LJM suffix in favor of the JM one. But we will
6027 still accept LJM as a valid suffix for a reasonable
6028 amount of time, just to allow ourselves to debug programs
6029 compiled using an older version of GNAT. */
6030 if (strcmp (str + 3, "LJM") == 0)
6031 return 1;
6032 if (str[3] != 'X')
6033 return 0;
6034 if (str[4] == 'F' || str[4] == 'D' || str[4] == 'B'
6035 || str[4] == 'U' || str[4] == 'P')
6036 return 1;
6037 if (str[4] == 'R' && str[5] != 'T')
6038 return 1;
6039 return 0;
6040 }
6041 if (!isdigit (str[2]))
6042 return 0;
6043 for (k = 3; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
6044 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
6045 return 0;
6046 return 1;
6047 }
6048 if (str[0] == '$' && isdigit (str[1]))
6049 {
6050 for (k = 2; str[k] != '\0'; k += 1)
6051 if (!isdigit (str[k]) && str[k] != '_')
6052 return 0;
6053 return 1;
6054 }
6055 return 0;
6056 }
6057
6058 /* Return non-zero if the string starting at NAME and ending before
6059 NAME_END contains no capital letters. */
6060
6061 static int
6062 is_valid_name_for_wild_match (const char *name0)
6063 {
6064 std::string decoded_name = ada_decode (name0);
6065 int i;
6066
6067 /* If the decoded name starts with an angle bracket, it means that
6068 NAME0 does not follow the GNAT encoding format. It should then
6069 not be allowed as a possible wild match. */
6070 if (decoded_name[0] == '<')
6071 return 0;
6072
6073 for (i=0; decoded_name[i] != '\0'; i++)
6074 if (isalpha (decoded_name[i]) && !islower (decoded_name[i]))
6075 return 0;
6076
6077 return 1;
6078 }
6079
6080 /* Advance *NAMEP to next occurrence of TARGET0 in the string NAME0
6081 that could start a simple name. Assumes that *NAMEP points into
6082 the string beginning at NAME0. */
6083
6084 static int
6085 advance_wild_match (const char **namep, const char *name0, int target0)
6086 {
6087 const char *name = *namep;
6088
6089 while (1)
6090 {
6091 int t0, t1;
6092
6093 t0 = *name;
6094 if (t0 == '_')
6095 {
6096 t1 = name[1];
6097 if ((t1 >= 'a' && t1 <= 'z') || (t1 >= '0' && t1 <= '9'))
6098 {
6099 name += 1;
6100 if (name == name0 + 5 && startswith (name0, "_ada"))
6101 break;
6102 else
6103 name += 1;
6104 }
6105 else if (t1 == '_' && ((name[2] >= 'a' && name[2] <= 'z')
6106 || name[2] == target0))
6107 {
6108 name += 2;
6109 break;
6110 }
6111 else
6112 return 0;
6113 }
6114 else if ((t0 >= 'a' && t0 <= 'z') || (t0 >= '0' && t0 <= '9'))
6115 name += 1;
6116 else
6117 return 0;
6118 }
6119
6120 *namep = name;
6121 return 1;
6122 }
6123
6124 /* Return true iff NAME encodes a name of the form prefix.PATN.
6125 Ignores any informational suffixes of NAME (i.e., for which
6126 is_name_suffix is true). Assumes that PATN is a lower-cased Ada
6127 simple name. */
6128
6129 static bool
6130 wild_match (const char *name, const char *patn)
6131 {
6132 const char *p;
6133 const char *name0 = name;
6134
6135 while (1)
6136 {
6137 const char *match = name;
6138
6139 if (*name == *patn)
6140 {
6141 for (name += 1, p = patn + 1; *p != '\0'; name += 1, p += 1)
6142 if (*p != *name)
6143 break;
6144 if (*p == '\0' && is_name_suffix (name))
6145 return match == name0 || is_valid_name_for_wild_match (name0);
6146
6147 if (name[-1] == '_')
6148 name -= 1;
6149 }
6150 if (!advance_wild_match (&name, name0, *patn))
6151 return false;
6152 }
6153 }
6154
6155 /* Returns true iff symbol name SYM_NAME matches SEARCH_NAME, ignoring
6156 any trailing suffixes that encode debugging information or leading
6157 _ada_ on SYM_NAME (see is_name_suffix commentary for the debugging
6158 information that is ignored). */
6159
6160 static bool
6161 full_match (const char *sym_name, const char *search_name)
6162 {
6163 size_t search_name_len = strlen (search_name);
6164
6165 if (strncmp (sym_name, search_name, search_name_len) == 0
6166 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + search_name_len))
6167 return true;
6168
6169 if (startswith (sym_name, "_ada_")
6170 && strncmp (sym_name + 5, search_name, search_name_len) == 0
6171 && is_name_suffix (sym_name + search_name_len + 5))
6172 return true;
6173
6174 return false;
6175 }
6176
6177 /* Add symbols from BLOCK matching LOOKUP_NAME in DOMAIN to vector
6178 *defn_symbols, updating the list of symbols in OBSTACKP (if
6179 necessary). OBJFILE is the section containing BLOCK. */
6180
6181 static void
6182 ada_add_block_symbols (struct obstack *obstackp,
6183 const struct block *block,
6184 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
6185 domain_enum domain, struct objfile *objfile)
6186 {
6187 struct block_iterator iter;
6188 /* A matching argument symbol, if any. */
6189 struct symbol *arg_sym;
6190 /* Set true when we find a matching non-argument symbol. */
6191 int found_sym;
6192 struct symbol *sym;
6193
6194 arg_sym = NULL;
6195 found_sym = 0;
6196 for (sym = block_iter_match_first (block, lookup_name, &iter);
6197 sym != NULL;
6198 sym = block_iter_match_next (lookup_name, &iter))
6199 {
6200 if (symbol_matches_domain (sym->language (), SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6201 {
6202 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6203 {
6204 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6205 arg_sym = sym;
6206 else
6207 {
6208 found_sym = 1;
6209 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6210 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6211 block);
6212 }
6213 }
6214 }
6215 }
6216
6217 /* Handle renamings. */
6218
6219 if (ada_add_block_renamings (obstackp, block, lookup_name, domain))
6220 found_sym = 1;
6221
6222 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6223 {
6224 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6225 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6226 block);
6227 }
6228
6229 if (!lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ())
6230 {
6231 arg_sym = NULL;
6232 found_sym = 0;
6233 const std::string &ada_lookup_name = lookup_name.ada ().lookup_name ();
6234 const char *name = ada_lookup_name.c_str ();
6235 size_t name_len = ada_lookup_name.size ();
6236
6237 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
6238 {
6239 if (symbol_matches_domain (sym->language (),
6240 SYMBOL_DOMAIN (sym), domain))
6241 {
6242 int cmp;
6243
6244 cmp = (int) '_' - (int) sym->linkage_name ()[0];
6245 if (cmp == 0)
6246 {
6247 cmp = !startswith (sym->linkage_name (), "_ada_");
6248 if (cmp == 0)
6249 cmp = strncmp (name, sym->linkage_name () + 5,
6250 name_len);
6251 }
6252
6253 if (cmp == 0
6254 && is_name_suffix (sym->linkage_name () + name_len + 5))
6255 {
6256 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED)
6257 {
6258 if (SYMBOL_IS_ARGUMENT (sym))
6259 arg_sym = sym;
6260 else
6261 {
6262 found_sym = 1;
6263 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6264 fixup_symbol_section (sym, objfile),
6265 block);
6266 }
6267 }
6268 }
6269 }
6270 }
6271
6272 /* NOTE: This really shouldn't be needed for _ada_ symbols.
6273 They aren't parameters, right? */
6274 if (!found_sym && arg_sym != NULL)
6275 {
6276 add_defn_to_vec (obstackp,
6277 fixup_symbol_section (arg_sym, objfile),
6278 block);
6279 }
6280 }
6281 }
6282 \f
6283
6284 /* Symbol Completion */
6285
6286 /* See symtab.h. */
6287
6288 bool
6289 ada_lookup_name_info::matches
6290 (const char *sym_name,
6291 symbol_name_match_type match_type,
6292 completion_match_result *comp_match_res) const
6293 {
6294 bool match = false;
6295 const char *text = m_encoded_name.c_str ();
6296 size_t text_len = m_encoded_name.size ();
6297
6298 /* First, test against the fully qualified name of the symbol. */
6299
6300 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6301 match = true;
6302
6303 std::string decoded_name = ada_decode (sym_name);
6304 if (match && !m_encoded_p)
6305 {
6306 /* One needed check before declaring a positive match is to verify
6307 that iff we are doing a verbatim match, the decoded version
6308 of the symbol name starts with '<'. Otherwise, this symbol name
6309 is not a suitable completion. */
6310
6311 bool has_angle_bracket = (decoded_name[0] == '<');
6312 match = (has_angle_bracket == m_verbatim_p);
6313 }
6314
6315 if (match && !m_verbatim_p)
6316 {
6317 /* When doing non-verbatim match, another check that needs to
6318 be done is to verify that the potentially matching symbol name
6319 does not include capital letters, because the ada-mode would
6320 not be able to understand these symbol names without the
6321 angle bracket notation. */
6322 const char *tmp;
6323
6324 for (tmp = sym_name; *tmp != '\0' && !isupper (*tmp); tmp++);
6325 if (*tmp != '\0')
6326 match = false;
6327 }
6328
6329 /* Second: Try wild matching... */
6330
6331 if (!match && m_wild_match_p)
6332 {
6333 /* Since we are doing wild matching, this means that TEXT
6334 may represent an unqualified symbol name. We therefore must
6335 also compare TEXT against the unqualified name of the symbol. */
6336 sym_name = ada_unqualified_name (decoded_name.c_str ());
6337
6338 if (strncmp (sym_name, text, text_len) == 0)
6339 match = true;
6340 }
6341
6342 /* Finally: If we found a match, prepare the result to return. */
6343
6344 if (!match)
6345 return false;
6346
6347 if (comp_match_res != NULL)
6348 {
6349 std::string &match_str = comp_match_res->match.storage ();
6350
6351 if (!m_encoded_p)
6352 match_str = ada_decode (sym_name);
6353 else
6354 {
6355 if (m_verbatim_p)
6356 match_str = add_angle_brackets (sym_name);
6357 else
6358 match_str = sym_name;
6359
6360 }
6361
6362 comp_match_res->set_match (match_str.c_str ());
6363 }
6364
6365 return true;
6366 }
6367
6368 /* Add the list of possible symbol names completing TEXT to TRACKER.
6369 WORD is the entire command on which completion is made. */
6370
6371 static void
6372 ada_collect_symbol_completion_matches (completion_tracker &tracker,
6373 complete_symbol_mode mode,
6374 symbol_name_match_type name_match_type,
6375 const char *text, const char *word,
6376 enum type_code code)
6377 {
6378 struct symbol *sym;
6379 const struct block *b, *surrounding_static_block = 0;
6380 struct block_iterator iter;
6381
6382 gdb_assert (code == TYPE_CODE_UNDEF);
6383
6384 lookup_name_info lookup_name (text, name_match_type, true);
6385
6386 /* First, look at the partial symtab symbols. */
6387 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL,
6388 lookup_name,
6389 NULL,
6390 NULL,
6391 ALL_DOMAIN);
6392
6393 /* At this point scan through the misc symbol vectors and add each
6394 symbol you find to the list. Eventually we want to ignore
6395 anything that isn't a text symbol (everything else will be
6396 handled by the psymtab code above). */
6397
6398 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6399 {
6400 for (minimal_symbol *msymbol : objfile->msymbols ())
6401 {
6402 QUIT;
6403
6404 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, msymbol))
6405 continue;
6406
6407 language symbol_language = msymbol->language ();
6408
6409 /* Ada minimal symbols won't have their language set to Ada. If
6410 we let completion_list_add_name compare using the
6411 default/C-like matcher, then when completing e.g., symbols in a
6412 package named "pck", we'd match internal Ada symbols like
6413 "pckS", which are invalid in an Ada expression, unless you wrap
6414 them in '<' '>' to request a verbatim match.
6415
6416 Unfortunately, some Ada encoded names successfully demangle as
6417 C++ symbols (using an old mangling scheme), such as "name__2Xn"
6418 -> "Xn::name(void)" and thus some Ada minimal symbols end up
6419 with the wrong language set. Paper over that issue here. */
6420 if (symbol_language == language_auto
6421 || symbol_language == language_cplus)
6422 symbol_language = language_ada;
6423
6424 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6425 symbol_language,
6426 msymbol->linkage_name (),
6427 lookup_name, text, word);
6428 }
6429 }
6430
6431 /* Search upwards from currently selected frame (so that we can
6432 complete on local vars. */
6433
6434 for (b = get_selected_block (0); b != NULL; b = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6435 {
6436 if (!BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (b))
6437 surrounding_static_block = b; /* For elmin of dups */
6438
6439 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6440 {
6441 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6442 continue;
6443
6444 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6445 sym->language (),
6446 sym->linkage_name (),
6447 lookup_name, text, word);
6448 }
6449 }
6450
6451 /* Go through the symtabs and check the externs and statics for
6452 symbols which match. */
6453
6454 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6455 {
6456 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
6457 {
6458 QUIT;
6459 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), GLOBAL_BLOCK);
6460 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6461 {
6462 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6463 continue;
6464
6465 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6466 sym->language (),
6467 sym->linkage_name (),
6468 lookup_name, text, word);
6469 }
6470 }
6471 }
6472
6473 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
6474 {
6475 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
6476 {
6477 QUIT;
6478 b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s), STATIC_BLOCK);
6479 /* Don't do this block twice. */
6480 if (b == surrounding_static_block)
6481 continue;
6482 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
6483 {
6484 if (completion_skip_symbol (mode, sym))
6485 continue;
6486
6487 completion_list_add_name (tracker,
6488 sym->language (),
6489 sym->linkage_name (),
6490 lookup_name, text, word);
6491 }
6492 }
6493 }
6494 }
6495
6496 /* Field Access */
6497
6498 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is a pointer to the GNAT dispatch table used
6499 for tagged types. */
6500
6501 static int
6502 ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (struct type *type)
6503 {
6504 const char *name;
6505
6506 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6507 return 0;
6508
6509 name = TYPE_NAME (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6510 if (name == NULL)
6511 return 0;
6512
6513 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6514 }
6515
6516 /* Return non-zero if TYPE is an interface tag. */
6517
6518 static int
6519 ada_is_interface_tag (struct type *type)
6520 {
6521 const char *name = TYPE_NAME (type);
6522
6523 if (name == NULL)
6524 return 0;
6525
6526 return (strcmp (name, "ada__tags__interface_tag") == 0);
6527 }
6528
6529 /* True if field number FIELD_NUM in struct or union type TYPE is supposed
6530 to be invisible to users. */
6531
6532 int
6533 ada_is_ignored_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6534 {
6535 if (field_num < 0 || field_num > TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
6536 return 1;
6537
6538 /* Check the name of that field. */
6539 {
6540 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6541
6542 /* Anonymous field names should not be printed.
6543 brobecker/2007-02-20: I don't think this can actually happen
6544 but we don't want to print the value of anonymous fields anyway. */
6545 if (name == NULL)
6546 return 1;
6547
6548 /* Normally, fields whose name start with an underscore ("_")
6549 are fields that have been internally generated by the compiler,
6550 and thus should not be printed. The "_parent" field is special,
6551 however: This is a field internally generated by the compiler
6552 for tagged types, and it contains the components inherited from
6553 the parent type. This field should not be printed as is, but
6554 should not be ignored either. */
6555 if (name[0] == '_' && !startswith (name, "_parent"))
6556 return 1;
6557 }
6558
6559 /* If this is the dispatch table of a tagged type or an interface tag,
6560 then ignore. */
6561 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 1)
6562 && (ada_is_dispatch_table_ptr_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))
6563 || ada_is_interface_tag (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num))))
6564 return 1;
6565
6566 /* Not a special field, so it should not be ignored. */
6567 return 0;
6568 }
6569
6570 /* True iff TYPE has a tag field. If REFOK, then TYPE may also be a
6571 pointer or reference type whose ultimate target has a tag field. */
6572
6573 int
6574 ada_is_tagged_type (struct type *type, int refok)
6575 {
6576 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type, "_tag", refok, 1) != NULL);
6577 }
6578
6579 /* True iff TYPE represents the type of X'Tag */
6580
6581 int
6582 ada_is_tag_type (struct type *type)
6583 {
6584 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6585
6586 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6587 return 0;
6588 else
6589 {
6590 const char *name = ada_type_name (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
6591
6592 return (name != NULL
6593 && strcmp (name, "ada__tags__dispatch_table") == 0);
6594 }
6595 }
6596
6597 /* The type of the tag on VAL. */
6598
6599 static struct type *
6600 ada_tag_type (struct value *val)
6601 {
6602 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (value_type (val), "_tag", 1, 0);
6603 }
6604
6605 /* Return 1 if TAG follows the old scheme for Ada tags (used for Ada 95,
6606 retired at Ada 05). */
6607
6608 static int
6609 is_ada95_tag (struct value *tag)
6610 {
6611 return ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1) != NULL;
6612 }
6613
6614 /* The value of the tag on VAL. */
6615
6616 static struct value *
6617 ada_value_tag (struct value *val)
6618 {
6619 return ada_value_struct_elt (val, "_tag", 0);
6620 }
6621
6622 /* The value of the tag on the object of type TYPE whose contents are
6623 saved at VALADDR, if it is non-null, or is at memory address
6624 ADDRESS. */
6625
6626 static struct value *
6627 value_tag_from_contents_and_address (struct type *type,
6628 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
6629 CORE_ADDR address)
6630 {
6631 int tag_byte_offset;
6632 struct type *tag_type;
6633
6634 if (find_struct_field ("_tag", type, 0, &tag_type, &tag_byte_offset,
6635 NULL, NULL, NULL))
6636 {
6637 const gdb_byte *valaddr1 = ((valaddr == NULL)
6638 ? NULL
6639 : valaddr + tag_byte_offset);
6640 CORE_ADDR address1 = (address == 0) ? 0 : address + tag_byte_offset;
6641
6642 return value_from_contents_and_address (tag_type, valaddr1, address1);
6643 }
6644 return NULL;
6645 }
6646
6647 static struct type *
6648 type_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6649 {
6650 const char *type_name = ada_tag_name (tag);
6651
6652 if (type_name != NULL)
6653 return ada_find_any_type (ada_encode (type_name));
6654 return NULL;
6655 }
6656
6657 /* Given a value OBJ of a tagged type, return a value of this
6658 type at the base address of the object. The base address, as
6659 defined in Ada.Tags, it is the address of the primary tag of
6660 the object, and therefore where the field values of its full
6661 view can be fetched. */
6662
6663 struct value *
6664 ada_tag_value_at_base_address (struct value *obj)
6665 {
6666 struct value *val;
6667 LONGEST offset_to_top = 0;
6668 struct type *ptr_type, *obj_type;
6669 struct value *tag;
6670 CORE_ADDR base_address;
6671
6672 obj_type = value_type (obj);
6673
6674 /* It is the responsability of the caller to deref pointers. */
6675
6676 if (TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
6677 || TYPE_CODE (obj_type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
6678 return obj;
6679
6680 tag = ada_value_tag (obj);
6681 if (!tag)
6682 return obj;
6683
6684 /* Base addresses only appeared with Ada 05 and multiple inheritance. */
6685
6686 if (is_ada95_tag (tag))
6687 return obj;
6688
6689 ptr_type = language_lookup_primitive_type
6690 (language_def (language_ada), target_gdbarch(), "storage_offset");
6691 ptr_type = lookup_pointer_type (ptr_type);
6692 val = value_cast (ptr_type, tag);
6693 if (!val)
6694 return obj;
6695
6696 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while
6697 trying to determine the base address, just like for the tag;
6698 see ada_tag_name for more details. We do not print the error
6699 message for the same reason. */
6700
6701 try
6702 {
6703 offset_to_top = value_as_long (value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -2)));
6704 }
6705
6706 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
6707 {
6708 return obj;
6709 }
6710
6711 /* If offset is null, nothing to do. */
6712
6713 if (offset_to_top == 0)
6714 return obj;
6715
6716 /* -1 is a special case in Ada.Tags; however, what should be done
6717 is not quite clear from the documentation. So do nothing for
6718 now. */
6719
6720 if (offset_to_top == -1)
6721 return obj;
6722
6723 /* OFFSET_TO_TOP used to be a positive value to be subtracted
6724 from the base address. This was however incompatible with
6725 C++ dispatch table: C++ uses a *negative* value to *add*
6726 to the base address. Ada's convention has therefore been
6727 changed in GNAT 19.0w 20171023: since then, C++ and Ada
6728 use the same convention. Here, we support both cases by
6729 checking the sign of OFFSET_TO_TOP. */
6730
6731 if (offset_to_top > 0)
6732 offset_to_top = -offset_to_top;
6733
6734 base_address = value_address (obj) + offset_to_top;
6735 tag = value_tag_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6736
6737 /* Make sure that we have a proper tag at the new address.
6738 Otherwise, offset_to_top is bogus (which can happen when
6739 the object is not initialized yet). */
6740
6741 if (!tag)
6742 return obj;
6743
6744 obj_type = type_from_tag (tag);
6745
6746 if (!obj_type)
6747 return obj;
6748
6749 return value_from_contents_and_address (obj_type, NULL, base_address);
6750 }
6751
6752 /* Return the "ada__tags__type_specific_data" type. */
6753
6754 static struct type *
6755 ada_get_tsd_type (struct inferior *inf)
6756 {
6757 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (inf);
6758
6759 if (data->tsd_type == 0)
6760 data->tsd_type = ada_find_any_type ("ada__tags__type_specific_data");
6761 return data->tsd_type;
6762 }
6763
6764 /* Return the TSD (type-specific data) associated to the given TAG.
6765 TAG is assumed to be the tag of a tagged-type entity.
6766
6767 May return NULL if we are unable to get the TSD. */
6768
6769 static struct value *
6770 ada_get_tsd_from_tag (struct value *tag)
6771 {
6772 struct value *val;
6773 struct type *type;
6774
6775 /* First option: The TSD is simply stored as a field of our TAG.
6776 Only older versions of GNAT would use this format, but we have
6777 to test it first, because there are no visible markers for
6778 the current approach except the absence of that field. */
6779
6780 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tag, "tsd", 1);
6781 if (val)
6782 return val;
6783
6784 /* Try the second representation for the dispatch table (in which
6785 there is no explicit 'tsd' field in the referent of the tag pointer,
6786 and instead the tsd pointer is stored just before the dispatch
6787 table. */
6788
6789 type = ada_get_tsd_type (current_inferior());
6790 if (type == NULL)
6791 return NULL;
6792 type = lookup_pointer_type (lookup_pointer_type (type));
6793 val = value_cast (type, tag);
6794 if (val == NULL)
6795 return NULL;
6796 return value_ind (value_ptradd (val, -1));
6797 }
6798
6799 /* Given the TSD of a tag (type-specific data), return a string
6800 containing the name of the associated type.
6801
6802 The returned value is good until the next call. May return NULL
6803 if we are unable to determine the tag name. */
6804
6805 static char *
6806 ada_tag_name_from_tsd (struct value *tsd)
6807 {
6808 static char name[1024];
6809 char *p;
6810 struct value *val;
6811
6812 val = ada_value_struct_elt (tsd, "expanded_name", 1);
6813 if (val == NULL)
6814 return NULL;
6815 read_memory_string (value_as_address (val), name, sizeof (name) - 1);
6816 for (p = name; *p != '\0'; p += 1)
6817 if (isalpha (*p))
6818 *p = tolower (*p);
6819 return name;
6820 }
6821
6822 /* The type name of the dynamic type denoted by the 'tag value TAG, as
6823 a C string.
6824
6825 Return NULL if the TAG is not an Ada tag, or if we were unable to
6826 determine the name of that tag. The result is good until the next
6827 call. */
6828
6829 const char *
6830 ada_tag_name (struct value *tag)
6831 {
6832 char *name = NULL;
6833
6834 if (!ada_is_tag_type (value_type (tag)))
6835 return NULL;
6836
6837 /* It is perfectly possible that an exception be raised while trying
6838 to determine the TAG's name, even under normal circumstances:
6839 The associated variable may be uninitialized or corrupted, for
6840 instance. We do not let any exception propagate past this point.
6841 instead we return NULL.
6842
6843 We also do not print the error message either (which often is very
6844 low-level (Eg: "Cannot read memory at 0x[...]"), but instead let
6845 the caller print a more meaningful message if necessary. */
6846 try
6847 {
6848 struct value *tsd = ada_get_tsd_from_tag (tag);
6849
6850 if (tsd != NULL)
6851 name = ada_tag_name_from_tsd (tsd);
6852 }
6853 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
6854 {
6855 }
6856
6857 return name;
6858 }
6859
6860 /* The parent type of TYPE, or NULL if none. */
6861
6862 struct type *
6863 ada_parent_type (struct type *type)
6864 {
6865 int i;
6866
6867 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
6868
6869 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
6870 return NULL;
6871
6872 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
6873 if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
6874 {
6875 struct type *parent_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
6876
6877 /* If the _parent field is a pointer, then dereference it. */
6878 if (TYPE_CODE (parent_type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6879 parent_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (parent_type);
6880 /* If there is a parallel XVS type, get the actual base type. */
6881 parent_type = ada_get_base_type (parent_type);
6882
6883 return ada_check_typedef (parent_type);
6884 }
6885
6886 return NULL;
6887 }
6888
6889 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE contains the
6890 parent-type (inherited) fields of a derived type. Assumes TYPE is
6891 a structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6892
6893 int
6894 ada_is_parent_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6895 {
6896 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (ada_check_typedef (type), field_num);
6897
6898 return (name != NULL
6899 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6900 || startswith (name, "_parent")));
6901 }
6902
6903 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure type TYPE is a
6904 transparent wrapper field (which should be silently traversed when doing
6905 field selection and flattened when printing). Assumes TYPE is a
6906 structure type with at least FIELD_NUM+1 fields. Such fields are always
6907 structures. */
6908
6909 int
6910 ada_is_wrapper_field (struct type *type, int field_num)
6911 {
6912 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6913
6914 if (name != NULL && strcmp (name, "RETVAL") == 0)
6915 {
6916 /* This happens in functions with "out" or "in out" parameters
6917 which are passed by copy. For such functions, GNAT describes
6918 the function's return type as being a struct where the return
6919 value is in a field called RETVAL, and where the other "out"
6920 or "in out" parameters are fields of that struct. This is not
6921 a wrapper. */
6922 return 0;
6923 }
6924
6925 return (name != NULL
6926 && (startswith (name, "PARENT")
6927 || strcmp (name, "REP") == 0
6928 || startswith (name, "_parent")
6929 || name[0] == 'S' || name[0] == 'R' || name[0] == 'O'));
6930 }
6931
6932 /* True iff field number FIELD_NUM of structure or union type TYPE
6933 is a variant wrapper. Assumes TYPE is a structure type with at least
6934 FIELD_NUM+1 fields. */
6935
6936 int
6937 ada_is_variant_part (struct type *type, int field_num)
6938 {
6939 /* Only Ada types are eligible. */
6940 if (!ADA_TYPE_P (type))
6941 return 0;
6942
6943 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, field_num);
6944
6945 return (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
6946 || (is_dynamic_field (type, field_num)
6947 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type))
6948 == TYPE_CODE_UNION)));
6949 }
6950
6951 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is a variant wrapper (type of the variant part)
6952 whose discriminants are contained in the record type OUTER_TYPE,
6953 returns the type of the controlling discriminant for the variant.
6954 May return NULL if the type could not be found. */
6955
6956 struct type *
6957 ada_variant_discrim_type (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
6958 {
6959 const char *name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
6960
6961 return ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, name, 1, 1);
6962 }
6963
6964 /* Assuming that TYPE is the type of a variant wrapper, and FIELD_NUM is a
6965 valid field number within it, returns 1 iff field FIELD_NUM of TYPE
6966 represents a 'when others' clause; otherwise 0. */
6967
6968 static int
6969 ada_is_others_clause (struct type *type, int field_num)
6970 {
6971 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
6972
6973 return (name != NULL && name[0] == 'O');
6974 }
6975
6976 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is the type of the variant part of a record,
6977 returns the name of the discriminant controlling the variant.
6978 The value is valid until the next call to ada_variant_discrim_name. */
6979
6980 const char *
6981 ada_variant_discrim_name (struct type *type0)
6982 {
6983 static char *result = NULL;
6984 static size_t result_len = 0;
6985 struct type *type;
6986 const char *name;
6987 const char *discrim_end;
6988 const char *discrim_start;
6989
6990 if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
6991 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
6992 else
6993 type = type0;
6994
6995 name = ada_type_name (type);
6996
6997 if (name == NULL || name[0] == '\000')
6998 return "";
6999
7000 for (discrim_end = name + strlen (name) - 6; discrim_end != name;
7001 discrim_end -= 1)
7002 {
7003 if (startswith (discrim_end, "___XVN"))
7004 break;
7005 }
7006 if (discrim_end == name)
7007 return "";
7008
7009 for (discrim_start = discrim_end; discrim_start != name + 3;
7010 discrim_start -= 1)
7011 {
7012 if (discrim_start == name + 1)
7013 return "";
7014 if ((discrim_start > name + 3
7015 && startswith (discrim_start - 3, "___"))
7016 || discrim_start[-1] == '.')
7017 break;
7018 }
7019
7020 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, discrim_end - discrim_start + 1);
7021 strncpy (result, discrim_start, discrim_end - discrim_start);
7022 result[discrim_end - discrim_start] = '\0';
7023 return result;
7024 }
7025
7026 /* Scan STR for a subtype-encoded number, beginning at position K.
7027 Put the position of the character just past the number scanned in
7028 *NEW_K, if NEW_K!=NULL. Put the scanned number in *R, if R!=NULL.
7029 Return 1 if there was a valid number at the given position, and 0
7030 otherwise. A "subtype-encoded" number consists of the absolute value
7031 in decimal, followed by the letter 'm' to indicate a negative number.
7032 Assumes 0m does not occur. */
7033
7034 int
7035 ada_scan_number (const char str[], int k, LONGEST * R, int *new_k)
7036 {
7037 ULONGEST RU;
7038
7039 if (!isdigit (str[k]))
7040 return 0;
7041
7042 /* Do it the hard way so as not to make any assumption about
7043 the relationship of unsigned long (%lu scan format code) and
7044 LONGEST. */
7045 RU = 0;
7046 while (isdigit (str[k]))
7047 {
7048 RU = RU * 10 + (str[k] - '0');
7049 k += 1;
7050 }
7051
7052 if (str[k] == 'm')
7053 {
7054 if (R != NULL)
7055 *R = (-(LONGEST) (RU - 1)) - 1;
7056 k += 1;
7057 }
7058 else if (R != NULL)
7059 *R = (LONGEST) RU;
7060
7061 /* NOTE on the above: Technically, C does not say what the results of
7062 - (LONGEST) RU or (LONGEST) -RU are for RU == largest positive
7063 number representable as a LONGEST (although either would probably work
7064 in most implementations). When RU>0, the locution in the then branch
7065 above is always equivalent to the negative of RU. */
7066
7067 if (new_k != NULL)
7068 *new_k = k;
7069 return 1;
7070 }
7071
7072 /* Assuming that TYPE is a variant part wrapper type (a VARIANTS field),
7073 and FIELD_NUM is a valid field number within it, returns 1 iff VAL is
7074 in the range encoded by field FIELD_NUM of TYPE; otherwise 0. */
7075
7076 static int
7077 ada_in_variant (LONGEST val, struct type *type, int field_num)
7078 {
7079 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, field_num);
7080 int p;
7081
7082 p = 0;
7083 while (1)
7084 {
7085 switch (name[p])
7086 {
7087 case '\0':
7088 return 0;
7089 case 'S':
7090 {
7091 LONGEST W;
7092
7093 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &W, &p))
7094 return 0;
7095 if (val == W)
7096 return 1;
7097 break;
7098 }
7099 case 'R':
7100 {
7101 LONGEST L, U;
7102
7103 if (!ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &L, &p)
7104 || name[p] != 'T' || !ada_scan_number (name, p + 1, &U, &p))
7105 return 0;
7106 if (val >= L && val <= U)
7107 return 1;
7108 break;
7109 }
7110 case 'O':
7111 return 1;
7112 default:
7113 return 0;
7114 }
7115 }
7116 }
7117
7118 /* FIXME: Lots of redundancy below. Try to consolidate. */
7119
7120 /* Given a value ARG1 (offset by OFFSET bytes) of a struct or union type
7121 ARG_TYPE, extract and return the value of one of its (non-static)
7122 fields. FIELDNO says which field. Differs from value_primitive_field
7123 only in that it can handle packed values of arbitrary type. */
7124
7125 struct value *
7126 ada_value_primitive_field (struct value *arg1, int offset, int fieldno,
7127 struct type *arg_type)
7128 {
7129 struct type *type;
7130
7131 arg_type = ada_check_typedef (arg_type);
7132 type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (arg_type, fieldno);
7133
7134 /* Handle packed fields. It might be that the field is not packed
7135 relative to its containing structure, but the structure itself is
7136 packed; in this case we must take the bit-field path. */
7137 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno) != 0 || value_bitpos (arg1) != 0)
7138 {
7139 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (arg_type, fieldno);
7140 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (arg_type, fieldno);
7141
7142 return ada_value_primitive_packed_val (arg1, value_contents (arg1),
7143 offset + bit_pos / 8,
7144 bit_pos % 8, bit_size, type);
7145 }
7146 else
7147 return value_primitive_field (arg1, offset, fieldno, arg_type);
7148 }
7149
7150 /* Find field with name NAME in object of type TYPE. If found,
7151 set the following for each argument that is non-null:
7152 - *FIELD_TYPE_P to the field's type;
7153 - *BYTE_OFFSET_P to OFFSET + the byte offset of the field within
7154 an object of that type;
7155 - *BIT_OFFSET_P to the bit offset modulo byte size of the field;
7156 - *BIT_SIZE_P to its size in bits if the field is packed, and
7157 0 otherwise;
7158 If INDEX_P is non-null, increment *INDEX_P by the number of source-visible
7159 fields up to but not including the desired field, or by the total
7160 number of fields if not found. A NULL value of NAME never
7161 matches; the function just counts visible fields in this case.
7162
7163 Notice that we need to handle when a tagged record hierarchy
7164 has some components with the same name, like in this scenario:
7165
7166 type Top_T is tagged record
7167 N : Integer := 1;
7168 U : Integer := 974;
7169 A : Integer := 48;
7170 end record;
7171
7172 type Middle_T is new Top.Top_T with record
7173 N : Character := 'a';
7174 C : Integer := 3;
7175 end record;
7176
7177 type Bottom_T is new Middle.Middle_T with record
7178 N : Float := 4.0;
7179 C : Character := '5';
7180 X : Integer := 6;
7181 A : Character := 'J';
7182 end record;
7183
7184 Let's say we now have a variable declared and initialized as follow:
7185
7186 TC : Top_A := new Bottom_T;
7187
7188 And then we use this variable to call this function
7189
7190 procedure Assign (Obj: in out Top_T; TV : Integer);
7191
7192 as follow:
7193
7194 Assign (Top_T (B), 12);
7195
7196 Now, we're in the debugger, and we're inside that procedure
7197 then and we want to print the value of obj.c:
7198
7199 Usually, the tagged record or one of the parent type owns the
7200 component to print and there's no issue but in this particular
7201 case, what does it mean to ask for Obj.C? Since the actual
7202 type for object is type Bottom_T, it could mean two things: type
7203 component C from the Middle_T view, but also component C from
7204 Bottom_T. So in that "undefined" case, when the component is
7205 not found in the non-resolved type (which includes all the
7206 components of the parent type), then resolve it and see if we
7207 get better luck once expanded.
7208
7209 In the case of homonyms in the derived tagged type, we don't
7210 guaranty anything, and pick the one that's easiest for us
7211 to program.
7212
7213 Returns 1 if found, 0 otherwise. */
7214
7215 static int
7216 find_struct_field (const char *name, struct type *type, int offset,
7217 struct type **field_type_p,
7218 int *byte_offset_p, int *bit_offset_p, int *bit_size_p,
7219 int *index_p)
7220 {
7221 int i;
7222 int parent_offset = -1;
7223
7224 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7225
7226 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7227 *field_type_p = NULL;
7228 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7229 *byte_offset_p = 0;
7230 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7231 *bit_offset_p = 0;
7232 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7233 *bit_size_p = 0;
7234
7235 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7236 {
7237 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i);
7238 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7239 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7240
7241 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7242 continue;
7243
7244 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7245 {
7246 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7247 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7248 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7249 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7250 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7251 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7252 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7253
7254 parent_offset = i;
7255 continue;
7256 }
7257
7258 else if (name != NULL && field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7259 {
7260 int bit_size = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, i);
7261
7262 if (field_type_p != NULL)
7263 *field_type_p = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7264 if (byte_offset_p != NULL)
7265 *byte_offset_p = fld_offset;
7266 if (bit_offset_p != NULL)
7267 *bit_offset_p = bit_pos % 8;
7268 if (bit_size_p != NULL)
7269 *bit_size_p = bit_size;
7270 return 1;
7271 }
7272 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7273 {
7274 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), fld_offset,
7275 field_type_p, byte_offset_p, bit_offset_p,
7276 bit_size_p, index_p))
7277 return 1;
7278 }
7279 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7280 {
7281 /* PNH: Wait. Do we ever execute this section, or is ARG always of
7282 fixed type?? */
7283 int j;
7284 struct type *field_type
7285 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7286
7287 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
7288 {
7289 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j),
7290 fld_offset
7291 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7292 field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7293 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7294 return 1;
7295 }
7296 }
7297 else if (index_p != NULL)
7298 *index_p += 1;
7299 }
7300
7301 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7302 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7303
7304 if (parent_offset != -1)
7305 {
7306 int bit_pos = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, parent_offset);
7307 int fld_offset = offset + bit_pos / 8;
7308
7309 if (find_struct_field (name, TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset),
7310 fld_offset, field_type_p, byte_offset_p,
7311 bit_offset_p, bit_size_p, index_p))
7312 return 1;
7313 }
7314
7315 return 0;
7316 }
7317
7318 /* Number of user-visible fields in record type TYPE. */
7319
7320 static int
7321 num_visible_fields (struct type *type)
7322 {
7323 int n;
7324
7325 n = 0;
7326 find_struct_field (NULL, type, 0, NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &n);
7327 return n;
7328 }
7329
7330 /* Look for a field NAME in ARG. Adjust the address of ARG by OFFSET bytes,
7331 and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7332 If found, return value, else return NULL.
7333
7334 Searches recursively through wrapper fields (e.g., '_parent').
7335
7336 In the case of homonyms in the tagged types, please refer to the
7337 long explanation in find_struct_field's function documentation. */
7338
7339 static struct value *
7340 ada_search_struct_field (const char *name, struct value *arg, int offset,
7341 struct type *type)
7342 {
7343 int i;
7344 int parent_offset = -1;
7345
7346 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7347 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7348 {
7349 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7350
7351 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7352 continue;
7353
7354 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7355 {
7356 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7357 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7358 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7359 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7360 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7361 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7362 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7363
7364 parent_offset = i;
7365 continue;
7366 }
7367
7368 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7369 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7370
7371 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7372 {
7373 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7374 ada_search_struct_field (name, arg,
7375 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7376 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7377
7378 if (v != NULL)
7379 return v;
7380 }
7381
7382 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7383 {
7384 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See find_struct_field. */
7385 int j;
7386 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7387 i));
7388 int var_offset = offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8;
7389
7390 for (j = 0; j < TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type); j += 1)
7391 {
7392 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field /* Force line
7393 break. */
7394 (name, arg,
7395 var_offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, j) / 8,
7396 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j));
7397
7398 if (v != NULL)
7399 return v;
7400 }
7401 }
7402 }
7403
7404 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7405 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7406
7407 if (parent_offset != -1)
7408 {
7409 struct value *v = ada_search_struct_field (
7410 name, arg, offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, parent_offset) / 8,
7411 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset));
7412
7413 if (v != NULL)
7414 return v;
7415 }
7416
7417 return NULL;
7418 }
7419
7420 static struct value *ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *, struct value *,
7421 int, struct type *);
7422
7423
7424 /* Return field #INDEX in ARG, where the index is that returned by
7425 * find_struct_field through its INDEX_P argument. Adjust the address
7426 * of ARG by OFFSET bytes, and search in it assuming it has (class) type TYPE.
7427 * If found, return value, else return NULL. */
7428
7429 static struct value *
7430 ada_index_struct_field (int index, struct value *arg, int offset,
7431 struct type *type)
7432 {
7433 return ada_index_struct_field_1 (&index, arg, offset, type);
7434 }
7435
7436
7437 /* Auxiliary function for ada_index_struct_field. Like
7438 * ada_index_struct_field, but takes index from *INDEX_P and modifies
7439 * *INDEX_P. */
7440
7441 static struct value *
7442 ada_index_struct_field_1 (int *index_p, struct value *arg, int offset,
7443 struct type *type)
7444 {
7445 int i;
7446 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7447
7448 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7449 {
7450 if (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i) == NULL)
7451 continue;
7452 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7453 {
7454 struct value *v = /* Do not let indent join lines here. */
7455 ada_index_struct_field_1 (index_p, arg,
7456 offset + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, i) / 8,
7457 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i));
7458
7459 if (v != NULL)
7460 return v;
7461 }
7462
7463 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7464 {
7465 /* PNH: Do we ever get here? See ada_search_struct_field,
7466 find_struct_field. */
7467 error (_("Cannot assign this kind of variant record"));
7468 }
7469 else if (*index_p == 0)
7470 return ada_value_primitive_field (arg, offset, i, type);
7471 else
7472 *index_p -= 1;
7473 }
7474 return NULL;
7475 }
7476
7477 /* Return a string representation of type TYPE. */
7478
7479 static std::string
7480 type_as_string (struct type *type)
7481 {
7482 string_file tmp_stream;
7483
7484 type_print (type, "", &tmp_stream, -1);
7485
7486 return std::move (tmp_stream.string ());
7487 }
7488
7489 /* Given a type TYPE, look up the type of the component of type named NAME.
7490 If DISPP is non-null, add its byte displacement from the beginning of a
7491 structure (pointed to by a value) of type TYPE to *DISPP (does not
7492 work for packed fields).
7493
7494 Matches any field whose name has NAME as a prefix, possibly
7495 followed by "___".
7496
7497 TYPE can be either a struct or union. If REFOK, TYPE may also
7498 be a (pointer or reference)+ to a struct or union, and the
7499 ultimate target type will be searched.
7500
7501 Looks recursively into variant clauses and parent types.
7502
7503 In the case of homonyms in the tagged types, please refer to the
7504 long explanation in find_struct_field's function documentation.
7505
7506 If NOERR is nonzero, return NULL if NAME is not suitably defined or
7507 TYPE is not a type of the right kind. */
7508
7509 static struct type *
7510 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (struct type *type, const char *name, int refok,
7511 int noerr)
7512 {
7513 int i;
7514 int parent_offset = -1;
7515
7516 if (name == NULL)
7517 goto BadName;
7518
7519 if (refok && type != NULL)
7520 while (1)
7521 {
7522 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7523 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
7524 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
7525 break;
7526 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
7527 }
7528
7529 if (type == NULL
7530 || (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7531 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_UNION))
7532 {
7533 if (noerr)
7534 return NULL;
7535
7536 error (_("Type %s is not a structure or union type"),
7537 type != NULL ? type_as_string (type).c_str () : _("(null)"));
7538 }
7539
7540 type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
7541
7542 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); i += 1)
7543 {
7544 const char *t_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, i);
7545 struct type *t;
7546
7547 if (t_field_name == NULL)
7548 continue;
7549
7550 else if (ada_is_parent_field (type, i))
7551 {
7552 /* This is a field pointing us to the parent type of a tagged
7553 type. As hinted in this function's documentation, we give
7554 preference to fields in the current record first, so what
7555 we do here is just record the index of this field before
7556 we skip it. If it turns out we couldn't find our field
7557 in the current record, then we'll get back to it and search
7558 inside it whether the field might exist in the parent. */
7559
7560 parent_offset = i;
7561 continue;
7562 }
7563
7564 else if (field_name_match (t_field_name, name))
7565 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i);
7566
7567 else if (ada_is_wrapper_field (type, i))
7568 {
7569 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, i), name,
7570 0, 1);
7571 if (t != NULL)
7572 return t;
7573 }
7574
7575 else if (ada_is_variant_part (type, i))
7576 {
7577 int j;
7578 struct type *field_type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type,
7579 i));
7580
7581 for (j = TYPE_NFIELDS (field_type) - 1; j >= 0; j -= 1)
7582 {
7583 /* FIXME pnh 2008/01/26: We check for a field that is
7584 NOT wrapped in a struct, since the compiler sometimes
7585 generates these for unchecked variant types. Revisit
7586 if the compiler changes this practice. */
7587 const char *v_field_name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (field_type, j);
7588
7589 if (v_field_name != NULL
7590 && field_name_match (v_field_name, name))
7591 t = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type, j);
7592 else
7593 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (field_type,
7594 j),
7595 name, 0, 1);
7596
7597 if (t != NULL)
7598 return t;
7599 }
7600 }
7601
7602 }
7603
7604 /* Field not found so far. If this is a tagged type which
7605 has a parent, try finding that field in the parent now. */
7606
7607 if (parent_offset != -1)
7608 {
7609 struct type *t;
7610
7611 t = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, parent_offset),
7612 name, 0, 1);
7613 if (t != NULL)
7614 return t;
7615 }
7616
7617 BadName:
7618 if (!noerr)
7619 {
7620 const char *name_str = name != NULL ? name : _("<null>");
7621
7622 error (_("Type %s has no component named %s"),
7623 type_as_string (type).c_str (), name_str);
7624 }
7625
7626 return NULL;
7627 }
7628
7629 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7630 within a value of type OUTER_TYPE, return true iff VAR_TYPE
7631 represents an unchecked union (that is, the variant part of a
7632 record that is named in an Unchecked_Union pragma). */
7633
7634 static int
7635 is_unchecked_variant (struct type *var_type, struct type *outer_type)
7636 {
7637 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7638
7639 return (ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (outer_type, discrim_name, 0, 1) == NULL);
7640 }
7641
7642
7643 /* Assuming that VAR_TYPE is the type of a variant part of a record (a union),
7644 within OUTER, determine which variant clause (field number in VAR_TYPE,
7645 numbering from 0) is applicable. Returns -1 if none are. */
7646
7647 int
7648 ada_which_variant_applies (struct type *var_type, struct value *outer)
7649 {
7650 int others_clause;
7651 int i;
7652 const char *discrim_name = ada_variant_discrim_name (var_type);
7653 struct value *discrim;
7654 LONGEST discrim_val;
7655
7656 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes problems
7657 because we will end up trying to resolve a type that is currently
7658 being constructed. */
7659 discrim = ada_value_struct_elt (outer, discrim_name, 1);
7660 if (discrim == NULL)
7661 return -1;
7662 discrim_val = value_as_long (discrim);
7663
7664 others_clause = -1;
7665 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (var_type); i += 1)
7666 {
7667 if (ada_is_others_clause (var_type, i))
7668 others_clause = i;
7669 else if (ada_in_variant (discrim_val, var_type, i))
7670 return i;
7671 }
7672
7673 return others_clause;
7674 }
7675 \f
7676
7677
7678 /* Dynamic-Sized Records */
7679
7680 /* Strategy: The type ostensibly attached to a value with dynamic size
7681 (i.e., a size that is not statically recorded in the debugging
7682 data) does not accurately reflect the size or layout of the value.
7683 Our strategy is to convert these values to values with accurate,
7684 conventional types that are constructed on the fly. */
7685
7686 /* There is a subtle and tricky problem here. In general, we cannot
7687 determine the size of dynamic records without its data. However,
7688 the 'struct value' data structure, which GDB uses to represent
7689 quantities in the inferior process (the target), requires the size
7690 of the type at the time of its allocation in order to reserve space
7691 for GDB's internal copy of the data. That's why the
7692 'to_fixed_xxx_type' routines take (target) addresses as parameters,
7693 rather than struct value*s.
7694
7695 However, GDB's internal history variables ($1, $2, etc.) are
7696 struct value*s containing internal copies of the data that are not, in
7697 general, the same as the data at their corresponding addresses in
7698 the target. Fortunately, the types we give to these values are all
7699 conventional, fixed-size types (as per the strategy described
7700 above), so that we don't usually have to perform the
7701 'to_fixed_xxx_type' conversions to look at their values.
7702 Unfortunately, there is one exception: if one of the internal
7703 history variables is an array whose elements are unconstrained
7704 records, then we will need to create distinct fixed types for each
7705 element selected. */
7706
7707 /* The upshot of all of this is that many routines take a (type, host
7708 address, target address) triple as arguments to represent a value.
7709 The host address, if non-null, is supposed to contain an internal
7710 copy of the relevant data; otherwise, the program is to consult the
7711 target at the target address. */
7712
7713 /* Assuming that VAL0 represents a pointer value, the result of
7714 dereferencing it. Differs from value_ind in its treatment of
7715 dynamic-sized types. */
7716
7717 struct value *
7718 ada_value_ind (struct value *val0)
7719 {
7720 struct value *val = value_ind (val0);
7721
7722 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7723 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7724
7725 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7726 }
7727
7728 /* The value resulting from dereferencing any "reference to"
7729 qualifiers on VAL0. */
7730
7731 static struct value *
7732 ada_coerce_ref (struct value *val0)
7733 {
7734 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val0)) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
7735 {
7736 struct value *val = val0;
7737
7738 val = coerce_ref (val);
7739
7740 if (ada_is_tagged_type (value_type (val), 0))
7741 val = ada_tag_value_at_base_address (val);
7742
7743 return ada_to_fixed_value (val);
7744 }
7745 else
7746 return val0;
7747 }
7748
7749 /* Return the bit alignment required for field #F of template type TYPE. */
7750
7751 static unsigned int
7752 field_alignment (struct type *type, int f)
7753 {
7754 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
7755 int len;
7756 int align_offset;
7757
7758 /* The field name should never be null, unless the debugging information
7759 is somehow malformed. In this case, we assume the field does not
7760 require any alignment. */
7761 if (name == NULL)
7762 return 1;
7763
7764 len = strlen (name);
7765
7766 if (!isdigit (name[len - 1]))
7767 return 1;
7768
7769 if (isdigit (name[len - 2]))
7770 align_offset = len - 2;
7771 else
7772 align_offset = len - 1;
7773
7774 if (align_offset < 7 || !startswith (name + align_offset - 6, "___XV"))
7775 return TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7776
7777 return atoi (name + align_offset) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
7778 }
7779
7780 /* Find a typedef or tag symbol named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. */
7781
7782 static struct symbol *
7783 ada_find_any_type_symbol (const char *name)
7784 {
7785 struct symbol *sym;
7786
7787 sym = standard_lookup (name, get_selected_block (NULL), VAR_DOMAIN);
7788 if (sym != NULL && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) == LOC_TYPEDEF)
7789 return sym;
7790
7791 sym = standard_lookup (name, NULL, STRUCT_DOMAIN);
7792 return sym;
7793 }
7794
7795 /* Find a type named NAME. Ignores ambiguity. This routine will look
7796 solely for types defined by debug info, it will not search the GDB
7797 primitive types. */
7798
7799 static struct type *
7800 ada_find_any_type (const char *name)
7801 {
7802 struct symbol *sym = ada_find_any_type_symbol (name);
7803
7804 if (sym != NULL)
7805 return SYMBOL_TYPE (sym);
7806
7807 return NULL;
7808 }
7809
7810 /* Given NAME_SYM and an associated BLOCK, find a "renaming" symbol
7811 associated with NAME_SYM's name. NAME_SYM may itself be a renaming
7812 symbol, in which case it is returned. Otherwise, this looks for
7813 symbols whose name is that of NAME_SYM suffixed with "___XR".
7814 Return symbol if found, and NULL otherwise. */
7815
7816 static bool
7817 ada_is_renaming_symbol (struct symbol *name_sym)
7818 {
7819 const char *name = name_sym->linkage_name ();
7820 return strstr (name, "___XR") != NULL;
7821 }
7822
7823 /* Because of GNAT encoding conventions, several GDB symbols may match a
7824 given type name. If the type denoted by TYPE0 is to be preferred to
7825 that of TYPE1 for purposes of type printing, return non-zero;
7826 otherwise return 0. */
7827
7828 int
7829 ada_prefer_type (struct type *type0, struct type *type1)
7830 {
7831 if (type1 == NULL)
7832 return 1;
7833 else if (type0 == NULL)
7834 return 0;
7835 else if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7836 return 1;
7837 else if (TYPE_CODE (type0) == TYPE_CODE_VOID)
7838 return 0;
7839 else if (TYPE_NAME (type1) == NULL && TYPE_NAME (type0) != NULL)
7840 return 1;
7841 else if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0))
7842 return 1;
7843 else if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type0)
7844 && !ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type1))
7845 return 1;
7846 else
7847 {
7848 const char *type0_name = TYPE_NAME (type0);
7849 const char *type1_name = TYPE_NAME (type1);
7850
7851 if (type0_name != NULL && strstr (type0_name, "___XR") != NULL
7852 && (type1_name == NULL || strstr (type1_name, "___XR") == NULL))
7853 return 1;
7854 }
7855 return 0;
7856 }
7857
7858 /* The name of TYPE, which is its TYPE_NAME. Null if TYPE is
7859 null. */
7860
7861 const char *
7862 ada_type_name (struct type *type)
7863 {
7864 if (type == NULL)
7865 return NULL;
7866 return TYPE_NAME (type);
7867 }
7868
7869 /* Search the list of "descriptive" types associated to TYPE for a type
7870 whose name is NAME. */
7871
7872 static struct type *
7873 find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (struct type *type, const char *name)
7874 {
7875 struct type *result, *tmp;
7876
7877 if (ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p)
7878 return NULL;
7879
7880 /* If there no descriptive-type info, then there is no parallel type
7881 to be found. */
7882 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7883 return NULL;
7884
7885 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (type);
7886 while (result != NULL)
7887 {
7888 const char *result_name = ada_type_name (result);
7889
7890 if (result_name == NULL)
7891 {
7892 warning (_("unexpected null name on descriptive type"));
7893 return NULL;
7894 }
7895
7896 /* If the names match, stop. */
7897 if (strcmp (result_name, name) == 0)
7898 break;
7899
7900 /* Otherwise, look at the next item on the list, if any. */
7901 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7902 tmp = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7903 else
7904 tmp = NULL;
7905
7906 /* If not found either, try after having resolved the typedef. */
7907 if (tmp != NULL)
7908 result = tmp;
7909 else
7910 {
7911 result = check_typedef (result);
7912 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (result))
7913 result = TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE_TYPE (result);
7914 else
7915 result = NULL;
7916 }
7917 }
7918
7919 /* If we didn't find a match, see whether this is a packed array. With
7920 older compilers, the descriptive type information is either absent or
7921 irrelevant when it comes to packed arrays so the above lookup fails.
7922 Fall back to using a parallel lookup by name in this case. */
7923 if (result == NULL && ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type))
7924 return ada_find_any_type (name);
7925
7926 return result;
7927 }
7928
7929 /* Find a parallel type to TYPE with the specified NAME, using the
7930 descriptive type taken from the debugging information, if available,
7931 and otherwise using the (slower) name-based method. */
7932
7933 static struct type *
7934 ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (struct type *type, const char *name)
7935 {
7936 struct type *result = NULL;
7937
7938 if (HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
7939 result = find_parallel_type_by_descriptive_type (type, name);
7940 else
7941 result = ada_find_any_type (name);
7942
7943 return result;
7944 }
7945
7946 /* Same as above, but specify the name of the parallel type by appending
7947 SUFFIX to the name of TYPE. */
7948
7949 struct type *
7950 ada_find_parallel_type (struct type *type, const char *suffix)
7951 {
7952 char *name;
7953 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type);
7954 int len;
7955
7956 if (type_name == NULL)
7957 return NULL;
7958
7959 len = strlen (type_name);
7960
7961 name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (suffix) + 1);
7962
7963 strcpy (name, type_name);
7964 strcpy (name + len, suffix);
7965
7966 return ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type, name);
7967 }
7968
7969 /* If TYPE is a variable-size record type, return the corresponding template
7970 type describing its fields. Otherwise, return NULL. */
7971
7972 static struct type *
7973 dynamic_template_type (struct type *type)
7974 {
7975 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
7976
7977 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
7978 || ada_type_name (type) == NULL)
7979 return NULL;
7980 else
7981 {
7982 int len = strlen (ada_type_name (type));
7983
7984 if (len > 6 && strcmp (ada_type_name (type) + len - 6, "___XVE") == 0)
7985 return type;
7986 else
7987 return ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE");
7988 }
7989 }
7990
7991 /* Assuming that TEMPL_TYPE is a union or struct type, returns
7992 non-zero iff field FIELD_NUM of TEMPL_TYPE has dynamic size. */
7993
7994 static int
7995 is_dynamic_field (struct type *templ_type, int field_num)
7996 {
7997 const char *name = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (templ_type, field_num);
7998
7999 return name != NULL
8000 && TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (templ_type, field_num)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
8001 && strstr (name, "___XVL") != NULL;
8002 }
8003
8004 /* The index of the variant field of TYPE, or -1 if TYPE does not
8005 represent a variant record type. */
8006
8007 static int
8008 variant_field_index (struct type *type)
8009 {
8010 int f;
8011
8012 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
8013 return -1;
8014
8015 for (f = 0; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (type); f += 1)
8016 {
8017 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
8018 return f;
8019 }
8020 return -1;
8021 }
8022
8023 /* A record type with no fields. */
8024
8025 static struct type *
8026 empty_record (struct type *templ)
8027 {
8028 struct type *type = alloc_type_copy (templ);
8029
8030 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
8031 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = 0;
8032 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = NULL;
8033 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (type);
8034 TYPE_NAME (type) = "<empty>";
8035 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
8036 return type;
8037 }
8038
8039 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8040 the value of type TYPE at VALADDR or ADDRESS (see comments at
8041 the beginning of this section) VAL according to GNAT conventions.
8042 DVAL0 should describe the (portion of a) record that contains any
8043 necessary discriminants. It should be NULL if value_type (VAL) is
8044 an outer-level type (i.e., as opposed to a branch of a variant.) A
8045 variant field (unless unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch
8046 of the variant.
8047
8048 If not KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS, then all fields whose position or
8049 length are not statically known are discarded. As a consequence,
8050 VALADDR, ADDRESS and DVAL0 are ignored.
8051
8052 NOTE: Limitations: For now, we assume that dynamic fields and
8053 variants occupy whole numbers of bytes. However, they need not be
8054 byte-aligned. */
8055
8056 struct type *
8057 ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (struct type *type,
8058 const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8059 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0,
8060 int keep_dynamic_fields)
8061 {
8062 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8063 struct value *dval;
8064 struct type *rtype;
8065 int nfields, bit_len;
8066 int variant_field;
8067 long off;
8068 int fld_bit_len;
8069 int f;
8070
8071 /* Compute the number of fields in this record type that are going
8072 to be processed: unless keep_dynamic_fields, this includes only
8073 fields whose position and length are static will be processed. */
8074 if (keep_dynamic_fields)
8075 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
8076 else
8077 {
8078 nfields = 0;
8079 while (nfields < TYPE_NFIELDS (type)
8080 && !ada_is_variant_part (type, nfields)
8081 && !is_dynamic_field (type, nfields))
8082 nfields++;
8083 }
8084
8085 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8086 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
8087 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8088 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
8089 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) = (struct field *)
8090 TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8091 memset (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), 0, sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8092 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
8093 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8094
8095 off = 0;
8096 bit_len = 0;
8097 variant_field = -1;
8098
8099 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8100 {
8101 off = align_up (off, field_alignment (type, f))
8102 + TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, f);
8103 SET_FIELD_BITPOS (TYPE_FIELD (rtype, f), off);
8104 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = 0;
8105
8106 if (ada_is_variant_part (type, f))
8107 {
8108 variant_field = f;
8109 fld_bit_len = 0;
8110 }
8111 else if (is_dynamic_field (type, f))
8112 {
8113 const gdb_byte *field_valaddr = valaddr;
8114 CORE_ADDR field_address = address;
8115 struct type *field_type =
8116 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f));
8117
8118 if (dval0 == NULL)
8119 {
8120 /* rtype's length is computed based on the run-time
8121 value of discriminants. If the discriminants are not
8122 initialized, the type size may be completely bogus and
8123 GDB may fail to allocate a value for it. So check the
8124 size first before creating the value. */
8125 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (rtype);
8126 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here
8127 causes problems because we will end up trying to
8128 resolve a type that is currently being
8129 constructed. */
8130 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype,
8131 valaddr,
8132 address);
8133 rtype = value_type (dval);
8134 }
8135 else
8136 dval = dval0;
8137
8138 /* If the type referenced by this field is an aligner type, we need
8139 to unwrap that aligner type, because its size might not be set.
8140 Keeping the aligner type would cause us to compute the wrong
8141 size for this field, impacting the offset of the all the fields
8142 that follow this one. */
8143 if (ada_is_aligner_type (field_type))
8144 {
8145 long field_offset = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (field_type, f);
8146
8147 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr, field_offset);
8148 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address, field_offset);
8149 field_type = ada_aligned_type (field_type);
8150 }
8151
8152 field_valaddr = cond_offset_host (field_valaddr,
8153 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8154 field_address = cond_offset_target (field_address,
8155 off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
8156
8157 /* Get the fixed type of the field. Note that, in this case,
8158 we do not want to get the real type out of the tag: if
8159 the current field is the parent part of a tagged record,
8160 we will get the tag of the object. Clearly wrong: the real
8161 type of the parent is not the real type of the child. We
8162 would end up in an infinite loop. */
8163 field_type = ada_get_base_type (field_type);
8164 field_type = ada_to_fixed_type (field_type, field_valaddr,
8165 field_address, dval, 0);
8166 /* If the field size is already larger than the maximum
8167 object size, then the record itself will necessarily
8168 be larger than the maximum object size. We need to make
8169 this check now, because the size might be so ridiculously
8170 large (due to an uninitialized variable in the inferior)
8171 that it would cause an overflow when adding it to the
8172 record size. */
8173 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (field_type);
8174
8175 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = field_type;
8176 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8177 /* The multiplication can potentially overflow. But because
8178 the field length has been size-checked just above, and
8179 assuming that the maximum size is a reasonable value,
8180 an overflow should not happen in practice. So rather than
8181 adding overflow recovery code to this already complex code,
8182 we just assume that it's not going to happen. */
8183 fld_bit_len =
8184 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8185 }
8186 else
8187 {
8188 /* Note: If this field's type is a typedef, it is important
8189 to preserve the typedef layer.
8190
8191 Otherwise, we might be transforming a typedef to a fat
8192 pointer (encoding a pointer to an unconstrained array),
8193 into a basic fat pointer (encoding an unconstrained
8194 array). As both types are implemented using the same
8195 structure, the typedef is the only clue which allows us
8196 to distinguish between the two options. Stripping it
8197 would prevent us from printing this field appropriately. */
8198 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8199 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f);
8200 if (TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f) > 0)
8201 fld_bit_len =
8202 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, f) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type, f);
8203 else
8204 {
8205 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f);
8206
8207 /* We need to be careful of typedefs when computing
8208 the length of our field. If this is a typedef,
8209 get the length of the target type, not the length
8210 of the typedef. */
8211 if (TYPE_CODE (field_type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
8212 field_type = ada_typedef_target_type (field_type);
8213
8214 fld_bit_len =
8215 TYPE_LENGTH (ada_check_typedef (field_type)) * TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8216 }
8217 }
8218 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8219 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8220 off += fld_bit_len;
8221 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8222 align_up (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8223 }
8224
8225 /* We handle the variant part, if any, at the end because of certain
8226 odd cases in which it is re-ordered so as NOT to be the last field of
8227 the record. This can happen in the presence of representation
8228 clauses. */
8229 if (variant_field >= 0)
8230 {
8231 struct type *branch_type;
8232
8233 off = TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (rtype, variant_field);
8234
8235 if (dval0 == NULL)
8236 {
8237 /* Using plain value_from_contents_and_address here causes
8238 problems because we will end up trying to resolve a type
8239 that is currently being constructed. */
8240 dval = value_from_contents_and_address_unresolved (rtype, valaddr,
8241 address);
8242 rtype = value_type (dval);
8243 }
8244 else
8245 dval = dval0;
8246
8247 branch_type =
8248 to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8249 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8250 cond_offset_host (valaddr, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8251 cond_offset_target (address, off / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8252 if (branch_type == NULL)
8253 {
8254 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype); f += 1)
8255 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
8256 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
8257 }
8258 else
8259 {
8260 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8261 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8262 fld_bit_len =
8263 TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field)) *
8264 TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8265 if (off + fld_bit_len > bit_len)
8266 bit_len = off + fld_bit_len;
8267 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) =
8268 align_up (bit_len, TARGET_CHAR_BIT) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT;
8269 }
8270 }
8271
8272 /* According to exp_dbug.ads, the size of TYPE for variable-size records
8273 should contain the alignment of that record, which should be a strictly
8274 positive value. If null or negative, then something is wrong, most
8275 probably in the debug info. In that case, we don't round up the size
8276 of the resulting type. If this record is not part of another structure,
8277 the current RTYPE length might be good enough for our purposes. */
8278 if (TYPE_LENGTH (type) <= 0)
8279 {
8280 if (TYPE_NAME (rtype))
8281 warning (_("Invalid type size for `%s' detected: %s."),
8282 TYPE_NAME (rtype), pulongest (TYPE_LENGTH (type)));
8283 else
8284 warning (_("Invalid type size for <unnamed> detected: %s."),
8285 pulongest (TYPE_LENGTH (type)));
8286 }
8287 else
8288 {
8289 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = align_up (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype),
8290 TYPE_LENGTH (type));
8291 }
8292
8293 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8294 if (TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) > varsize_limit)
8295 error (_("record type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8296 return rtype;
8297 }
8298
8299 /* As for ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 with KEEP_DYNAMIC_FIELDS
8300 of 1. */
8301
8302 static struct type *
8303 template_to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8304 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8305 {
8306 return ada_template_to_fixed_record_type_1 (type, valaddr,
8307 address, dval0, 1);
8308 }
8309
8310 /* An ordinary record type in which ___XVL-convention fields and
8311 ___XVU- and ___XVN-convention field types in TYPE0 are replaced with
8312 static approximations, containing all possible fields. Uses
8313 no runtime values. Useless for use in values, but that's OK,
8314 since the results are used only for type determinations. Works on both
8315 structs and unions. Representation note: to save space, we memorize
8316 the result of this function in the TYPE_TARGET_TYPE of the
8317 template type. */
8318
8319 static struct type *
8320 template_to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8321 {
8322 struct type *type;
8323 int nfields;
8324 int f;
8325
8326 /* No need no do anything if the input type is already fixed. */
8327 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8328 return type0;
8329
8330 /* Likewise if we already have computed the static approximation. */
8331 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) != NULL)
8332 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0);
8333
8334 /* Don't clone TYPE0 until we are sure we are going to need a copy. */
8335 type = type0;
8336 nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type0);
8337
8338 /* Whether or not we cloned TYPE0, cache the result so that we don't do
8339 recompute all over next time. */
8340 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type;
8341
8342 for (f = 0; f < nfields; f += 1)
8343 {
8344 struct type *field_type = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type0, f);
8345 struct type *new_type;
8346
8347 if (is_dynamic_field (type0, f))
8348 {
8349 field_type = ada_check_typedef (field_type);
8350 new_type = to_static_fixed_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (field_type));
8351 }
8352 else
8353 new_type = static_unwrap_type (field_type);
8354
8355 if (new_type != field_type)
8356 {
8357 /* Clone TYPE0 only the first time we get a new field type. */
8358 if (type == type0)
8359 {
8360 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0) = type = alloc_type_copy (type0);
8361 TYPE_CODE (type) = TYPE_CODE (type0);
8362 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (type);
8363 TYPE_NFIELDS (type) = nfields;
8364 TYPE_FIELDS (type) = (struct field *)
8365 TYPE_ALLOC (type, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8366 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (type), TYPE_FIELDS (type0),
8367 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8368 TYPE_NAME (type) = ada_type_name (type0);
8369 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type) = 1;
8370 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = 0;
8371 }
8372 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, f) = new_type;
8373 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, f) = TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type0, f);
8374 }
8375 }
8376
8377 return type;
8378 }
8379
8380 /* Given an object of type TYPE whose contents are at VALADDR and
8381 whose address in memory is ADDRESS, returns a revision of TYPE,
8382 which should be a non-dynamic-sized record, in which the variant
8383 part, if any, is replaced with the appropriate branch. Looks
8384 for discriminant values in DVAL0, which can be NULL if the record
8385 contains the necessary discriminant values. */
8386
8387 static struct type *
8388 to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8389 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval0)
8390 {
8391 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
8392 struct value *dval;
8393 struct type *rtype;
8394 struct type *branch_type;
8395 int nfields = TYPE_NFIELDS (type);
8396 int variant_field = variant_field_index (type);
8397
8398 if (variant_field == -1)
8399 return type;
8400
8401 if (dval0 == NULL)
8402 {
8403 dval = value_from_contents_and_address (type, valaddr, address);
8404 type = value_type (dval);
8405 }
8406 else
8407 dval = dval0;
8408
8409 rtype = alloc_type_copy (type);
8410 TYPE_CODE (rtype) = TYPE_CODE_STRUCT;
8411 INIT_NONE_SPECIFIC (rtype);
8412 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) = nfields;
8413 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype) =
8414 (struct field *) TYPE_ALLOC (rtype, nfields * sizeof (struct field));
8415 memcpy (TYPE_FIELDS (rtype), TYPE_FIELDS (type),
8416 sizeof (struct field) * nfields);
8417 TYPE_NAME (rtype) = ada_type_name (type);
8418 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (rtype) = 1;
8419 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) = TYPE_LENGTH (type);
8420
8421 branch_type = to_fixed_variant_branch_type
8422 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field),
8423 cond_offset_host (valaddr,
8424 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8425 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT),
8426 cond_offset_target (address,
8427 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type, variant_field)
8428 / TARGET_CHAR_BIT), dval);
8429 if (branch_type == NULL)
8430 {
8431 int f;
8432
8433 for (f = variant_field + 1; f < nfields; f += 1)
8434 TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f - 1] = TYPE_FIELDS (rtype)[f];
8435 TYPE_NFIELDS (rtype) -= 1;
8436 }
8437 else
8438 {
8439 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (rtype, variant_field) = branch_type;
8440 TYPE_FIELD_NAME (rtype, variant_field) = "S";
8441 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (rtype, variant_field) = 0;
8442 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) += TYPE_LENGTH (branch_type);
8443 }
8444 TYPE_LENGTH (rtype) -= TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, variant_field));
8445
8446 value_free_to_mark (mark);
8447 return rtype;
8448 }
8449
8450 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8451 the value at (TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS) [see explanation at
8452 beginning of this section]. Any necessary discriminants' values
8453 should be in DVAL, a record value; it may be NULL if the object
8454 at ADDR itself contains any necessary discriminant values.
8455 Additionally, VALADDR and ADDRESS may also be NULL if no discriminant
8456 values from the record are needed. Except in the case that DVAL,
8457 VALADDR, and ADDRESS are all 0 or NULL, a variant field (unless
8458 unchecked) is replaced by a particular branch of the variant.
8459
8460 NOTE: the case in which DVAL and VALADDR are NULL and ADDRESS is 0
8461 is questionable and may be removed. It can arise during the
8462 processing of an unconstrained-array-of-record type where all the
8463 variant branches have exactly the same size. This is because in
8464 such cases, the compiler does not bother to use the XVS convention
8465 when encoding the record. I am currently dubious of this
8466 shortcut and suspect the compiler should be altered. FIXME. */
8467
8468 static struct type *
8469 to_fixed_record_type (struct type *type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8470 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8471 {
8472 struct type *templ_type;
8473
8474 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8475 return type0;
8476
8477 templ_type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8478
8479 if (templ_type != NULL)
8480 return template_to_fixed_record_type (templ_type, valaddr, address, dval);
8481 else if (variant_field_index (type0) >= 0)
8482 {
8483 if (dval == NULL && valaddr == NULL && address == 0)
8484 return type0;
8485 return to_record_with_fixed_variant_part (type0, valaddr, address,
8486 dval);
8487 }
8488 else
8489 {
8490 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0) = 1;
8491 return type0;
8492 }
8493
8494 }
8495
8496 /* An ordinary record type (with fixed-length fields) that describes
8497 the value at (VAR_TYPE0, VALADDR, ADDRESS), where VAR_TYPE0 is a
8498 union type. Any necessary discriminants' values should be in DVAL,
8499 a record value. That is, this routine selects the appropriate
8500 branch of the union at ADDR according to the discriminant value
8501 indicated in the union's type name. Returns VAR_TYPE0 itself if
8502 it represents a variant subject to a pragma Unchecked_Union. */
8503
8504 static struct type *
8505 to_fixed_variant_branch_type (struct type *var_type0, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8506 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval)
8507 {
8508 int which;
8509 struct type *templ_type;
8510 struct type *var_type;
8511
8512 if (TYPE_CODE (var_type0) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
8513 var_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (var_type0);
8514 else
8515 var_type = var_type0;
8516
8517 templ_type = ada_find_parallel_type (var_type, "___XVU");
8518
8519 if (templ_type != NULL)
8520 var_type = templ_type;
8521
8522 if (is_unchecked_variant (var_type, value_type (dval)))
8523 return var_type0;
8524 which = ada_which_variant_applies (var_type, dval);
8525
8526 if (which < 0)
8527 return empty_record (var_type);
8528 else if (is_dynamic_field (var_type, which))
8529 return to_fixed_record_type
8530 (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)),
8531 valaddr, address, dval);
8532 else if (variant_field_index (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which)) >= 0)
8533 return
8534 to_fixed_record_type
8535 (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which), valaddr, address, dval);
8536 else
8537 return TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (var_type, which);
8538 }
8539
8540 /* Assuming RANGE_TYPE is a TYPE_CODE_RANGE, return nonzero if
8541 ENCODING_TYPE, a type following the GNAT conventions for discrete
8542 type encodings, only carries redundant information. */
8543
8544 static int
8545 ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (struct type *range_type,
8546 struct type *encoding_type)
8547 {
8548 const char *bounds_str;
8549 int n;
8550 LONGEST lo, hi;
8551
8552 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (range_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE);
8553
8554 if (TYPE_CODE (get_base_type (range_type))
8555 != TYPE_CODE (get_base_type (encoding_type)))
8556 {
8557 /* The compiler probably used a simple base type to describe
8558 the range type instead of the range's actual base type,
8559 expecting us to get the real base type from the encoding
8560 anyway. In this situation, the encoding cannot be ignored
8561 as redundant. */
8562 return 0;
8563 }
8564
8565 if (is_dynamic_type (range_type))
8566 return 0;
8567
8568 if (TYPE_NAME (encoding_type) == NULL)
8569 return 0;
8570
8571 bounds_str = strstr (TYPE_NAME (encoding_type), "___XDLU_");
8572 if (bounds_str == NULL)
8573 return 0;
8574
8575 n = 8; /* Skip "___XDLU_". */
8576 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &lo, &n))
8577 return 0;
8578 if (TYPE_LOW_BOUND (range_type) != lo)
8579 return 0;
8580
8581 n += 2; /* Skip the "__" separator between the two bounds. */
8582 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &hi, &n))
8583 return 0;
8584 if (TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (range_type) != hi)
8585 return 0;
8586
8587 return 1;
8588 }
8589
8590 /* Given the array type ARRAY_TYPE, return nonzero if DESC_TYPE,
8591 a type following the GNAT encoding for describing array type
8592 indices, only carries redundant information. */
8593
8594 static int
8595 ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (struct type *array_type,
8596 struct type *desc_type)
8597 {
8598 struct type *this_layer = check_typedef (array_type);
8599 int i;
8600
8601 for (i = 0; i < TYPE_NFIELDS (desc_type); i++)
8602 {
8603 if (!ada_is_redundant_range_encoding (TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (this_layer),
8604 TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (desc_type, i)))
8605 return 0;
8606 this_layer = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (this_layer));
8607 }
8608
8609 return 1;
8610 }
8611
8612 /* Assuming that TYPE0 is an array type describing the type of a value
8613 at ADDR, and that DVAL describes a record containing any
8614 discriminants used in TYPE0, returns a type for the value that
8615 contains no dynamic components (that is, no components whose sizes
8616 are determined by run-time quantities). Unless IGNORE_TOO_BIG is
8617 true, gives an error message if the resulting type's size is over
8618 varsize_limit. */
8619
8620 static struct type *
8621 to_fixed_array_type (struct type *type0, struct value *dval,
8622 int ignore_too_big)
8623 {
8624 struct type *index_type_desc;
8625 struct type *result;
8626 int constrained_packed_array_p;
8627 static const char *xa_suffix = "___XA";
8628
8629 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8630 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8631 return type0;
8632
8633 constrained_packed_array_p = ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8634 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8635 type0 = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type0);
8636
8637 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, xa_suffix);
8638
8639 /* As mentioned in exp_dbug.ads, for non bit-packed arrays an
8640 encoding suffixed with 'P' may still be generated. If so,
8641 it should be used to find the XA type. */
8642
8643 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8644 {
8645 const char *type_name = ada_type_name (type0);
8646
8647 if (type_name != NULL)
8648 {
8649 const int len = strlen (type_name);
8650 char *name = (char *) alloca (len + strlen (xa_suffix));
8651
8652 if (type_name[len - 1] == 'P')
8653 {
8654 strcpy (name, type_name);
8655 strcpy (name + len - 1, xa_suffix);
8656 index_type_desc = ada_find_parallel_type_with_name (type0, name);
8657 }
8658 }
8659 }
8660
8661 ada_fixup_array_indexes_type (index_type_desc);
8662 if (index_type_desc != NULL
8663 && ada_is_redundant_index_type_desc (type0, index_type_desc))
8664 {
8665 /* Ignore this ___XA parallel type, as it does not bring any
8666 useful information. This allows us to avoid creating fixed
8667 versions of the array's index types, which would be identical
8668 to the original ones. This, in turn, can also help avoid
8669 the creation of fixed versions of the array itself. */
8670 index_type_desc = NULL;
8671 }
8672
8673 if (index_type_desc == NULL)
8674 {
8675 struct type *elt_type0 = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0));
8676
8677 /* NOTE: elt_type---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8678 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8679 debugging data. */
8680 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8681 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8682 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8683 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8684 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8685 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8686 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8687 consult the object tag. */
8688 struct type *elt_type = ada_to_fixed_type (elt_type0, 0, 0, dval, 1);
8689
8690 /* Make sure we always create a new array type when dealing with
8691 packed array types, since we're going to fix-up the array
8692 type length and element bitsize a little further down. */
8693 if (elt_type0 == elt_type && !constrained_packed_array_p)
8694 result = type0;
8695 else
8696 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (type0),
8697 elt_type, TYPE_INDEX_TYPE (type0));
8698 }
8699 else
8700 {
8701 int i;
8702 struct type *elt_type0;
8703
8704 elt_type0 = type0;
8705 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc); i > 0; i -= 1)
8706 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8707
8708 /* NOTE: result---the fixed version of elt_type0---should never
8709 depend on the contents of the array in properly constructed
8710 debugging data. */
8711 /* Create a fixed version of the array element type.
8712 We're not providing the address of an element here,
8713 and thus the actual object value cannot be inspected to do
8714 the conversion. This should not be a problem, since arrays of
8715 unconstrained objects are not allowed. In particular, all
8716 the elements of an array of a tagged type should all be of
8717 the same type specified in the debugging info. No need to
8718 consult the object tag. */
8719 result =
8720 ada_to_fixed_type (ada_check_typedef (elt_type0), 0, 0, dval, 1);
8721
8722 elt_type0 = type0;
8723 for (i = TYPE_NFIELDS (index_type_desc) - 1; i >= 0; i -= 1)
8724 {
8725 struct type *range_type =
8726 to_fixed_range_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (index_type_desc, i), dval);
8727
8728 result = create_array_type (alloc_type_copy (elt_type0),
8729 result, range_type);
8730 elt_type0 = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (elt_type0);
8731 }
8732 if (!ignore_too_big && TYPE_LENGTH (result) > varsize_limit)
8733 error (_("array type with dynamic size is larger than varsize-limit"));
8734 }
8735
8736 /* We want to preserve the type name. This can be useful when
8737 trying to get the type name of a value that has already been
8738 printed (for instance, if the user did "print VAR; whatis $". */
8739 TYPE_NAME (result) = TYPE_NAME (type0);
8740
8741 if (constrained_packed_array_p)
8742 {
8743 /* So far, the resulting type has been created as if the original
8744 type was a regular (non-packed) array type. As a result, the
8745 bitsize of the array elements needs to be set again, and the array
8746 length needs to be recomputed based on that bitsize. */
8747 int len = TYPE_LENGTH (result) / TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (result));
8748 int elt_bitsize = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8749
8750 TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (result, 0) = TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (type0, 0);
8751 TYPE_LENGTH (result) = len * elt_bitsize / HOST_CHAR_BIT;
8752 if (TYPE_LENGTH (result) * HOST_CHAR_BIT < len * elt_bitsize)
8753 TYPE_LENGTH (result)++;
8754 }
8755
8756 TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (result) = 1;
8757 return result;
8758 }
8759
8760
8761 /* A standard type (containing no dynamically sized components)
8762 corresponding to TYPE for the value (TYPE, VALADDR, ADDRESS)
8763 DVAL describes a record containing any discriminants used in TYPE0,
8764 and may be NULL if there are none, or if the object of type TYPE at
8765 ADDRESS or in VALADDR contains these discriminants.
8766
8767 If CHECK_TAG is not null, in the case of tagged types, this function
8768 attempts to locate the object's tag and use it to compute the actual
8769 type. However, when ADDRESS is null, we cannot use it to determine the
8770 location of the tag, and therefore compute the tagged type's actual type.
8771 So we return the tagged type without consulting the tag. */
8772
8773 static struct type *
8774 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8775 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8776 {
8777 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
8778
8779 /* Only un-fixed types need to be handled here. */
8780 if (!HAVE_GNAT_AUX_INFO (type))
8781 return type;
8782
8783 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
8784 {
8785 default:
8786 return type;
8787 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8788 {
8789 struct type *static_type = to_static_fixed_type (type);
8790 struct type *fixed_record_type =
8791 to_fixed_record_type (type, valaddr, address, NULL);
8792
8793 /* If STATIC_TYPE is a tagged type and we know the object's address,
8794 then we can determine its tag, and compute the object's actual
8795 type from there. Note that we have to use the fixed record
8796 type (the parent part of the record may have dynamic fields
8797 and the way the location of _tag is expressed may depend on
8798 them). */
8799
8800 if (check_tag && address != 0 && ada_is_tagged_type (static_type, 0))
8801 {
8802 struct value *tag =
8803 value_tag_from_contents_and_address
8804 (fixed_record_type,
8805 valaddr,
8806 address);
8807 struct type *real_type = type_from_tag (tag);
8808 struct value *obj =
8809 value_from_contents_and_address (fixed_record_type,
8810 valaddr,
8811 address);
8812 fixed_record_type = value_type (obj);
8813 if (real_type != NULL)
8814 return to_fixed_record_type
8815 (real_type, NULL,
8816 value_address (ada_tag_value_at_base_address (obj)), NULL);
8817 }
8818
8819 /* Check to see if there is a parallel ___XVZ variable.
8820 If there is, then it provides the actual size of our type. */
8821 else if (ada_type_name (fixed_record_type) != NULL)
8822 {
8823 const char *name = ada_type_name (fixed_record_type);
8824 char *xvz_name
8825 = (char *) alloca (strlen (name) + 7 /* "___XVZ\0" */);
8826 bool xvz_found = false;
8827 LONGEST size;
8828
8829 xsnprintf (xvz_name, strlen (name) + 7, "%s___XVZ", name);
8830 try
8831 {
8832 xvz_found = get_int_var_value (xvz_name, size);
8833 }
8834 catch (const gdb_exception_error &except)
8835 {
8836 /* We found the variable, but somehow failed to read
8837 its value. Rethrow the same error, but with a little
8838 bit more information, to help the user understand
8839 what went wrong (Eg: the variable might have been
8840 optimized out). */
8841 throw_error (except.error,
8842 _("unable to read value of %s (%s)"),
8843 xvz_name, except.what ());
8844 }
8845
8846 if (xvz_found && TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) != size)
8847 {
8848 fixed_record_type = copy_type (fixed_record_type);
8849 TYPE_LENGTH (fixed_record_type) = size;
8850
8851 /* The FIXED_RECORD_TYPE may have be a stub. We have
8852 observed this when the debugging info is STABS, and
8853 apparently it is something that is hard to fix.
8854
8855 In practice, we don't need the actual type definition
8856 at all, because the presence of the XVZ variable allows us
8857 to assume that there must be a XVS type as well, which we
8858 should be able to use later, when we need the actual type
8859 definition.
8860
8861 In the meantime, pretend that the "fixed" type we are
8862 returning is NOT a stub, because this can cause trouble
8863 when using this type to create new types targeting it.
8864 Indeed, the associated creation routines often check
8865 whether the target type is a stub and will try to replace
8866 it, thus using a type with the wrong size. This, in turn,
8867 might cause the new type to have the wrong size too.
8868 Consider the case of an array, for instance, where the size
8869 of the array is computed from the number of elements in
8870 our array multiplied by the size of its element. */
8871 TYPE_STUB (fixed_record_type) = 0;
8872 }
8873 }
8874 return fixed_record_type;
8875 }
8876 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
8877 return to_fixed_array_type (type, dval, 1);
8878 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8879 if (dval == NULL)
8880 return type;
8881 else
8882 return to_fixed_variant_branch_type (type, valaddr, address, dval);
8883 }
8884 }
8885
8886 /* The same as ada_to_fixed_type_1, except that it preserves the type
8887 if it is a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a type that is already fixed.
8888
8889 The typedef layer needs be preserved in order to differentiate between
8890 arrays and array pointers when both types are implemented using the same
8891 fat pointer. In the array pointer case, the pointer is encoded as
8892 a typedef of the pointer type. For instance, considering:
8893
8894 type String_Access is access String;
8895 S1 : String_Access := null;
8896
8897 To the debugger, S1 is defined as a typedef of type String. But
8898 to the user, it is a pointer. So if the user tries to print S1,
8899 we should not dereference the array, but print the array address
8900 instead.
8901
8902 If we didn't preserve the typedef layer, we would lose the fact that
8903 the type is to be presented as a pointer (needs de-reference before
8904 being printed). And we would also use the source-level type name. */
8905
8906 struct type *
8907 ada_to_fixed_type (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr,
8908 CORE_ADDR address, struct value *dval, int check_tag)
8909
8910 {
8911 struct type *fixed_type =
8912 ada_to_fixed_type_1 (type, valaddr, address, dval, check_tag);
8913
8914 /* If TYPE is a typedef and its target type is the same as the FIXED_TYPE,
8915 then preserve the typedef layer.
8916
8917 Implementation note: We can only check the main-type portion of
8918 the TYPE and FIXED_TYPE, because eliminating the typedef layer
8919 from TYPE now returns a type that has the same instance flags
8920 as TYPE. For instance, if TYPE is a "typedef const", and its
8921 target type is a "struct", then the typedef elimination will return
8922 a "const" version of the target type. See check_typedef for more
8923 details about how the typedef layer elimination is done.
8924
8925 brobecker/2010-11-19: It seems to me that the only case where it is
8926 useful to preserve the typedef layer is when dealing with fat pointers.
8927 Perhaps, we could add a check for that and preserve the typedef layer
8928 only in that situation. But this seems unnecessary so far, probably
8929 because we call check_typedef/ada_check_typedef pretty much everywhere.
8930 */
8931 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF
8932 && (TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (ada_typedef_target_type (type))
8933 == TYPE_MAIN_TYPE (fixed_type)))
8934 return type;
8935
8936 return fixed_type;
8937 }
8938
8939 /* A standard (static-sized) type corresponding as well as possible to
8940 TYPE0, but based on no runtime data. */
8941
8942 static struct type *
8943 to_static_fixed_type (struct type *type0)
8944 {
8945 struct type *type;
8946
8947 if (type0 == NULL)
8948 return NULL;
8949
8950 if (TYPE_FIXED_INSTANCE (type0))
8951 return type0;
8952
8953 type0 = ada_check_typedef (type0);
8954
8955 switch (TYPE_CODE (type0))
8956 {
8957 default:
8958 return type0;
8959 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
8960 type = dynamic_template_type (type0);
8961 if (type != NULL)
8962 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8963 else
8964 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8965 case TYPE_CODE_UNION:
8966 type = ada_find_parallel_type (type0, "___XVU");
8967 if (type != NULL)
8968 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type);
8969 else
8970 return template_to_static_fixed_type (type0);
8971 }
8972 }
8973
8974 /* A static approximation of TYPE with all type wrappers removed. */
8975
8976 static struct type *
8977 static_unwrap_type (struct type *type)
8978 {
8979 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
8980 {
8981 struct type *type1 = TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (ada_check_typedef (type), 0);
8982 if (ada_type_name (type1) == NULL)
8983 TYPE_NAME (type1) = ada_type_name (type);
8984
8985 return static_unwrap_type (type1);
8986 }
8987 else
8988 {
8989 struct type *raw_real_type = ada_get_base_type (type);
8990
8991 if (raw_real_type == type)
8992 return type;
8993 else
8994 return to_static_fixed_type (raw_real_type);
8995 }
8996 }
8997
8998 /* In some cases, incomplete and private types require
8999 cross-references that are not resolved as records (for example,
9000 type Foo;
9001 type FooP is access Foo;
9002 V: FooP;
9003 type Foo is array ...;
9004 ). In these cases, since there is no mechanism for producing
9005 cross-references to such types, we instead substitute for FooP a
9006 stub enumeration type that is nowhere resolved, and whose tag is
9007 the name of the actual type. Call these types "non-record stubs". */
9008
9009 /* A type equivalent to TYPE that is not a non-record stub, if one
9010 exists, otherwise TYPE. */
9011
9012 struct type *
9013 ada_check_typedef (struct type *type)
9014 {
9015 if (type == NULL)
9016 return NULL;
9017
9018 /* If our type is an access to an unconstrained array, which is encoded
9019 as a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF of a fat pointer, then we're done.
9020 We don't want to strip the TYPE_CODE_TYPDEF layer, because this is
9021 what allows us to distinguish between fat pointers that represent
9022 array types, and fat pointers that represent array access types
9023 (in both cases, the compiler implements them as fat pointers). */
9024 if (ada_is_access_to_unconstrained_array (type))
9025 return type;
9026
9027 type = check_typedef (type);
9028 if (type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM
9029 || !TYPE_STUB (type)
9030 || TYPE_NAME (type) == NULL)
9031 return type;
9032 else
9033 {
9034 const char *name = TYPE_NAME (type);
9035 struct type *type1 = ada_find_any_type (name);
9036
9037 if (type1 == NULL)
9038 return type;
9039
9040 /* TYPE1 might itself be a TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF (this can happen with
9041 stubs pointing to arrays, as we don't create symbols for array
9042 types, only for the typedef-to-array types). If that's the case,
9043 strip the typedef layer. */
9044 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
9045 type1 = ada_check_typedef (type1);
9046
9047 return type1;
9048 }
9049 }
9050
9051 /* A value representing the data at VALADDR/ADDRESS as described by
9052 type TYPE0, but with a standard (static-sized) type that correctly
9053 describes it. If VAL0 is not NULL and TYPE0 already is a standard
9054 type, then return VAL0 [this feature is simply to avoid redundant
9055 creation of struct values]. */
9056
9057 static struct value *
9058 ada_to_fixed_value_create (struct type *type0, CORE_ADDR address,
9059 struct value *val0)
9060 {
9061 struct type *type = ada_to_fixed_type (type0, 0, address, NULL, 1);
9062
9063 if (type == type0 && val0 != NULL)
9064 return val0;
9065
9066 if (VALUE_LVAL (val0) != lval_memory)
9067 {
9068 /* Our value does not live in memory; it could be a convenience
9069 variable, for instance. Create a not_lval value using val0's
9070 contents. */
9071 return value_from_contents (type, value_contents (val0));
9072 }
9073
9074 return value_from_contents_and_address (type, 0, address);
9075 }
9076
9077 /* A value representing VAL, but with a standard (static-sized) type
9078 that correctly describes it. Does not necessarily create a new
9079 value. */
9080
9081 struct value *
9082 ada_to_fixed_value (struct value *val)
9083 {
9084 val = unwrap_value (val);
9085 val = ada_to_fixed_value_create (value_type (val), value_address (val), val);
9086 return val;
9087 }
9088 \f
9089
9090 /* Attributes */
9091
9092 /* Table mapping attribute numbers to names.
9093 NOTE: Keep up to date with enum ada_attribute definition in ada-lang.h. */
9094
9095 static const char *attribute_names[] = {
9096 "<?>",
9097
9098 "first",
9099 "last",
9100 "length",
9101 "image",
9102 "max",
9103 "min",
9104 "modulus",
9105 "pos",
9106 "size",
9107 "tag",
9108 "val",
9109 0
9110 };
9111
9112 static const char *
9113 ada_attribute_name (enum exp_opcode n)
9114 {
9115 if (n >= OP_ATR_FIRST && n <= (int) OP_ATR_VAL)
9116 return attribute_names[n - OP_ATR_FIRST + 1];
9117 else
9118 return attribute_names[0];
9119 }
9120
9121 /* Evaluate the 'POS attribute applied to ARG. */
9122
9123 static LONGEST
9124 pos_atr (struct value *arg)
9125 {
9126 struct value *val = coerce_ref (arg);
9127 struct type *type = value_type (val);
9128 LONGEST result;
9129
9130 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9131 error (_("'POS only defined on discrete types"));
9132
9133 if (!discrete_position (type, value_as_long (val), &result))
9134 error (_("enumeration value is invalid: can't find 'POS"));
9135
9136 return result;
9137 }
9138
9139 static struct value *
9140 value_pos_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9141 {
9142 return value_from_longest (type, pos_atr (arg));
9143 }
9144
9145 /* Evaluate the TYPE'VAL attribute applied to ARG. */
9146
9147 static struct value *
9148 value_val_atr (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9149 {
9150 if (!discrete_type_p (type))
9151 error (_("'VAL only defined on discrete types"));
9152 if (!integer_type_p (value_type (arg)))
9153 error (_("'VAL requires integral argument"));
9154
9155 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
9156 {
9157 long pos = value_as_long (arg);
9158
9159 if (pos < 0 || pos >= TYPE_NFIELDS (type))
9160 error (_("argument to 'VAL out of range"));
9161 return value_from_longest (type, TYPE_FIELD_ENUMVAL (type, pos));
9162 }
9163 else
9164 return value_from_longest (type, value_as_long (arg));
9165 }
9166 \f
9167
9168 /* Evaluation */
9169
9170 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada character type.
9171 [At the moment, this is true only for Character and Wide_Character;
9172 It is a heuristic test that could stand improvement]. */
9173
9174 bool
9175 ada_is_character_type (struct type *type)
9176 {
9177 const char *name;
9178
9179 /* If the type code says it's a character, then assume it really is,
9180 and don't check any further. */
9181 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_CHAR)
9182 return true;
9183
9184 /* Otherwise, assume it's a character type iff it is a discrete type
9185 with a known character type name. */
9186 name = ada_type_name (type);
9187 return (name != NULL
9188 && (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
9189 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
9190 && (strcmp (name, "character") == 0
9191 || strcmp (name, "wide_character") == 0
9192 || strcmp (name, "wide_wide_character") == 0
9193 || strcmp (name, "unsigned char") == 0));
9194 }
9195
9196 /* True if TYPE appears to be an Ada string type. */
9197
9198 bool
9199 ada_is_string_type (struct type *type)
9200 {
9201 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9202 if (type != NULL
9203 && TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_PTR
9204 && (ada_is_simple_array_type (type)
9205 || ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
9206 && ada_array_arity (type) == 1)
9207 {
9208 struct type *elttype = ada_array_element_type (type, 1);
9209
9210 return ada_is_character_type (elttype);
9211 }
9212 else
9213 return false;
9214 }
9215
9216 /* The compiler sometimes provides a parallel XVS type for a given
9217 PAD type. Normally, it is safe to follow the PAD type directly,
9218 but older versions of the compiler have a bug that causes the offset
9219 of its "F" field to be wrong. Following that field in that case
9220 would lead to incorrect results, but this can be worked around
9221 by ignoring the PAD type and using the associated XVS type instead.
9222
9223 Set to True if the debugger should trust the contents of PAD types.
9224 Otherwise, ignore the PAD type if there is a parallel XVS type. */
9225 static bool trust_pad_over_xvs = true;
9226
9227 /* True if TYPE is a struct type introduced by the compiler to force the
9228 alignment of a value. Such types have a single field with a
9229 distinctive name. */
9230
9231 int
9232 ada_is_aligner_type (struct type *type)
9233 {
9234 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9235
9236 if (!trust_pad_over_xvs && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVS") != NULL)
9237 return 0;
9238
9239 return (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9240 && TYPE_NFIELDS (type) == 1
9241 && strcmp (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (type, 0), "F") == 0);
9242 }
9243
9244 /* If there is an ___XVS-convention type parallel to SUBTYPE, return
9245 the parallel type. */
9246
9247 struct type *
9248 ada_get_base_type (struct type *raw_type)
9249 {
9250 struct type *real_type_namer;
9251 struct type *raw_real_type;
9252
9253 if (raw_type == NULL || TYPE_CODE (raw_type) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9254 return raw_type;
9255
9256 if (ada_is_aligner_type (raw_type))
9257 /* The encoding specifies that we should always use the aligner type.
9258 So, even if this aligner type has an associated XVS type, we should
9259 simply ignore it.
9260
9261 According to the compiler gurus, an XVS type parallel to an aligner
9262 type may exist because of a stabs limitation. In stabs, aligner
9263 types are empty because the field has a variable-sized type, and
9264 thus cannot actually be used as an aligner type. As a result,
9265 we need the associated parallel XVS type to decode the type.
9266 Since the policy in the compiler is to not change the internal
9267 representation based on the debugging info format, we sometimes
9268 end up having a redundant XVS type parallel to the aligner type. */
9269 return raw_type;
9270
9271 real_type_namer = ada_find_parallel_type (raw_type, "___XVS");
9272 if (real_type_namer == NULL
9273 || TYPE_CODE (real_type_namer) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
9274 || TYPE_NFIELDS (real_type_namer) != 1)
9275 return raw_type;
9276
9277 if (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0)) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
9278 {
9279 /* This is an older encoding form where the base type needs to be
9280 looked up by name. We prefer the newer encoding because it is
9281 more efficient. */
9282 raw_real_type = ada_find_any_type (TYPE_FIELD_NAME (real_type_namer, 0));
9283 if (raw_real_type == NULL)
9284 return raw_type;
9285 else
9286 return raw_real_type;
9287 }
9288
9289 /* The field in our XVS type is a reference to the base type. */
9290 return TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (real_type_namer, 0));
9291 }
9292
9293 /* The type of value designated by TYPE, with all aligners removed. */
9294
9295 struct type *
9296 ada_aligned_type (struct type *type)
9297 {
9298 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9299 return ada_aligned_type (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0));
9300 else
9301 return ada_get_base_type (type);
9302 }
9303
9304
9305 /* The address of the aligned value in an object at address VALADDR
9306 having type TYPE. Assumes ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE). */
9307
9308 const gdb_byte *
9309 ada_aligned_value_addr (struct type *type, const gdb_byte *valaddr)
9310 {
9311 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9312 return ada_aligned_value_addr (TYPE_FIELD_TYPE (type, 0),
9313 valaddr +
9314 TYPE_FIELD_BITPOS (type,
9315 0) / TARGET_CHAR_BIT);
9316 else
9317 return valaddr;
9318 }
9319
9320
9321
9322 /* The printed representation of an enumeration literal with encoded
9323 name NAME. The value is good to the next call of ada_enum_name. */
9324 const char *
9325 ada_enum_name (const char *name)
9326 {
9327 static char *result;
9328 static size_t result_len = 0;
9329 const char *tmp;
9330
9331 /* First, unqualify the enumeration name:
9332 1. Search for the last '.' character. If we find one, then skip
9333 all the preceding characters, the unqualified name starts
9334 right after that dot.
9335 2. Otherwise, we may be debugging on a target where the compiler
9336 translates dots into "__". Search forward for double underscores,
9337 but stop searching when we hit an overloading suffix, which is
9338 of the form "__" followed by digits. */
9339
9340 tmp = strrchr (name, '.');
9341 if (tmp != NULL)
9342 name = tmp + 1;
9343 else
9344 {
9345 while ((tmp = strstr (name, "__")) != NULL)
9346 {
9347 if (isdigit (tmp[2]))
9348 break;
9349 else
9350 name = tmp + 2;
9351 }
9352 }
9353
9354 if (name[0] == 'Q')
9355 {
9356 int v;
9357
9358 if (name[1] == 'U' || name[1] == 'W')
9359 {
9360 if (sscanf (name + 2, "%x", &v) != 1)
9361 return name;
9362 }
9363 else if (((name[1] >= '0' && name[1] <= '9')
9364 || (name[1] >= 'a' && name[1] <= 'z'))
9365 && name[2] == '\0')
9366 {
9367 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 4);
9368 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", name[1]);
9369 return result;
9370 }
9371 else
9372 return name;
9373
9374 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, 16);
9375 if (isascii (v) && isprint (v))
9376 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "'%c'", v);
9377 else if (name[1] == 'U')
9378 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%02x\"]", v);
9379 else
9380 xsnprintf (result, result_len, "[\"%04x\"]", v);
9381
9382 return result;
9383 }
9384 else
9385 {
9386 tmp = strstr (name, "__");
9387 if (tmp == NULL)
9388 tmp = strstr (name, "$");
9389 if (tmp != NULL)
9390 {
9391 GROW_VECT (result, result_len, tmp - name + 1);
9392 strncpy (result, name, tmp - name);
9393 result[tmp - name] = '\0';
9394 return result;
9395 }
9396
9397 return name;
9398 }
9399 }
9400
9401 /* Evaluate the subexpression of EXP starting at *POS as for
9402 evaluate_type, updating *POS to point just past the evaluated
9403 expression. */
9404
9405 static struct value *
9406 evaluate_subexp_type (struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9407 {
9408 return evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
9409 }
9410
9411 /* If VAL is wrapped in an aligner or subtype wrapper, return the
9412 value it wraps. */
9413
9414 static struct value *
9415 unwrap_value (struct value *val)
9416 {
9417 struct type *type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (val));
9418
9419 if (ada_is_aligner_type (type))
9420 {
9421 struct value *v = ada_value_struct_elt (val, "F", 0);
9422 struct type *val_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (v));
9423
9424 if (ada_type_name (val_type) == NULL)
9425 TYPE_NAME (val_type) = ada_type_name (type);
9426
9427 return unwrap_value (v);
9428 }
9429 else
9430 {
9431 struct type *raw_real_type =
9432 ada_check_typedef (ada_get_base_type (type));
9433
9434 /* If there is no parallel XVS or XVE type, then the value is
9435 already unwrapped. Return it without further modification. */
9436 if ((type == raw_real_type)
9437 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVE") == NULL)
9438 return val;
9439
9440 return
9441 coerce_unspec_val_to_type
9442 (val, ada_to_fixed_type (raw_real_type, 0,
9443 value_address (val),
9444 NULL, 1));
9445 }
9446 }
9447
9448 static struct value *
9449 cast_from_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9450 {
9451 struct value *scale = ada_scaling_factor (value_type (arg));
9452 arg = value_cast (value_type (scale), arg);
9453
9454 arg = value_binop (arg, scale, BINOP_MUL);
9455 return value_cast (type, arg);
9456 }
9457
9458 static struct value *
9459 cast_to_fixed (struct type *type, struct value *arg)
9460 {
9461 if (type == value_type (arg))
9462 return arg;
9463
9464 struct value *scale = ada_scaling_factor (type);
9465 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg)))
9466 arg = cast_from_fixed (value_type (scale), arg);
9467 else
9468 arg = value_cast (value_type (scale), arg);
9469
9470 arg = value_binop (arg, scale, BINOP_DIV);
9471 return value_cast (type, arg);
9472 }
9473
9474 /* Given two array types T1 and T2, return nonzero iff both arrays
9475 contain the same number of elements. */
9476
9477 static int
9478 ada_same_array_size_p (struct type *t1, struct type *t2)
9479 {
9480 LONGEST lo1, hi1, lo2, hi2;
9481
9482 /* Get the array bounds in order to verify that the size of
9483 the two arrays match. */
9484 if (!get_array_bounds (t1, &lo1, &hi1)
9485 || !get_array_bounds (t2, &lo2, &hi2))
9486 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9487
9488 /* To make things easier for size comparison, normalize a bit
9489 the case of empty arrays by making sure that the difference
9490 between upper bound and lower bound is always -1. */
9491 if (lo1 > hi1)
9492 hi1 = lo1 - 1;
9493 if (lo2 > hi2)
9494 hi2 = lo2 - 1;
9495
9496 return (hi1 - lo1 == hi2 - lo2);
9497 }
9498
9499 /* Assuming that VAL is an array of integrals, and TYPE represents
9500 an array with the same number of elements, but with wider integral
9501 elements, return an array "casted" to TYPE. In practice, this
9502 means that the returned array is built by casting each element
9503 of the original array into TYPE's (wider) element type. */
9504
9505 static struct value *
9506 ada_promote_array_of_integrals (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9507 {
9508 struct type *elt_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
9509 LONGEST lo, hi;
9510 struct value *res;
9511 LONGEST i;
9512
9513 /* Verify that both val and type are arrays of scalars, and
9514 that the size of val's elements is smaller than the size
9515 of type's element. */
9516 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9517 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)));
9518 gdb_assert (TYPE_CODE (value_type (val)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY);
9519 gdb_assert (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9520 gdb_assert (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9521 > TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (val))));
9522
9523 if (!get_array_bounds (type, &lo, &hi))
9524 error (_("unable to determine array bounds"));
9525
9526 res = allocate_value (type);
9527
9528 /* Promote each array element. */
9529 for (i = 0; i < hi - lo + 1; i++)
9530 {
9531 struct value *elt = value_cast (elt_type, value_subscript (val, lo + i));
9532
9533 memcpy (value_contents_writeable (res) + (i * TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type)),
9534 value_contents_all (elt), TYPE_LENGTH (elt_type));
9535 }
9536
9537 return res;
9538 }
9539
9540 /* Coerce VAL as necessary for assignment to an lval of type TYPE, and
9541 return the converted value. */
9542
9543 static struct value *
9544 coerce_for_assign (struct type *type, struct value *val)
9545 {
9546 struct type *type2 = value_type (val);
9547
9548 if (type == type2)
9549 return val;
9550
9551 type2 = ada_check_typedef (type2);
9552 type = ada_check_typedef (type);
9553
9554 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
9555 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9556 {
9557 val = ada_value_ind (val);
9558 type2 = value_type (val);
9559 }
9560
9561 if (TYPE_CODE (type2) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9562 && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9563 {
9564 if (!ada_same_array_size_p (type, type2))
9565 error (_("cannot assign arrays of different length"));
9566
9567 if (is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))
9568 && is_integral_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9569 && TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9570 < TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9571 {
9572 /* Allow implicit promotion of the array elements to
9573 a wider type. */
9574 return ada_promote_array_of_integrals (type, val);
9575 }
9576
9577 if (TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type2))
9578 != TYPE_LENGTH (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type)))
9579 error (_("Incompatible types in assignment"));
9580 deprecated_set_value_type (val, type);
9581 }
9582 return val;
9583 }
9584
9585 static struct value *
9586 ada_value_binop (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2, enum exp_opcode op)
9587 {
9588 struct value *val;
9589 struct type *type1, *type2;
9590 LONGEST v, v1, v2;
9591
9592 arg1 = coerce_ref (arg1);
9593 arg2 = coerce_ref (arg2);
9594 type1 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1)));
9595 type2 = get_base_type (ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)));
9596
9597 if (TYPE_CODE (type1) != TYPE_CODE_INT
9598 || TYPE_CODE (type2) != TYPE_CODE_INT)
9599 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9600
9601 switch (op)
9602 {
9603 case BINOP_MOD:
9604 case BINOP_DIV:
9605 case BINOP_REM:
9606 break;
9607 default:
9608 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9609 }
9610
9611 v2 = value_as_long (arg2);
9612 if (v2 == 0)
9613 error (_("second operand of %s must not be zero."), op_string (op));
9614
9615 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type1) || op == BINOP_MOD)
9616 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
9617
9618 v1 = value_as_long (arg1);
9619 switch (op)
9620 {
9621 case BINOP_DIV:
9622 v = v1 / v2;
9623 if (!TRUNCATION_TOWARDS_ZERO && v1 * (v1 % v2) < 0)
9624 v += v > 0 ? -1 : 1;
9625 break;
9626 case BINOP_REM:
9627 v = v1 % v2;
9628 if (v * v1 < 0)
9629 v -= v2;
9630 break;
9631 default:
9632 /* Should not reach this point. */
9633 v = 0;
9634 }
9635
9636 val = allocate_value (type1);
9637 store_unsigned_integer (value_contents_raw (val),
9638 TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (val)),
9639 type_byte_order (type1), v);
9640 return val;
9641 }
9642
9643 static int
9644 ada_value_equal (struct value *arg1, struct value *arg2)
9645 {
9646 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg1))
9647 || ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (arg2)))
9648 {
9649 struct type *arg1_type, *arg2_type;
9650
9651 /* Automatically dereference any array reference before
9652 we attempt to perform the comparison. */
9653 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
9654 arg2 = ada_coerce_ref (arg2);
9655
9656 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
9657 arg2 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg2);
9658
9659 arg1_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
9660 arg2_type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2));
9661
9662 if (TYPE_CODE (arg1_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
9663 || TYPE_CODE (arg2_type) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9664 error (_("Attempt to compare array with non-array"));
9665 /* FIXME: The following works only for types whose
9666 representations use all bits (no padding or undefined bits)
9667 and do not have user-defined equality. */
9668 return (TYPE_LENGTH (arg1_type) == TYPE_LENGTH (arg2_type)
9669 && memcmp (value_contents (arg1), value_contents (arg2),
9670 TYPE_LENGTH (arg1_type)) == 0);
9671 }
9672 return value_equal (arg1, arg2);
9673 }
9674
9675 /* Total number of component associations in the aggregate starting at
9676 index PC in EXP. Assumes that index PC is the start of an
9677 OP_AGGREGATE. */
9678
9679 static int
9680 num_component_specs (struct expression *exp, int pc)
9681 {
9682 int n, m, i;
9683
9684 m = exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9685 pc += 3;
9686 n = 0;
9687 for (i = 0; i < m; i += 1)
9688 {
9689 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
9690 {
9691 default:
9692 n += 1;
9693 break;
9694 case OP_CHOICES:
9695 n += exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst;
9696 break;
9697 }
9698 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &pc, EVAL_SKIP);
9699 }
9700 return n;
9701 }
9702
9703 /* Assign the result of evaluating EXP starting at *POS to the INDEXth
9704 component of LHS (a simple array or a record), updating *POS past
9705 the expression, assuming that LHS is contained in CONTAINER. Does
9706 not modify the inferior's memory, nor does it modify LHS (unless
9707 LHS == CONTAINER). */
9708
9709 static void
9710 assign_component (struct value *container, struct value *lhs, LONGEST index,
9711 struct expression *exp, int *pos)
9712 {
9713 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
9714 struct value *elt;
9715 struct type *lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9716
9717 if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
9718 {
9719 struct type *index_type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
9720 struct value *index_val = value_from_longest (index_type, index);
9721
9722 elt = unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript (lhs, 1, &index_val));
9723 }
9724 else
9725 {
9726 elt = ada_index_struct_field (index, lhs, 0, value_type (lhs));
9727 elt = ada_to_fixed_value (elt);
9728 }
9729
9730 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
9731 assign_aggregate (container, elt, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
9732 else
9733 value_assign_to_component (container, elt,
9734 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9735 EVAL_NORMAL));
9736
9737 value_free_to_mark (mark);
9738 }
9739
9740 /* Assuming that LHS represents an lvalue having a record or array
9741 type, and EXP->ELTS[*POS] is an OP_AGGREGATE, evaluate an assignment
9742 of that aggregate's value to LHS, advancing *POS past the
9743 aggregate. NOSIDE is as for evaluate_subexp. CONTAINER is an
9744 lvalue containing LHS (possibly LHS itself). Does not modify
9745 the inferior's memory, nor does it modify the contents of
9746 LHS (unless == CONTAINER). Returns the modified CONTAINER. */
9747
9748 static struct value *
9749 assign_aggregate (struct value *container,
9750 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9751 int *pos, enum noside noside)
9752 {
9753 struct type *lhs_type;
9754 int n = exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst;
9755 LONGEST low_index, high_index;
9756 int num_specs;
9757 LONGEST *indices;
9758 int max_indices, num_indices;
9759 int i;
9760
9761 *pos += 3;
9762 if (noside != EVAL_NORMAL)
9763 {
9764 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9765 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
9766 return container;
9767 }
9768
9769 container = ada_coerce_ref (container);
9770 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (container)))
9771 container = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (container);
9772 lhs = ada_coerce_ref (lhs);
9773 if (!deprecated_value_modifiable (lhs))
9774 error (_("Left operand of assignment is not a modifiable lvalue."));
9775
9776 lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9777 if (ada_is_direct_array_type (lhs_type))
9778 {
9779 lhs = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (lhs);
9780 lhs_type = check_typedef (value_type (lhs));
9781 low_index = TYPE_ARRAY_LOWER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9782 high_index = TYPE_ARRAY_UPPER_BOUND_VALUE (lhs_type);
9783 }
9784 else if (TYPE_CODE (lhs_type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT)
9785 {
9786 low_index = 0;
9787 high_index = num_visible_fields (lhs_type) - 1;
9788 }
9789 else
9790 error (_("Left-hand side must be array or record."));
9791
9792 num_specs = num_component_specs (exp, *pos - 3);
9793 max_indices = 4 * num_specs + 4;
9794 indices = XALLOCAVEC (LONGEST, max_indices);
9795 indices[0] = indices[1] = low_index - 1;
9796 indices[2] = indices[3] = high_index + 1;
9797 num_indices = 4;
9798
9799 for (i = 0; i < n; i += 1)
9800 {
9801 switch (exp->elts[*pos].opcode)
9802 {
9803 case OP_CHOICES:
9804 aggregate_assign_from_choices (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9805 &num_indices, max_indices,
9806 low_index, high_index);
9807 break;
9808 case OP_POSITIONAL:
9809 aggregate_assign_positional (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9810 &num_indices, max_indices,
9811 low_index, high_index);
9812 break;
9813 case OP_OTHERS:
9814 if (i != n-1)
9815 error (_("Misplaced 'others' clause"));
9816 aggregate_assign_others (container, lhs, exp, pos, indices,
9817 num_indices, low_index, high_index);
9818 break;
9819 default:
9820 error (_("Internal error: bad aggregate clause"));
9821 }
9822 }
9823
9824 return container;
9825 }
9826
9827 /* Assign into the component of LHS indexed by the OP_POSITIONAL
9828 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9829 the positions are relative to lower bound LOW, where HIGH is the
9830 upper bound. Record the position in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1]
9831 updating *NUM_INDICES as needed. CONTAINER is as for
9832 assign_aggregate. */
9833 static void
9834 aggregate_assign_positional (struct value *container,
9835 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9836 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9837 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9838 {
9839 LONGEST ind = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 1].longconst) + low;
9840
9841 if (ind - 1 == high)
9842 warning (_("Extra components in aggregate ignored."));
9843 if (ind <= high)
9844 {
9845 add_component_interval (ind, ind, indices, num_indices, max_indices);
9846 *pos += 3;
9847 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, pos);
9848 }
9849 else
9850 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9851 }
9852
9853 /* Assign into the components of LHS indexed by the OP_CHOICES
9854 construct at *POS, updating *POS past the construct, given that
9855 the allowable indices are LOW..HIGH. Record the indices assigned
9856 to in INDICES[0 .. MAX_INDICES-1], updating *NUM_INDICES as
9857 needed. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9858 static void
9859 aggregate_assign_from_choices (struct value *container,
9860 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9861 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int *num_indices,
9862 int max_indices, LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9863 {
9864 int j;
9865 int n_choices = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos+1].longconst);
9866 int choice_pos, expr_pc;
9867 int is_array = ada_is_direct_array_type (value_type (lhs));
9868
9869 choice_pos = *pos += 3;
9870
9871 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9872 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9873 expr_pc = *pos;
9874 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9875
9876 for (j = 0; j < n_choices; j += 1)
9877 {
9878 LONGEST lower, upper;
9879 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[choice_pos].opcode;
9880
9881 if (op == OP_DISCRETE_RANGE)
9882 {
9883 choice_pos += 1;
9884 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9885 EVAL_NORMAL));
9886 upper = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos,
9887 EVAL_NORMAL));
9888 }
9889 else if (is_array)
9890 {
9891 lower = value_as_long (ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos,
9892 EVAL_NORMAL));
9893 upper = lower;
9894 }
9895 else
9896 {
9897 int ind;
9898 const char *name;
9899
9900 switch (op)
9901 {
9902 case OP_NAME:
9903 name = &exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].string;
9904 break;
9905 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
9906 name = exp->elts[choice_pos + 2].symbol->natural_name ();
9907 break;
9908 default:
9909 error (_("Invalid record component association."));
9910 }
9911 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, &choice_pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9912 ind = 0;
9913 if (! find_struct_field (name, value_type (lhs), 0,
9914 NULL, NULL, NULL, NULL, &ind))
9915 error (_("Unknown component name: %s."), name);
9916 lower = upper = ind;
9917 }
9918
9919 if (lower <= upper && (lower < low || upper > high))
9920 error (_("Index in component association out of bounds."));
9921
9922 add_component_interval (lower, upper, indices, num_indices,
9923 max_indices);
9924 while (lower <= upper)
9925 {
9926 int pos1;
9927
9928 pos1 = expr_pc;
9929 assign_component (container, lhs, lower, exp, &pos1);
9930 lower += 1;
9931 }
9932 }
9933 }
9934
9935 /* Assign the value of the expression in the OP_OTHERS construct in
9936 EXP at *POS into the components of LHS indexed from LOW .. HIGH that
9937 have not been previously assigned. The index intervals already assigned
9938 are in INDICES[0 .. NUM_INDICES-1]. Updates *POS to after the
9939 OP_OTHERS clause. CONTAINER is as for assign_aggregate. */
9940 static void
9941 aggregate_assign_others (struct value *container,
9942 struct value *lhs, struct expression *exp,
9943 int *pos, LONGEST *indices, int num_indices,
9944 LONGEST low, LONGEST high)
9945 {
9946 int i;
9947 int expr_pc = *pos + 1;
9948
9949 for (i = 0; i < num_indices - 2; i += 2)
9950 {
9951 LONGEST ind;
9952
9953 for (ind = indices[i + 1] + 1; ind < indices[i + 2]; ind += 1)
9954 {
9955 int localpos;
9956
9957 localpos = expr_pc;
9958 assign_component (container, lhs, ind, exp, &localpos);
9959 }
9960 }
9961 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
9962 }
9963
9964 /* Add the interval [LOW .. HIGH] to the sorted set of intervals
9965 [ INDICES[0] .. INDICES[1] ],..., [ INDICES[*SIZE-2] .. INDICES[*SIZE-1] ],
9966 modifying *SIZE as needed. It is an error if *SIZE exceeds
9967 MAX_SIZE. The resulting intervals do not overlap. */
9968 static void
9969 add_component_interval (LONGEST low, LONGEST high,
9970 LONGEST* indices, int *size, int max_size)
9971 {
9972 int i, j;
9973
9974 for (i = 0; i < *size; i += 2) {
9975 if (high >= indices[i] && low <= indices[i + 1])
9976 {
9977 int kh;
9978
9979 for (kh = i + 2; kh < *size; kh += 2)
9980 if (high < indices[kh])
9981 break;
9982 if (low < indices[i])
9983 indices[i] = low;
9984 indices[i + 1] = indices[kh - 1];
9985 if (high > indices[i + 1])
9986 indices[i + 1] = high;
9987 memcpy (indices + i + 2, indices + kh, *size - kh);
9988 *size -= kh - i - 2;
9989 return;
9990 }
9991 else if (high < indices[i])
9992 break;
9993 }
9994
9995 if (*size == max_size)
9996 error (_("Internal error: miscounted aggregate components."));
9997 *size += 2;
9998 for (j = *size-1; j >= i+2; j -= 1)
9999 indices[j] = indices[j - 2];
10000 indices[i] = low;
10001 indices[i + 1] = high;
10002 }
10003
10004 /* Perform and Ada cast of ARG2 to type TYPE if the type of ARG2
10005 is different. */
10006
10007 static struct value *
10008 ada_value_cast (struct type *type, struct value *arg2)
10009 {
10010 if (type == ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg2)))
10011 return arg2;
10012
10013 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (type))
10014 return cast_to_fixed (type, arg2);
10015
10016 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10017 return cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
10018
10019 return value_cast (type, arg2);
10020 }
10021
10022 /* Evaluating Ada expressions, and printing their result.
10023 ------------------------------------------------------
10024
10025 1. Introduction:
10026 ----------------
10027
10028 We usually evaluate an Ada expression in order to print its value.
10029 We also evaluate an expression in order to print its type, which
10030 happens during the EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase of the evaluation,
10031 but we'll focus mostly on the EVAL_NORMAL phase. In practice, the
10032 EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS phase allows us to simplify certain aspects of
10033 the evaluation compared to the EVAL_NORMAL, but is otherwise very
10034 similar.
10035
10036 Evaluating expressions is a little more complicated for Ada entities
10037 than it is for entities in languages such as C. The main reason for
10038 this is that Ada provides types whose definition might be dynamic.
10039 One example of such types is variant records. Or another example
10040 would be an array whose bounds can only be known at run time.
10041
10042 The following description is a general guide as to what should be
10043 done (and what should NOT be done) in order to evaluate an expression
10044 involving such types, and when. This does not cover how the semantic
10045 information is encoded by GNAT as this is covered separatly. For the
10046 document used as the reference for the GNAT encoding, see exp_dbug.ads
10047 in the GNAT sources.
10048
10049 Ideally, we should embed each part of this description next to its
10050 associated code. Unfortunately, the amount of code is so vast right
10051 now that it's hard to see whether the code handling a particular
10052 situation might be duplicated or not. One day, when the code is
10053 cleaned up, this guide might become redundant with the comments
10054 inserted in the code, and we might want to remove it.
10055
10056 2. ``Fixing'' an Entity, the Simple Case:
10057 -----------------------------------------
10058
10059 When evaluating Ada expressions, the tricky issue is that they may
10060 reference entities whose type contents and size are not statically
10061 known. Consider for instance a variant record:
10062
10063 type Rec (Empty : Boolean := True) is record
10064 case Empty is
10065 when True => null;
10066 when False => Value : Integer;
10067 end case;
10068 end record;
10069 Yes : Rec := (Empty => False, Value => 1);
10070 No : Rec := (empty => True);
10071
10072 The size and contents of that record depends on the value of the
10073 descriminant (Rec.Empty). At this point, neither the debugging
10074 information nor the associated type structure in GDB are able to
10075 express such dynamic types. So what the debugger does is to create
10076 "fixed" versions of the type that applies to the specific object.
10077 We also informally refer to this operation as "fixing" an object,
10078 which means creating its associated fixed type.
10079
10080 Example: when printing the value of variable "Yes" above, its fixed
10081 type would look like this:
10082
10083 type Rec is record
10084 Empty : Boolean;
10085 Value : Integer;
10086 end record;
10087
10088 On the other hand, if we printed the value of "No", its fixed type
10089 would become:
10090
10091 type Rec is record
10092 Empty : Boolean;
10093 end record;
10094
10095 Things become a little more complicated when trying to fix an entity
10096 with a dynamic type that directly contains another dynamic type,
10097 such as an array of variant records, for instance. There are
10098 two possible cases: Arrays, and records.
10099
10100 3. ``Fixing'' Arrays:
10101 ---------------------
10102
10103 The type structure in GDB describes an array in terms of its bounds,
10104 and the type of its elements. By design, all elements in the array
10105 have the same type and we cannot represent an array of variant elements
10106 using the current type structure in GDB. When fixing an array,
10107 we cannot fix the array element, as we would potentially need one
10108 fixed type per element of the array. As a result, the best we can do
10109 when fixing an array is to produce an array whose bounds and size
10110 are correct (allowing us to read it from memory), but without having
10111 touched its element type. Fixing each element will be done later,
10112 when (if) necessary.
10113
10114 Arrays are a little simpler to handle than records, because the same
10115 amount of memory is allocated for each element of the array, even if
10116 the amount of space actually used by each element differs from element
10117 to element. Consider for instance the following array of type Rec:
10118
10119 type Rec_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Rec;
10120
10121 The actual amount of memory occupied by each element might be different
10122 from element to element, depending on the value of their discriminant.
10123 But the amount of space reserved for each element in the array remains
10124 fixed regardless. So we simply need to compute that size using
10125 the debugging information available, from which we can then determine
10126 the array size (we multiply the number of elements of the array by
10127 the size of each element).
10128
10129 The simplest case is when we have an array of a constrained element
10130 type. For instance, consider the following type declarations:
10131
10132 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Integer) is
10133 Length : Integer;
10134 Buffer : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10135 end record;
10136 type Bounded_String_Array is array (1 ..2) of Bounded_String (80);
10137
10138 In this case, the compiler describes the array as an array of
10139 variable-size elements (identified by its XVS suffix) for which
10140 the size can be read in the parallel XVZ variable.
10141
10142 In the case of an array of an unconstrained element type, the compiler
10143 wraps the array element inside a private PAD type. This type should not
10144 be shown to the user, and must be "unwrap"'ed before printing. Note
10145 that we also use the adjective "aligner" in our code to designate
10146 these wrapper types.
10147
10148 In some cases, the size allocated for each element is statically
10149 known. In that case, the PAD type already has the correct size,
10150 and the array element should remain unfixed.
10151
10152 But there are cases when this size is not statically known.
10153 For instance, assuming that "Five" is an integer variable:
10154
10155 type Dynamic is array (1 .. Five) of Integer;
10156 type Wrapper (Has_Length : Boolean := False) is record
10157 Data : Dynamic;
10158 case Has_Length is
10159 when True => Length : Integer;
10160 when False => null;
10161 end case;
10162 end record;
10163 type Wrapper_Array is array (1 .. 2) of Wrapper;
10164
10165 Hello : Wrapper_Array := (others => (Has_Length => True,
10166 Data => (others => 17),
10167 Length => 1));
10168
10169
10170 The debugging info would describe variable Hello as being an
10171 array of a PAD type. The size of that PAD type is not statically
10172 known, but can be determined using a parallel XVZ variable.
10173 In that case, a copy of the PAD type with the correct size should
10174 be used for the fixed array.
10175
10176 3. ``Fixing'' record type objects:
10177 ----------------------------------
10178
10179 Things are slightly different from arrays in the case of dynamic
10180 record types. In this case, in order to compute the associated
10181 fixed type, we need to determine the size and offset of each of
10182 its components. This, in turn, requires us to compute the fixed
10183 type of each of these components.
10184
10185 Consider for instance the example:
10186
10187 type Bounded_String (Max_Size : Natural) is record
10188 Str : String (1 .. Max_Size);
10189 Length : Natural;
10190 end record;
10191 My_String : Bounded_String (Max_Size => 10);
10192
10193 In that case, the position of field "Length" depends on the size
10194 of field Str, which itself depends on the value of the Max_Size
10195 discriminant. In order to fix the type of variable My_String,
10196 we need to fix the type of field Str. Therefore, fixing a variant
10197 record requires us to fix each of its components.
10198
10199 However, if a component does not have a dynamic size, the component
10200 should not be fixed. In particular, fields that use a PAD type
10201 should not fixed. Here is an example where this might happen
10202 (assuming type Rec above):
10203
10204 type Container (Big : Boolean) is record
10205 First : Rec;
10206 After : Integer;
10207 case Big is
10208 when True => Another : Integer;
10209 when False => null;
10210 end case;
10211 end record;
10212 My_Container : Container := (Big => False,
10213 First => (Empty => True),
10214 After => 42);
10215
10216 In that example, the compiler creates a PAD type for component First,
10217 whose size is constant, and then positions the component After just
10218 right after it. The offset of component After is therefore constant
10219 in this case.
10220
10221 The debugger computes the position of each field based on an algorithm
10222 that uses, among other things, the actual position and size of the field
10223 preceding it. Let's now imagine that the user is trying to print
10224 the value of My_Container. If the type fixing was recursive, we would
10225 end up computing the offset of field After based on the size of the
10226 fixed version of field First. And since in our example First has
10227 only one actual field, the size of the fixed type is actually smaller
10228 than the amount of space allocated to that field, and thus we would
10229 compute the wrong offset of field After.
10230
10231 To make things more complicated, we need to watch out for dynamic
10232 components of variant records (identified by the ___XVL suffix in
10233 the component name). Even if the target type is a PAD type, the size
10234 of that type might not be statically known. So the PAD type needs
10235 to be unwrapped and the resulting type needs to be fixed. Otherwise,
10236 we might end up with the wrong size for our component. This can be
10237 observed with the following type declarations:
10238
10239 type Octal is new Integer range 0 .. 7;
10240 type Octal_Array is array (Positive range <>) of Octal;
10241 pragma Pack (Octal_Array);
10242
10243 type Octal_Buffer (Size : Positive) is record
10244 Buffer : Octal_Array (1 .. Size);
10245 Length : Integer;
10246 end record;
10247
10248 In that case, Buffer is a PAD type whose size is unset and needs
10249 to be computed by fixing the unwrapped type.
10250
10251 4. When to ``Fix'' un-``Fixed'' sub-elements of an entity:
10252 ----------------------------------------------------------
10253
10254 Lastly, when should the sub-elements of an entity that remained unfixed
10255 thus far, be actually fixed?
10256
10257 The answer is: Only when referencing that element. For instance
10258 when selecting one component of a record, this specific component
10259 should be fixed at that point in time. Or when printing the value
10260 of a record, each component should be fixed before its value gets
10261 printed. Similarly for arrays, the element of the array should be
10262 fixed when printing each element of the array, or when extracting
10263 one element out of that array. On the other hand, fixing should
10264 not be performed on the elements when taking a slice of an array!
10265
10266 Note that one of the side effects of miscomputing the offset and
10267 size of each field is that we end up also miscomputing the size
10268 of the containing type. This can have adverse results when computing
10269 the value of an entity. GDB fetches the value of an entity based
10270 on the size of its type, and thus a wrong size causes GDB to fetch
10271 the wrong amount of memory. In the case where the computed size is
10272 too small, GDB fetches too little data to print the value of our
10273 entity. Results in this case are unpredictable, as we usually read
10274 past the buffer containing the data =:-o. */
10275
10276 /* Evaluate a subexpression of EXP, at index *POS, and return a value
10277 for that subexpression cast to TO_TYPE. Advance *POS over the
10278 subexpression. */
10279
10280 static value *
10281 ada_evaluate_subexp_for_cast (expression *exp, int *pos,
10282 enum noside noside, struct type *to_type)
10283 {
10284 int pc = *pos;
10285
10286 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE
10287 || exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE)
10288 {
10289 (*pos) += 4;
10290
10291 value *val;
10292 if (exp->elts[pc].opcode == OP_VAR_MSYM_VALUE)
10293 {
10294 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10295 return value_zero (to_type, not_lval);
10296
10297 val = evaluate_var_msym_value (noside,
10298 exp->elts[pc + 1].objfile,
10299 exp->elts[pc + 2].msymbol);
10300 }
10301 else
10302 val = evaluate_var_value (noside,
10303 exp->elts[pc + 1].block,
10304 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol);
10305
10306 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10307 return eval_skip_value (exp);
10308
10309 val = ada_value_cast (to_type, val);
10310
10311 /* Follow the Ada language semantics that do not allow taking
10312 an address of the result of a cast (view conversion in Ada). */
10313 if (VALUE_LVAL (val) == lval_memory)
10314 {
10315 if (value_lazy (val))
10316 value_fetch_lazy (val);
10317 VALUE_LVAL (val) = not_lval;
10318 }
10319 return val;
10320 }
10321
10322 value *val = evaluate_subexp (to_type, exp, pos, noside);
10323 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10324 return eval_skip_value (exp);
10325 return ada_value_cast (to_type, val);
10326 }
10327
10328 /* Implement the evaluate_exp routine in the exp_descriptor structure
10329 for the Ada language. */
10330
10331 static struct value *
10332 ada_evaluate_subexp (struct type *expect_type, struct expression *exp,
10333 int *pos, enum noside noside)
10334 {
10335 enum exp_opcode op;
10336 int tem;
10337 int pc;
10338 int preeval_pos;
10339 struct value *arg1 = NULL, *arg2 = NULL, *arg3;
10340 struct type *type;
10341 int nargs, oplen;
10342 struct value **argvec;
10343
10344 pc = *pos;
10345 *pos += 1;
10346 op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
10347
10348 switch (op)
10349 {
10350 default:
10351 *pos -= 1;
10352 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10353
10354 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
10355 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
10356
10357 /* If evaluating an OP_FLOAT and an EXPECT_TYPE was provided,
10358 then we need to perform the conversion manually, because
10359 evaluate_subexp_standard doesn't do it. This conversion is
10360 necessary in Ada because the different kinds of float/fixed
10361 types in Ada have different representations.
10362
10363 Similarly, we need to perform the conversion from OP_LONG
10364 ourselves. */
10365 if ((op == OP_FLOAT || op == OP_LONG) && expect_type != NULL)
10366 arg1 = ada_value_cast (expect_type, arg1);
10367
10368 return arg1;
10369
10370 case OP_STRING:
10371 {
10372 struct value *result;
10373
10374 *pos -= 1;
10375 result = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10376 /* The result type will have code OP_STRING, bashed there from
10377 OP_ARRAY. Bash it back. */
10378 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) == TYPE_CODE_STRING)
10379 TYPE_CODE (value_type (result)) = TYPE_CODE_ARRAY;
10380 return result;
10381 }
10382
10383 case UNOP_CAST:
10384 (*pos) += 2;
10385 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10386 return ada_evaluate_subexp_for_cast (exp, pos, noside, type);
10387
10388 case UNOP_QUAL:
10389 (*pos) += 2;
10390 type = exp->elts[pc + 1].type;
10391 return ada_evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10392
10393 case BINOP_ASSIGN:
10394 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10395 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_AGGREGATE)
10396 {
10397 arg1 = assign_aggregate (arg1, arg1, exp, pos, noside);
10398 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10399 return arg1;
10400 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg1);
10401 }
10402 /* Force the evaluation of the rhs ARG2 to the type of the lhs ARG1,
10403 except if the lhs of our assignment is a convenience variable.
10404 In the case of assigning to a convenience variable, the lhs
10405 should be exactly the result of the evaluation of the rhs. */
10406 type = value_type (arg1);
10407 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10408 type = NULL;
10409 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (type, exp, pos, noside);
10410 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10411 return arg1;
10412 if (VALUE_LVAL (arg1) == lval_internalvar)
10413 {
10414 /* Nothing. */
10415 }
10416 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10417 arg2 = cast_to_fixed (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10418 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10419 error
10420 (_("Fixed-point values must be assigned to fixed-point variables"));
10421 else
10422 arg2 = coerce_for_assign (value_type (arg1), arg2);
10423 return ada_value_assign (arg1, arg2);
10424
10425 case BINOP_ADD:
10426 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10427 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10428 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10429 goto nosideret;
10430 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10431 return (value_from_longest
10432 (value_type (arg1),
10433 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10434 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10435 return (value_from_longest
10436 (value_type (arg2),
10437 value_as_long (arg1) + value_as_long (arg2)));
10438 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10439 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10440 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10441 error (_("Operands of fixed-point addition must have the same type"));
10442 /* Do the addition, and cast the result to the type of the first
10443 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10444 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10445 type = value_type (arg1);
10446 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10447 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10448 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10449 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_ADD));
10450
10451 case BINOP_SUB:
10452 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10453 arg2 = evaluate_subexp_with_coercion (exp, pos, noside);
10454 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10455 goto nosideret;
10456 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg1)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10457 return (value_from_longest
10458 (value_type (arg1),
10459 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10460 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (arg2)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10461 return (value_from_longest
10462 (value_type (arg2),
10463 value_as_long (arg1) - value_as_long (arg2)));
10464 if ((ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1))
10465 || ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10466 && value_type (arg1) != value_type (arg2))
10467 error (_("Operands of fixed-point subtraction "
10468 "must have the same type"));
10469 /* Do the substraction, and cast the result to the type of the first
10470 argument. We cannot cast the result to a reference type, so if
10471 ARG1 is a reference type, find its underlying type. */
10472 type = value_type (arg1);
10473 while (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10474 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
10475 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10476 return value_cast (type, value_binop (arg1, arg2, BINOP_SUB));
10477
10478 case BINOP_MUL:
10479 case BINOP_DIV:
10480 case BINOP_REM:
10481 case BINOP_MOD:
10482 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10483 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10484 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10485 goto nosideret;
10486 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10487 {
10488 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10489 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
10490 }
10491 else
10492 {
10493 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_double;
10494 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10495 arg1 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg1);
10496 if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg2)))
10497 arg2 = cast_from_fixed (type, arg2);
10498 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10499 return ada_value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
10500 }
10501
10502 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10503 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10504 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10505 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (value_type (arg1), exp, pos, noside);
10506 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10507 goto nosideret;
10508 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10509 tem = 0;
10510 else
10511 {
10512 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10513 tem = ada_value_equal (arg1, arg2);
10514 }
10515 if (op == BINOP_NOTEQUAL)
10516 tem = !tem;
10517 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10518 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) tem);
10519
10520 case UNOP_NEG:
10521 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10522 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10523 goto nosideret;
10524 else if (ada_is_fixed_point_type (value_type (arg1)))
10525 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), value_neg (arg1));
10526 else
10527 {
10528 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
10529 return value_neg (arg1);
10530 }
10531
10532 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10533 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10534 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10535 {
10536 struct value *val;
10537
10538 *pos -= 1;
10539 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10540 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10541 return value_cast (type, val);
10542 }
10543
10544 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10545 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10546 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10547 {
10548 struct value *val;
10549
10550 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS);
10551 *pos = pc;
10552 val = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10553
10554 return value_cast (value_type (arg1), val);
10555 }
10556
10557 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10558 *pos -= 1;
10559
10560 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10561 {
10562 *pos += 4;
10563 goto nosideret;
10564 }
10565
10566 if (SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10567 /* Only encountered when an unresolved symbol occurs in a
10568 context other than a function call, in which case, it is
10569 invalid. */
10570 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10571 exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->print_name ());
10572
10573 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10574 {
10575 type = static_unwrap_type (SYMBOL_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol));
10576 /* Check to see if this is a tagged type. We also need to handle
10577 the case where the type is a reference to a tagged type, but
10578 we have to be careful to exclude pointers to tagged types.
10579 The latter should be shown as usual (as a pointer), whereas
10580 a reference should mostly be transparent to the user. */
10581 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type, 0)
10582 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10583 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0)))
10584 {
10585 /* Tagged types are a little special in the fact that the real
10586 type is dynamic and can only be determined by inspecting the
10587 object's tag. This means that we need to get the object's
10588 value first (EVAL_NORMAL) and then extract the actual object
10589 type from its tag.
10590
10591 Note that we cannot skip the final step where we extract
10592 the object type from its tag, because the EVAL_NORMAL phase
10593 results in dynamic components being resolved into fixed ones.
10594 This can cause problems when trying to print the type
10595 description of tagged types whose parent has a dynamic size:
10596 We use the type name of the "_parent" component in order
10597 to print the name of the ancestor type in the type description.
10598 If that component had a dynamic size, the resolution into
10599 a fixed type would result in the loss of that type name,
10600 thus preventing us from printing the name of the ancestor
10601 type in the type description. */
10602 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_NORMAL);
10603
10604 if (TYPE_CODE (type) != TYPE_CODE_REF)
10605 {
10606 struct type *actual_type;
10607
10608 actual_type = type_from_tag (ada_value_tag (arg1));
10609 if (actual_type == NULL)
10610 /* If, for some reason, we were unable to determine
10611 the actual type from the tag, then use the static
10612 approximation that we just computed as a fallback.
10613 This can happen if the debugging information is
10614 incomplete, for instance. */
10615 actual_type = type;
10616 return value_zero (actual_type, not_lval);
10617 }
10618 else
10619 {
10620 /* In the case of a ref, ada_coerce_ref takes care
10621 of determining the actual type. But the evaluation
10622 should return a ref as it should be valid to ask
10623 for its address; so rebuild a ref after coerce. */
10624 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
10625 return value_ref (arg1, TYPE_CODE_REF);
10626 }
10627 }
10628
10629 /* Records and unions for which GNAT encodings have been
10630 generated need to be statically fixed as well.
10631 Otherwise, non-static fixing produces a type where
10632 all dynamic properties are removed, which prevents "ptype"
10633 from being able to completely describe the type.
10634 For instance, a case statement in a variant record would be
10635 replaced by the relevant components based on the actual
10636 value of the discriminants. */
10637 if ((TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10638 && dynamic_template_type (type) != NULL)
10639 || (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_UNION
10640 && ada_find_parallel_type (type, "___XVU") != NULL))
10641 {
10642 *pos += 4;
10643 return value_zero (to_static_fixed_type (type), not_lval);
10644 }
10645 }
10646
10647 arg1 = evaluate_subexp_standard (expect_type, exp, pos, noside);
10648 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
10649
10650 case OP_FUNCALL:
10651 (*pos) += 2;
10652
10653 /* Allocate arg vector, including space for the function to be
10654 called in argvec[0] and a terminating NULL. */
10655 nargs = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10656 argvec = XALLOCAVEC (struct value *, nargs + 2);
10657
10658 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_VAR_VALUE
10659 && SYMBOL_DOMAIN (exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol) == UNDEF_DOMAIN)
10660 error (_("Unexpected unresolved symbol, %s, during evaluation"),
10661 exp->elts[pc + 5].symbol->print_name ());
10662 else
10663 {
10664 for (tem = 0; tem <= nargs; tem += 1)
10665 argvec[tem] = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10666 argvec[tem] = 0;
10667
10668 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10669 goto nosideret;
10670 }
10671
10672 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type
10673 (desc_base_type (value_type (argvec[0]))))
10674 argvec[0] = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]);
10675 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10676 && TYPE_FIELD_BITSIZE (value_type (argvec[0]), 0) != 0)
10677 /* This is a packed array that has already been fixed, and
10678 therefore already coerced to a simple array. Nothing further
10679 to do. */
10680 ;
10681 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
10682 {
10683 /* Make sure we dereference references so that all the code below
10684 feels like it's really handling the referenced value. Wrapping
10685 types (for alignment) may be there, so make sure we strip them as
10686 well. */
10687 argvec[0] = ada_to_fixed_value (coerce_ref (argvec[0]));
10688 }
10689 else if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (argvec[0])) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10690 && VALUE_LVAL (argvec[0]) == lval_memory)
10691 argvec[0] = value_addr (argvec[0]);
10692
10693 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (argvec[0]));
10694
10695 /* Ada allows us to implicitly dereference arrays when subscripting
10696 them. So, if this is an array typedef (encoding use for array
10697 access types encoded as fat pointers), strip it now. */
10698 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_TYPEDEF)
10699 type = ada_typedef_target_type (type);
10700
10701 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10702 {
10703 switch (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))))
10704 {
10705 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10706 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10707 break;
10708 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10709 break;
10710 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10711 if (noside != EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10712 argvec[0] = ada_value_ind (argvec[0]);
10713 type = ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10714 break;
10715 default:
10716 error (_("cannot subscript or call something of type `%s'"),
10717 ada_type_name (value_type (argvec[0])));
10718 break;
10719 }
10720 }
10721
10722 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
10723 {
10724 case TYPE_CODE_FUNC:
10725 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10726 {
10727 if (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) == NULL)
10728 error_call_unknown_return_type (NULL);
10729 return allocate_value (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
10730 }
10731 return call_function_by_hand (argvec[0], NULL,
10732 gdb::make_array_view (argvec + 1,
10733 nargs));
10734 case TYPE_CODE_INTERNAL_FUNCTION:
10735 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10736 /* We don't know anything about what the internal
10737 function might return, but we have to return
10738 something. */
10739 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
10740 not_lval);
10741 else
10742 return call_internal_function (exp->gdbarch, exp->language_defn,
10743 argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1);
10744
10745 case TYPE_CODE_STRUCT:
10746 {
10747 int arity;
10748
10749 arity = ada_array_arity (type);
10750 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10751 if (type == NULL)
10752 error (_("cannot subscript or call a record"));
10753 if (arity != nargs)
10754 error (_("wrong number of subscripts; expecting %d"), arity);
10755 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10756 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10757 return
10758 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10759 (argvec[0], nargs, argvec + 1));
10760 }
10761 case TYPE_CODE_ARRAY:
10762 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10763 {
10764 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10765 if (type == NULL)
10766 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10767 else
10768 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10769 }
10770 return
10771 unwrap_value (ada_value_subscript
10772 (ada_coerce_to_simple_array (argvec[0]),
10773 nargs, argvec + 1));
10774 case TYPE_CODE_PTR: /* Pointer to array */
10775 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10776 {
10777 type = to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), NULL, 1);
10778 type = ada_array_element_type (type, nargs);
10779 if (type == NULL)
10780 error (_("element type of array unknown"));
10781 else
10782 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
10783 }
10784 return
10785 unwrap_value (ada_value_ptr_subscript (argvec[0],
10786 nargs, argvec + 1));
10787
10788 default:
10789 error (_("Attempt to index or call something other than an "
10790 "array or function"));
10791 }
10792
10793 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10794 {
10795 struct value *array = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10796 struct value *low_bound_val =
10797 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10798 struct value *high_bound_val =
10799 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10800 LONGEST low_bound;
10801 LONGEST high_bound;
10802
10803 low_bound_val = coerce_ref (low_bound_val);
10804 high_bound_val = coerce_ref (high_bound_val);
10805 low_bound = value_as_long (low_bound_val);
10806 high_bound = value_as_long (high_bound_val);
10807
10808 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10809 goto nosideret;
10810
10811 /* If this is a reference to an aligner type, then remove all
10812 the aligners. */
10813 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10814 && ada_is_aligner_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array))))
10815 TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)) =
10816 ada_aligned_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)));
10817
10818 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (array)))
10819 error (_("cannot slice a packed array"));
10820
10821 /* If this is a reference to an array or an array lvalue,
10822 convert to a pointer. */
10823 if (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_REF
10824 || (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY
10825 && VALUE_LVAL (array) == lval_memory))
10826 array = value_addr (array);
10827
10828 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS
10829 && ada_is_array_descriptor_type (ada_check_typedef
10830 (value_type (array))))
10831 return empty_array (ada_type_of_array (array, 0), low_bound,
10832 high_bound);
10833
10834 array = ada_coerce_to_simple_array_ptr (array);
10835
10836 /* If we have more than one level of pointer indirection,
10837 dereference the value until we get only one level. */
10838 while (TYPE_CODE (value_type (array)) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
10839 && (TYPE_CODE (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (value_type (array)))
10840 == TYPE_CODE_PTR))
10841 array = value_ind (array);
10842
10843 /* Make sure we really do have an array type before going further,
10844 to avoid a SEGV when trying to get the index type or the target
10845 type later down the road if the debug info generated by
10846 the compiler is incorrect or incomplete. */
10847 if (!ada_is_simple_array_type (value_type (array)))
10848 error (_("cannot take slice of non-array"));
10849
10850 if (TYPE_CODE (ada_check_typedef (value_type (array)))
10851 == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
10852 {
10853 struct type *type0 = ada_check_typedef (value_type (array));
10854
10855 if (high_bound < low_bound || noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10856 return empty_array (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), low_bound, high_bound);
10857 else
10858 {
10859 struct type *arr_type0 =
10860 to_fixed_array_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type0), NULL, 1);
10861
10862 return ada_value_slice_from_ptr (array, arr_type0,
10863 longest_to_int (low_bound),
10864 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10865 }
10866 }
10867 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10868 return array;
10869 else if (high_bound < low_bound)
10870 return empty_array (value_type (array), low_bound, high_bound);
10871 else
10872 return ada_value_slice (array, longest_to_int (low_bound),
10873 longest_to_int (high_bound));
10874 }
10875
10876 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
10877 (*pos) += 2;
10878 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10879 type = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
10880
10881 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10882 goto nosideret;
10883
10884 switch (TYPE_CODE (type))
10885 {
10886 default:
10887 lim_warning (_("Membership test incompletely implemented; "
10888 "always returns true"));
10889 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10890 return value_from_longest (type, (LONGEST) 1);
10891
10892 case TYPE_CODE_RANGE:
10893 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_LOW_BOUND (type));
10894 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type));
10895 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10896 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10897 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10898 return
10899 value_from_longest (type,
10900 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10901 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10902 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10903 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10904 }
10905
10906 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
10907 (*pos) += 2;
10908 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10909 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10910
10911 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10912 goto nosideret;
10913
10914 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10915 {
10916 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10917 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
10918 }
10919
10920 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
10921
10922 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg2), tem, "range");
10923 if (!type)
10924 type = value_type (arg1);
10925
10926 arg3 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 1));
10927 arg2 = value_from_longest (type, ada_array_bound (arg2, tem, 0));
10928
10929 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10930 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10931 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10932 return
10933 value_from_longest (type,
10934 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10935 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10936 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10937 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10938
10939 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
10940 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10941 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10942 arg3 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10943
10944 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10945 goto nosideret;
10946
10947 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
10948 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg3);
10949 type = language_bool_type (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch);
10950 return
10951 value_from_longest (type,
10952 (value_less (arg1, arg3)
10953 || value_equal (arg1, arg3))
10954 && (value_less (arg2, arg1)
10955 || value_equal (arg2, arg1)));
10956
10957 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10958 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10959 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
10960 {
10961 struct type *type_arg;
10962
10963 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
10964 {
10965 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
10966 arg1 = NULL;
10967 type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
10968 }
10969 else
10970 {
10971 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
10972 type_arg = NULL;
10973 }
10974
10975 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode != OP_LONG)
10976 error (_("Invalid operand to '%s"), ada_attribute_name (op));
10977 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[*pos + 2].longconst);
10978 *pos += 4;
10979
10980 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
10981 goto nosideret;
10982 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
10983 {
10984 if (type_arg == NULL)
10985 type_arg = value_type (arg1);
10986
10987 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
10988 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
10989
10990 if (!discrete_type_p (type_arg))
10991 {
10992 switch (op)
10993 {
10994 default: /* Should never happen. */
10995 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
10996 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
10997 case OP_ATR_LAST:
10998 type_arg = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem,
10999 ada_attribute_name (op));
11000 break;
11001 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11002 type_arg = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11003 break;
11004 }
11005 }
11006
11007 return value_zero (type_arg, not_lval);
11008 }
11009 else if (type_arg == NULL)
11010 {
11011 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1);
11012
11013 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (value_type (arg1)))
11014 arg1 = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
11015
11016 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
11017 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11018 else
11019 {
11020 type = ada_index_type (value_type (arg1), tem,
11021 ada_attribute_name (op));
11022 if (type == NULL)
11023 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11024 }
11025
11026 switch (op)
11027 {
11028 default: /* Should never happen. */
11029 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11030 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11031 return value_from_longest
11032 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 0));
11033 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11034 return value_from_longest
11035 (type, ada_array_bound (arg1, tem, 1));
11036 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11037 return value_from_longest
11038 (type, ada_array_length (arg1, tem));
11039 }
11040 }
11041 else if (discrete_type_p (type_arg))
11042 {
11043 struct type *range_type;
11044 const char *name = ada_type_name (type_arg);
11045
11046 range_type = NULL;
11047 if (name != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type_arg) != TYPE_CODE_ENUM)
11048 range_type = to_fixed_range_type (type_arg, NULL);
11049 if (range_type == NULL)
11050 range_type = type_arg;
11051 switch (op)
11052 {
11053 default:
11054 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11055 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11056 return value_from_longest
11057 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_low_bound (range_type));
11058 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11059 return value_from_longest
11060 (range_type, ada_discrete_type_high_bound (range_type));
11061 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11062 error (_("the 'length attribute applies only to array types"));
11063 }
11064 }
11065 else if (TYPE_CODE (type_arg) == TYPE_CODE_FLT)
11066 error (_("unimplemented type attribute"));
11067 else
11068 {
11069 LONGEST low, high;
11070
11071 if (ada_is_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg))
11072 type_arg = decode_constrained_packed_array_type (type_arg);
11073
11074 if (op == OP_ATR_LENGTH)
11075 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11076 else
11077 {
11078 type = ada_index_type (type_arg, tem, ada_attribute_name (op));
11079 if (type == NULL)
11080 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11081 }
11082
11083 switch (op)
11084 {
11085 default:
11086 error (_("unexpected attribute encountered"));
11087 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
11088 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
11089 return value_from_longest (type, low);
11090 case OP_ATR_LAST:
11091 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
11092 return value_from_longest (type, high);
11093 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
11094 low = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 0);
11095 high = ada_array_bound_from_type (type_arg, tem, 1);
11096 return value_from_longest (type, high - low + 1);
11097 }
11098 }
11099 }
11100
11101 case OP_ATR_TAG:
11102 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11103 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11104 goto nosideret;
11105
11106 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11107 return value_zero (ada_tag_type (arg1), not_lval);
11108
11109 return ada_value_tag (arg1);
11110
11111 case OP_ATR_MIN:
11112 case OP_ATR_MAX:
11113 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11114 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11115 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11116 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11117 goto nosideret;
11118 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11119 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11120 else
11121 {
11122 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11123 return value_binop (arg1, arg2,
11124 op == OP_ATR_MIN ? BINOP_MIN : BINOP_MAX);
11125 }
11126
11127 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
11128 {
11129 struct type *type_arg = check_typedef (exp->elts[pc + 2].type);
11130
11131 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11132 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11133 goto nosideret;
11134
11135 if (!ada_is_modular_type (type_arg))
11136 error (_("'modulus must be applied to modular type"));
11137
11138 return value_from_longest (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type_arg),
11139 ada_modulus (type_arg));
11140 }
11141
11142
11143 case OP_ATR_POS:
11144 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11145 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11146 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11147 goto nosideret;
11148 type = builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int;
11149 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11150 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11151 else
11152 return value_pos_atr (type, arg1);
11153
11154 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
11155 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11156 type = value_type (arg1);
11157
11158 /* If the argument is a reference, then dereference its type, since
11159 the user is really asking for the size of the actual object,
11160 not the size of the pointer. */
11161 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF)
11162 type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type);
11163
11164 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11165 goto nosideret;
11166 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11167 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int, not_lval);
11168 else
11169 return value_from_longest (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11170 TARGET_CHAR_BIT * TYPE_LENGTH (type));
11171
11172 case OP_ATR_VAL:
11173 evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, EVAL_SKIP);
11174 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11175 type = exp->elts[pc + 2].type;
11176 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11177 goto nosideret;
11178 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11179 return value_zero (type, not_lval);
11180 else
11181 return value_val_atr (type, arg1);
11182
11183 case BINOP_EXP:
11184 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11185 arg2 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11186 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11187 goto nosideret;
11188 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11189 return value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval);
11190 else
11191 {
11192 /* For integer exponentiation operations,
11193 only promote the first argument. */
11194 if (is_integral_type (value_type (arg2)))
11195 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11196 else
11197 binop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1, &arg2);
11198
11199 return value_binop (arg1, arg2, op);
11200 }
11201
11202 case UNOP_PLUS:
11203 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11204 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11205 goto nosideret;
11206 else
11207 return arg1;
11208
11209 case UNOP_ABS:
11210 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11211 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11212 goto nosideret;
11213 unop_promote (exp->language_defn, exp->gdbarch, &arg1);
11214 if (value_less (arg1, value_zero (value_type (arg1), not_lval)))
11215 return value_neg (arg1);
11216 else
11217 return arg1;
11218
11219 case UNOP_IND:
11220 preeval_pos = *pos;
11221 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11222 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11223 goto nosideret;
11224 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11225 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11226 {
11227 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11228 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11229 {
11230 struct type *arrType = ada_type_of_array (arg1, 0);
11231
11232 if (arrType == NULL)
11233 error (_("Attempt to dereference null array pointer."));
11234 return value_at_lazy (arrType, 0);
11235 }
11236 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR
11237 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
11238 /* In C you can dereference an array to get the 1st elt. */
11239 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_ARRAY)
11240 {
11241 /* As mentioned in the OP_VAR_VALUE case, tagged types can
11242 only be determined by inspecting the object's tag.
11243 This means that we need to evaluate completely the
11244 expression in order to get its type. */
11245
11246 if ((TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_REF
11247 || TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_PTR)
11248 && ada_is_tagged_type (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type), 0))
11249 {
11250 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11251 EVAL_NORMAL);
11252 type = value_type (ada_value_ind (arg1));
11253 }
11254 else
11255 {
11256 type = to_static_fixed_type
11257 (ada_aligned_type
11258 (ada_check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type))));
11259 }
11260 ada_ensure_varsize_limit (type);
11261 return value_zero (type, lval_memory);
11262 }
11263 else if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11264 {
11265 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. */
11266 if (expect_type == NULL)
11267 return value_zero (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11268 lval_memory);
11269 else
11270 {
11271 expect_type =
11272 to_static_fixed_type (ada_aligned_type (expect_type));
11273 return value_zero (expect_type, lval_memory);
11274 }
11275 }
11276 else
11277 error (_("Attempt to take contents of a non-pointer value."));
11278 }
11279 arg1 = ada_coerce_ref (arg1); /* FIXME: What is this for?? */
11280 type = ada_check_typedef (value_type (arg1));
11281
11282 if (TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_INT)
11283 /* GDB allows dereferencing an int. If we were given
11284 the expect_type, then use that as the target type.
11285 Otherwise, assume that the target type is an int. */
11286 {
11287 if (expect_type != NULL)
11288 return ada_value_ind (value_cast (lookup_pointer_type (expect_type),
11289 arg1));
11290 else
11291 return value_at_lazy (builtin_type (exp->gdbarch)->builtin_int,
11292 (CORE_ADDR) value_as_address (arg1));
11293 }
11294
11295 if (ada_is_array_descriptor_type (type))
11296 /* GDB allows dereferencing GNAT array descriptors. */
11297 return ada_coerce_to_simple_array (arg1);
11298 else
11299 return ada_value_ind (arg1);
11300
11301 case STRUCTOP_STRUCT:
11302 tem = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
11303 (*pos) += 3 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (tem + 1);
11304 preeval_pos = *pos;
11305 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, pos, noside);
11306 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11307 goto nosideret;
11308 if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11309 {
11310 struct type *type1 = value_type (arg1);
11311
11312 if (ada_is_tagged_type (type1, 1))
11313 {
11314 type = ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1,
11315 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11316 1, 1);
11317
11318 /* If the field is not found, check if it exists in the
11319 extension of this object's type. This means that we
11320 need to evaluate completely the expression. */
11321
11322 if (type == NULL)
11323 {
11324 arg1 = evaluate_subexp (NULL_TYPE, exp, &preeval_pos,
11325 EVAL_NORMAL);
11326 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1,
11327 &exp->elts[pc + 2].string,
11328 0);
11329 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11330 type = value_type (ada_to_fixed_value (arg1));
11331 }
11332 }
11333 else
11334 type =
11335 ada_lookup_struct_elt_type (type1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 1,
11336 0);
11337
11338 return value_zero (ada_aligned_type (type), lval_memory);
11339 }
11340 else
11341 {
11342 arg1 = ada_value_struct_elt (arg1, &exp->elts[pc + 2].string, 0);
11343 arg1 = unwrap_value (arg1);
11344 return ada_to_fixed_value (arg1);
11345 }
11346
11347 case OP_TYPE:
11348 /* The value is not supposed to be used. This is here to make it
11349 easier to accommodate expressions that contain types. */
11350 (*pos) += 2;
11351 if (noside == EVAL_SKIP)
11352 goto nosideret;
11353 else if (noside == EVAL_AVOID_SIDE_EFFECTS)
11354 return allocate_value (exp->elts[pc + 1].type);
11355 else
11356 error (_("Attempt to use a type name as an expression"));
11357
11358 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11359 case OP_CHOICES:
11360 case OP_OTHERS:
11361 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
11362 case OP_POSITIONAL:
11363 case OP_NAME:
11364 if (noside == EVAL_NORMAL)
11365 switch (op)
11366 {
11367 case OP_NAME:
11368 error (_("Undefined name, ambiguous name, or renaming used in "
11369 "component association: %s."), &exp->elts[pc+2].string);
11370 case OP_AGGREGATE:
11371 error (_("Aggregates only allowed on the right of an assignment"));
11372 default:
11373 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11374 _("aggregate apparently mangled"));
11375 }
11376
11377 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
11378 *pos += oplen - 1;
11379 for (tem = 0; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
11380 ada_evaluate_subexp (NULL, exp, pos, noside);
11381 goto nosideret;
11382 }
11383
11384 nosideret:
11385 return eval_skip_value (exp);
11386 }
11387 \f
11388
11389 /* Fixed point */
11390
11391 /* If TYPE encodes an Ada fixed-point type, return the suffix of the
11392 type name that encodes the 'small and 'delta information.
11393 Otherwise, return NULL. */
11394
11395 static const char *
11396 fixed_type_info (struct type *type)
11397 {
11398 const char *name = ada_type_name (type);
11399 enum type_code code = (type == NULL) ? TYPE_CODE_UNDEF : TYPE_CODE (type);
11400
11401 if ((code == TYPE_CODE_INT || code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE) && name != NULL)
11402 {
11403 const char *tail = strstr (name, "___XF_");
11404
11405 if (tail == NULL)
11406 return NULL;
11407 else
11408 return tail + 5;
11409 }
11410 else if (code == TYPE_CODE_RANGE && TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type) != type)
11411 return fixed_type_info (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (type));
11412 else
11413 return NULL;
11414 }
11415
11416 /* Returns non-zero iff TYPE represents an Ada fixed-point type. */
11417
11418 int
11419 ada_is_fixed_point_type (struct type *type)
11420 {
11421 return fixed_type_info (type) != NULL;
11422 }
11423
11424 /* Return non-zero iff TYPE represents a System.Address type. */
11425
11426 int
11427 ada_is_system_address_type (struct type *type)
11428 {
11429 return (TYPE_NAME (type)
11430 && strcmp (TYPE_NAME (type), "system__address") == 0);
11431 }
11432
11433 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11434 type, return the target floating-point type to be used to represent
11435 of this type during internal computation. */
11436
11437 static struct type *
11438 ada_scaling_type (struct type *type)
11439 {
11440 return builtin_type (get_type_arch (type))->builtin_long_double;
11441 }
11442
11443 /* Assuming that TYPE is the representation of an Ada fixed-point
11444 type, return its delta, or NULL if the type is malformed and the
11445 delta cannot be determined. */
11446
11447 struct value *
11448 ada_delta (struct type *type)
11449 {
11450 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
11451 struct type *scale_type = ada_scaling_type (type);
11452
11453 long long num, den;
11454
11455 if (sscanf (encoding, "_%lld_%lld", &num, &den) < 2)
11456 return nullptr;
11457 else
11458 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num),
11459 value_from_longest (scale_type, den), BINOP_DIV);
11460 }
11461
11462 /* Assuming that ada_is_fixed_point_type (TYPE), return the scaling
11463 factor ('SMALL value) associated with the type. */
11464
11465 struct value *
11466 ada_scaling_factor (struct type *type)
11467 {
11468 const char *encoding = fixed_type_info (type);
11469 struct type *scale_type = ada_scaling_type (type);
11470
11471 long long num0, den0, num1, den1;
11472 int n;
11473
11474 n = sscanf (encoding, "_%lld_%lld_%lld_%lld",
11475 &num0, &den0, &num1, &den1);
11476
11477 if (n < 2)
11478 return value_from_longest (scale_type, 1);
11479 else if (n == 4)
11480 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num1),
11481 value_from_longest (scale_type, den1), BINOP_DIV);
11482 else
11483 return value_binop (value_from_longest (scale_type, num0),
11484 value_from_longest (scale_type, den0), BINOP_DIV);
11485 }
11486
11487 \f
11488
11489 /* Range types */
11490
11491 /* Scan STR beginning at position K for a discriminant name, and
11492 return the value of that discriminant field of DVAL in *PX. If
11493 PNEW_K is not null, put the position of the character beyond the
11494 name scanned in *PNEW_K. Return 1 if successful; return 0 and do
11495 not alter *PX and *PNEW_K if unsuccessful. */
11496
11497 static int
11498 scan_discrim_bound (const char *str, int k, struct value *dval, LONGEST * px,
11499 int *pnew_k)
11500 {
11501 static char *bound_buffer = NULL;
11502 static size_t bound_buffer_len = 0;
11503 const char *pstart, *pend, *bound;
11504 struct value *bound_val;
11505
11506 if (dval == NULL || str == NULL || str[k] == '\0')
11507 return 0;
11508
11509 pstart = str + k;
11510 pend = strstr (pstart, "__");
11511 if (pend == NULL)
11512 {
11513 bound = pstart;
11514 k += strlen (bound);
11515 }
11516 else
11517 {
11518 int len = pend - pstart;
11519
11520 /* Strip __ and beyond. */
11521 GROW_VECT (bound_buffer, bound_buffer_len, len + 1);
11522 strncpy (bound_buffer, pstart, len);
11523 bound_buffer[len] = '\0';
11524
11525 bound = bound_buffer;
11526 k = pend - str;
11527 }
11528
11529 bound_val = ada_search_struct_field (bound, dval, 0, value_type (dval));
11530 if (bound_val == NULL)
11531 return 0;
11532
11533 *px = value_as_long (bound_val);
11534 if (pnew_k != NULL)
11535 *pnew_k = k;
11536 return 1;
11537 }
11538
11539 /* Value of variable named NAME in the current environment. If
11540 no such variable found, then if ERR_MSG is null, returns 0, and
11541 otherwise causes an error with message ERR_MSG. */
11542
11543 static struct value *
11544 get_var_value (const char *name, const char *err_msg)
11545 {
11546 lookup_name_info lookup_name (name, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
11547
11548 std::vector<struct block_symbol> syms;
11549 int nsyms = ada_lookup_symbol_list_worker (lookup_name,
11550 get_selected_block (0),
11551 VAR_DOMAIN, &syms, 1);
11552
11553 if (nsyms != 1)
11554 {
11555 if (err_msg == NULL)
11556 return 0;
11557 else
11558 error (("%s"), err_msg);
11559 }
11560
11561 return value_of_variable (syms[0].symbol, syms[0].block);
11562 }
11563
11564 /* Value of integer variable named NAME in the current environment.
11565 If no such variable is found, returns false. Otherwise, sets VALUE
11566 to the variable's value and returns true. */
11567
11568 bool
11569 get_int_var_value (const char *name, LONGEST &value)
11570 {
11571 struct value *var_val = get_var_value (name, 0);
11572
11573 if (var_val == 0)
11574 return false;
11575
11576 value = value_as_long (var_val);
11577 return true;
11578 }
11579
11580
11581 /* Return a range type whose base type is that of the range type named
11582 NAME in the current environment, and whose bounds are calculated
11583 from NAME according to the GNAT range encoding conventions.
11584 Extract discriminant values, if needed, from DVAL. ORIG_TYPE is the
11585 corresponding range type from debug information; fall back to using it
11586 if symbol lookup fails. If a new type must be created, allocate it
11587 like ORIG_TYPE was. The bounds information, in general, is encoded
11588 in NAME, the base type given in the named range type. */
11589
11590 static struct type *
11591 to_fixed_range_type (struct type *raw_type, struct value *dval)
11592 {
11593 const char *name;
11594 struct type *base_type;
11595 const char *subtype_info;
11596
11597 gdb_assert (raw_type != NULL);
11598 gdb_assert (TYPE_NAME (raw_type) != NULL);
11599
11600 if (TYPE_CODE (raw_type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE)
11601 base_type = TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (raw_type);
11602 else
11603 base_type = raw_type;
11604
11605 name = TYPE_NAME (raw_type);
11606 subtype_info = strstr (name, "___XD");
11607 if (subtype_info == NULL)
11608 {
11609 LONGEST L = ada_discrete_type_low_bound (raw_type);
11610 LONGEST U = ada_discrete_type_high_bound (raw_type);
11611
11612 if (L < INT_MIN || U > INT_MAX)
11613 return raw_type;
11614 else
11615 return create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type), raw_type,
11616 L, U);
11617 }
11618 else
11619 {
11620 static char *name_buf = NULL;
11621 static size_t name_len = 0;
11622 int prefix_len = subtype_info - name;
11623 LONGEST L, U;
11624 struct type *type;
11625 const char *bounds_str;
11626 int n;
11627
11628 GROW_VECT (name_buf, name_len, prefix_len + 5);
11629 strncpy (name_buf, name, prefix_len);
11630 name_buf[prefix_len] = '\0';
11631
11632 subtype_info += 5;
11633 bounds_str = strchr (subtype_info, '_');
11634 n = 1;
11635
11636 if (*subtype_info == 'L')
11637 {
11638 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &L, &n)
11639 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &L, &n))
11640 return raw_type;
11641 if (bounds_str[n] == '_')
11642 n += 2;
11643 else if (bounds_str[n] == '.') /* FIXME? SGI Workshop kludge. */
11644 n += 1;
11645 subtype_info += 1;
11646 }
11647 else
11648 {
11649 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___L");
11650 if (!get_int_var_value (name_buf, L))
11651 {
11652 lim_warning (_("Unknown lower bound, using 1."));
11653 L = 1;
11654 }
11655 }
11656
11657 if (*subtype_info == 'U')
11658 {
11659 if (!ada_scan_number (bounds_str, n, &U, &n)
11660 && !scan_discrim_bound (bounds_str, n, dval, &U, &n))
11661 return raw_type;
11662 }
11663 else
11664 {
11665 strcpy (name_buf + prefix_len, "___U");
11666 if (!get_int_var_value (name_buf, U))
11667 {
11668 lim_warning (_("Unknown upper bound, using %ld."), (long) L);
11669 U = L;
11670 }
11671 }
11672
11673 type = create_static_range_type (alloc_type_copy (raw_type),
11674 base_type, L, U);
11675 /* create_static_range_type alters the resulting type's length
11676 to match the size of the base_type, which is not what we want.
11677 Set it back to the original range type's length. */
11678 TYPE_LENGTH (type) = TYPE_LENGTH (raw_type);
11679 TYPE_NAME (type) = name;
11680 return type;
11681 }
11682 }
11683
11684 /* True iff NAME is the name of a range type. */
11685
11686 int
11687 ada_is_range_type_name (const char *name)
11688 {
11689 return (name != NULL && strstr (name, "___XD"));
11690 }
11691 \f
11692
11693 /* Modular types */
11694
11695 /* True iff TYPE is an Ada modular type. */
11696
11697 int
11698 ada_is_modular_type (struct type *type)
11699 {
11700 struct type *subranged_type = get_base_type (type);
11701
11702 return (subranged_type != NULL && TYPE_CODE (type) == TYPE_CODE_RANGE
11703 && TYPE_CODE (subranged_type) == TYPE_CODE_INT
11704 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (subranged_type));
11705 }
11706
11707 /* Assuming ada_is_modular_type (TYPE), the modulus of TYPE. */
11708
11709 ULONGEST
11710 ada_modulus (struct type *type)
11711 {
11712 return (ULONGEST) TYPE_HIGH_BOUND (type) + 1;
11713 }
11714 \f
11715
11716 /* Ada exception catchpoint support:
11717 ---------------------------------
11718
11719 We support 3 kinds of exception catchpoints:
11720 . catchpoints on Ada exceptions
11721 . catchpoints on unhandled Ada exceptions
11722 . catchpoints on failed assertions
11723
11724 Exceptions raised during failed assertions, or unhandled exceptions
11725 could perfectly be caught with the general catchpoint on Ada exceptions.
11726 However, we can easily differentiate these two special cases, and having
11727 the option to distinguish these two cases from the rest can be useful
11728 to zero-in on certain situations.
11729
11730 Exception catchpoints are a specialized form of breakpoint,
11731 since they rely on inserting breakpoints inside known routines
11732 of the GNAT runtime. The implementation therefore uses a standard
11733 breakpoint structure of the BP_BREAKPOINT type, but with its own set
11734 of breakpoint_ops.
11735
11736 Support in the runtime for exception catchpoints have been changed
11737 a few times already, and these changes affect the implementation
11738 of these catchpoints. In order to be able to support several
11739 variants of the runtime, we use a sniffer that will determine
11740 the runtime variant used by the program being debugged. */
11741
11742 /* Ada's standard exceptions.
11743
11744 The Ada 83 standard also defined Numeric_Error. But there so many
11745 situations where it was unclear from the Ada 83 Reference Manual
11746 (RM) whether Constraint_Error or Numeric_Error should be raised,
11747 that the ARG (Ada Rapporteur Group) eventually issued a Binding
11748 Interpretation saying that anytime the RM says that Numeric_Error
11749 should be raised, the implementation may raise Constraint_Error.
11750 Ada 95 went one step further and pretty much removed Numeric_Error
11751 from the list of standard exceptions (it made it a renaming of
11752 Constraint_Error, to help preserve compatibility when compiling
11753 an Ada83 compiler). As such, we do not include Numeric_Error from
11754 this list of standard exceptions. */
11755
11756 static const char *standard_exc[] = {
11757 "constraint_error",
11758 "program_error",
11759 "storage_error",
11760 "tasking_error"
11761 };
11762
11763 typedef CORE_ADDR (ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype) (void);
11764
11765 /* A structure that describes how to support exception catchpoints
11766 for a given executable. */
11767
11768 struct exception_support_info
11769 {
11770 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11771 a catchpoint on exceptions. */
11772 const char *catch_exception_sym;
11773
11774 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11775 a catchpoint on unhandled exceptions. */
11776 const char *catch_exception_unhandled_sym;
11777
11778 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11779 a catchpoint on failed assertions. */
11780 const char *catch_assert_sym;
11781
11782 /* The name of the symbol to break on in order to insert
11783 a catchpoint on exception handling. */
11784 const char *catch_handlers_sym;
11785
11786 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
11787 catchpoint, this function is responsible for returning the address
11788 in inferior memory where the name of that exception is stored.
11789 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
11790 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_ftype *unhandled_exception_name_addr;
11791 };
11792
11793 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void);
11794 static CORE_ADDR ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void);
11795
11796 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11797 implement exception catchpoints with the latest version of the
11798 Ada runtime (as of 2019-08-??). */
11799
11800 static const struct exception_support_info default_exception_support_info =
11801 {
11802 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11803 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11804 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11805 "__gnat_begin_handler_v1", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11806 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11807 };
11808
11809 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11810 implement exception catchpoints with an earlier version of the
11811 Ada runtime (as of 2007-03-06) using v0 of the EH ABI. */
11812
11813 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_v0 =
11814 {
11815 "__gnat_debug_raise_exception", /* catch_exception_sym */
11816 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11817 "__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11818 "__gnat_begin_handler", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11819 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr
11820 };
11821
11822 /* The following exception support info structure describes how to
11823 implement exception catchpoints with a slightly older version
11824 of the Ada runtime. */
11825
11826 static const struct exception_support_info exception_support_info_fallback =
11827 {
11828 "__gnat_raise_nodefer_with_msg", /* catch_exception_sym */
11829 "__gnat_unhandled_exception", /* catch_exception_unhandled_sym */
11830 "system__assertions__raise_assert_failure", /* catch_assert_sym */
11831 "__gnat_begin_handler", /* catch_handlers_sym */
11832 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise
11833 };
11834
11835 /* Return nonzero if we can detect the exception support routines
11836 described in EINFO.
11837
11838 This function errors out if an abnormal situation is detected
11839 (for instance, if we find the exception support routines, but
11840 that support is found to be incomplete). */
11841
11842 static int
11843 ada_has_this_exception_support (const struct exception_support_info *einfo)
11844 {
11845 struct symbol *sym;
11846
11847 /* The symbol we're looking up is provided by a unit in the GNAT runtime
11848 that should be compiled with debugging information. As a result, we
11849 expect to find that symbol in the symtabs. */
11850
11851 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11852 if (sym == NULL)
11853 {
11854 /* Perhaps we did not find our symbol because the Ada runtime was
11855 compiled without debugging info, or simply stripped of it.
11856 It happens on some GNU/Linux distributions for instance, where
11857 users have to install a separate debug package in order to get
11858 the runtime's debugging info. In that situation, let the user
11859 know why we cannot insert an Ada exception catchpoint.
11860
11861 Note: Just for the purpose of inserting our Ada exception
11862 catchpoint, we could rely purely on the associated minimal symbol.
11863 But we would be operating in degraded mode anyway, since we are
11864 still lacking the debugging info needed later on to extract
11865 the name of the exception being raised (this name is printed in
11866 the catchpoint message, and is also used when trying to catch
11867 a specific exception). We do not handle this case for now. */
11868 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11869 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_exception_sym, NULL, NULL);
11870
11871 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11872 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11873 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11874 "in this configuration."));
11875
11876 return 0;
11877 }
11878
11879 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11880
11881 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11882 {
11883 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11884 sym->linkage_name (), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11885 return 0;
11886 }
11887
11888 sym = standard_lookup (einfo->catch_handlers_sym, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
11889 if (sym == NULL)
11890 {
11891 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym
11892 = lookup_minimal_symbol (einfo->catch_handlers_sym, NULL, NULL);
11893
11894 if (msym.minsym && MSYMBOL_TYPE (msym.minsym) != mst_solib_trampoline)
11895 error (_("Your Ada runtime appears to be missing some debugging "
11896 "information.\nCannot insert Ada exception catchpoint "
11897 "in this configuration."));
11898
11899 return 0;
11900 }
11901
11902 /* Make sure that the symbol we found corresponds to a function. */
11903
11904 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
11905 {
11906 error (_("Symbol \"%s\" is not a function (class = %d)"),
11907 sym->linkage_name (), SYMBOL_CLASS (sym));
11908 return 0;
11909 }
11910
11911 return 1;
11912 }
11913
11914 /* Inspect the Ada runtime and determine which exception info structure
11915 should be used to provide support for exception catchpoints.
11916
11917 This function will always set the per-inferior exception_info,
11918 or raise an error. */
11919
11920 static void
11921 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer (void)
11922 {
11923 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
11924
11925 /* If the exception info is already known, then no need to recompute it. */
11926 if (data->exception_info != NULL)
11927 return;
11928
11929 /* Check the latest (default) exception support info. */
11930 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&default_exception_support_info))
11931 {
11932 data->exception_info = &default_exception_support_info;
11933 return;
11934 }
11935
11936 /* Try the v0 exception suport info. */
11937 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_v0))
11938 {
11939 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_v0;
11940 return;
11941 }
11942
11943 /* Try our fallback exception suport info. */
11944 if (ada_has_this_exception_support (&exception_support_info_fallback))
11945 {
11946 data->exception_info = &exception_support_info_fallback;
11947 return;
11948 }
11949
11950 /* Sometimes, it is normal for us to not be able to find the routine
11951 we are looking for. This happens when the program is linked with
11952 the shared version of the GNAT runtime, and the program has not been
11953 started yet. Inform the user of these two possible causes if
11954 applicable. */
11955
11956 if (ada_update_initial_language (language_unknown) != language_ada)
11957 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Is this an Ada main program?"));
11958
11959 /* If the symbol does not exist, then check that the program is
11960 already started, to make sure that shared libraries have been
11961 loaded. If it is not started, this may mean that the symbol is
11962 in a shared library. */
11963
11964 if (inferior_ptid.pid () == 0)
11965 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. Try to start the program first."));
11966
11967 /* At this point, we know that we are debugging an Ada program and
11968 that the inferior has been started, but we still are not able to
11969 find the run-time symbols. That can mean that we are in
11970 configurable run time mode, or that a-except as been optimized
11971 out by the linker... In any case, at this point it is not worth
11972 supporting this feature. */
11973
11974 error (_("Cannot insert Ada exception catchpoints in this configuration."));
11975 }
11976
11977 /* True iff FRAME is very likely to be that of a function that is
11978 part of the runtime system. This is all very heuristic, but is
11979 intended to be used as advice as to what frames are uninteresting
11980 to most users. */
11981
11982 static int
11983 is_known_support_routine (struct frame_info *frame)
11984 {
11985 enum language func_lang;
11986 int i;
11987 const char *fullname;
11988
11989 /* If this code does not have any debugging information (no symtab),
11990 This cannot be any user code. */
11991
11992 symtab_and_line sal = find_frame_sal (frame);
11993 if (sal.symtab == NULL)
11994 return 1;
11995
11996 /* If there is a symtab, but the associated source file cannot be
11997 located, then assume this is not user code: Selecting a frame
11998 for which we cannot display the code would not be very helpful
11999 for the user. This should also take care of case such as VxWorks
12000 where the kernel has some debugging info provided for a few units. */
12001
12002 fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab);
12003 if (access (fullname, R_OK) != 0)
12004 return 1;
12005
12006 /* Check the unit filename against the Ada runtime file naming.
12007 We also check the name of the objfile against the name of some
12008 known system libraries that sometimes come with debugging info
12009 too. */
12010
12011 for (i = 0; known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
12012 {
12013 re_comp (known_runtime_file_name_patterns[i]);
12014 if (re_exec (lbasename (sal.symtab->filename)))
12015 return 1;
12016 if (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab) != NULL
12017 && re_exec (objfile_name (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab))))
12018 return 1;
12019 }
12020
12021 /* Check whether the function is a GNAT-generated entity. */
12022
12023 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> func_name
12024 = find_frame_funname (frame, &func_lang, NULL);
12025 if (func_name == NULL)
12026 return 1;
12027
12028 for (i = 0; known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i] != NULL; i += 1)
12029 {
12030 re_comp (known_auxiliary_function_name_patterns[i]);
12031 if (re_exec (func_name.get ()))
12032 return 1;
12033 }
12034
12035 return 0;
12036 }
12037
12038 /* Find the first frame that contains debugging information and that is not
12039 part of the Ada run-time, starting from FI and moving upward. */
12040
12041 void
12042 ada_find_printable_frame (struct frame_info *fi)
12043 {
12044 for (; fi != NULL; fi = get_prev_frame (fi))
12045 {
12046 if (!is_known_support_routine (fi))
12047 {
12048 select_frame (fi);
12049 break;
12050 }
12051 }
12052
12053 }
12054
12055 /* Assuming that the inferior just triggered an unhandled exception
12056 catchpoint, return the address in inferior memory where the name
12057 of the exception is stored.
12058
12059 Return zero if the address could not be computed. */
12060
12061 static CORE_ADDR
12062 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr (void)
12063 {
12064 return parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name");
12065 }
12066
12067 /* Same as ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr, except that this function
12068 should be used when the inferior uses an older version of the runtime,
12069 where the exception name needs to be extracted from a specific frame
12070 several frames up in the callstack. */
12071
12072 static CORE_ADDR
12073 ada_unhandled_exception_name_addr_from_raise (void)
12074 {
12075 int frame_level;
12076 struct frame_info *fi;
12077 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12078
12079 /* To determine the name of this exception, we need to select
12080 the frame corresponding to RAISE_SYM_NAME. This frame is
12081 at least 3 levels up, so we simply skip the first 3 frames
12082 without checking the name of their associated function. */
12083 fi = get_current_frame ();
12084 for (frame_level = 0; frame_level < 3; frame_level += 1)
12085 if (fi != NULL)
12086 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
12087
12088 while (fi != NULL)
12089 {
12090 enum language func_lang;
12091
12092 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> func_name
12093 = find_frame_funname (fi, &func_lang, NULL);
12094 if (func_name != NULL)
12095 {
12096 if (strcmp (func_name.get (),
12097 data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym) == 0)
12098 break; /* We found the frame we were looking for... */
12099 }
12100 fi = get_prev_frame (fi);
12101 }
12102
12103 if (fi == NULL)
12104 return 0;
12105
12106 select_frame (fi);
12107 return parse_and_eval_address ("id.full_name");
12108 }
12109
12110 /* Assuming the inferior just triggered an Ada exception catchpoint
12111 (of any type), return the address in inferior memory where the name
12112 of the exception is stored, if applicable.
12113
12114 Assumes the selected frame is the current frame.
12115
12116 Return zero if the address could not be computed, or if not relevant. */
12117
12118 static CORE_ADDR
12119 ada_exception_name_addr_1 (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12120 struct breakpoint *b)
12121 {
12122 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12123
12124 switch (ex)
12125 {
12126 case ada_catch_exception:
12127 return (parse_and_eval_address ("e.full_name"));
12128 break;
12129
12130 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12131 return data->exception_info->unhandled_exception_name_addr ();
12132 break;
12133
12134 case ada_catch_handlers:
12135 return 0; /* The runtimes does not provide access to the exception
12136 name. */
12137 break;
12138
12139 case ada_catch_assert:
12140 return 0; /* Exception name is not relevant in this case. */
12141 break;
12142
12143 default:
12144 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12145 break;
12146 }
12147
12148 return 0; /* Should never be reached. */
12149 }
12150
12151 /* Assuming the inferior is stopped at an exception catchpoint,
12152 return the message which was associated to the exception, if
12153 available. Return NULL if the message could not be retrieved.
12154
12155 Note: The exception message can be associated to an exception
12156 either through the use of the Raise_Exception function, or
12157 more simply (Ada 2005 and later), via:
12158
12159 raise Exception_Name with "exception message";
12160
12161 */
12162
12163 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
12164 ada_exception_message_1 (void)
12165 {
12166 struct value *e_msg_val;
12167 int e_msg_len;
12168
12169 /* For runtimes that support this feature, the exception message
12170 is passed as an unbounded string argument called "message". */
12171 e_msg_val = parse_and_eval ("message");
12172 if (e_msg_val == NULL)
12173 return NULL; /* Exception message not supported. */
12174
12175 e_msg_val = ada_coerce_to_simple_array (e_msg_val);
12176 gdb_assert (e_msg_val != NULL);
12177 e_msg_len = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (e_msg_val));
12178
12179 /* If the message string is empty, then treat it as if there was
12180 no exception message. */
12181 if (e_msg_len <= 0)
12182 return NULL;
12183
12184 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> e_msg ((char *) xmalloc (e_msg_len + 1));
12185 read_memory_string (value_address (e_msg_val), e_msg.get (), e_msg_len + 1);
12186 e_msg.get ()[e_msg_len] = '\0';
12187
12188 return e_msg;
12189 }
12190
12191 /* Same as ada_exception_message_1, except that all exceptions are
12192 contained here (returning NULL instead). */
12193
12194 static gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>
12195 ada_exception_message (void)
12196 {
12197 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> e_msg;
12198
12199 try
12200 {
12201 e_msg = ada_exception_message_1 ();
12202 }
12203 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12204 {
12205 e_msg.reset (nullptr);
12206 }
12207
12208 return e_msg;
12209 }
12210
12211 /* Same as ada_exception_name_addr_1, except that it intercepts and contains
12212 any error that ada_exception_name_addr_1 might cause to be thrown.
12213 When an error is intercepted, a warning with the error message is printed,
12214 and zero is returned. */
12215
12216 static CORE_ADDR
12217 ada_exception_name_addr (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12218 struct breakpoint *b)
12219 {
12220 CORE_ADDR result = 0;
12221
12222 try
12223 {
12224 result = ada_exception_name_addr_1 (ex, b);
12225 }
12226
12227 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12228 {
12229 warning (_("failed to get exception name: %s"), e.what ());
12230 return 0;
12231 }
12232
12233 return result;
12234 }
12235
12236 static std::string ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string
12237 (const char *excep_string,
12238 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex);
12239
12240 /* Ada catchpoints.
12241
12242 In the case of catchpoints on Ada exceptions, the catchpoint will
12243 stop the target on every exception the program throws. When a user
12244 specifies the name of a specific exception, we translate this
12245 request into a condition expression (in text form), and then parse
12246 it into an expression stored in each of the catchpoint's locations.
12247 We then use this condition to check whether the exception that was
12248 raised is the one the user is interested in. If not, then the
12249 target is resumed again. We store the name of the requested
12250 exception, in order to be able to re-set the condition expression
12251 when symbols change. */
12252
12253 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint
12254 breakpoint location. */
12255
12256 class ada_catchpoint_location : public bp_location
12257 {
12258 public:
12259 ada_catchpoint_location (breakpoint *owner)
12260 : bp_location (owner, bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
12261 {}
12262
12263 /* The condition that checks whether the exception that was raised
12264 is the specific exception the user specified on catchpoint
12265 creation. */
12266 expression_up excep_cond_expr;
12267 };
12268
12269 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an Ada catchpoint. */
12270
12271 struct ada_catchpoint : public breakpoint
12272 {
12273 explicit ada_catchpoint (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind kind)
12274 : m_kind (kind)
12275 {
12276 }
12277
12278 /* The name of the specific exception the user specified. */
12279 std::string excep_string;
12280
12281 /* What kind of catchpoint this is. */
12282 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind m_kind;
12283 };
12284
12285 /* Parse the exception condition string in the context of each of the
12286 catchpoint's locations, and store them for later evaluation. */
12287
12288 static void
12289 create_excep_cond_exprs (struct ada_catchpoint *c,
12290 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12291 {
12292 struct bp_location *bl;
12293
12294 /* Nothing to do if there's no specific exception to catch. */
12295 if (c->excep_string.empty ())
12296 return;
12297
12298 /* Same if there are no locations... */
12299 if (c->loc == NULL)
12300 return;
12301
12302 /* Compute the condition expression in text form, from the specific
12303 expection we want to catch. */
12304 std::string cond_string
12305 = ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (c->excep_string.c_str (), ex);
12306
12307 /* Iterate over all the catchpoint's locations, and parse an
12308 expression for each. */
12309 for (bl = c->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
12310 {
12311 struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12312 = (struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12313 expression_up exp;
12314
12315 if (!bl->shlib_disabled)
12316 {
12317 const char *s;
12318
12319 s = cond_string.c_str ();
12320 try
12321 {
12322 exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, bl->address,
12323 block_for_pc (bl->address),
12324 0);
12325 }
12326 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12327 {
12328 warning (_("failed to reevaluate internal exception condition "
12329 "for catchpoint %d: %s"),
12330 c->number, e.what ());
12331 }
12332 }
12333
12334 ada_loc->excep_cond_expr = std::move (exp);
12335 }
12336 }
12337
12338 /* Implement the ALLOCATE_LOCATION method in the breakpoint_ops
12339 structure for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12340
12341 static struct bp_location *
12342 allocate_location_exception (struct breakpoint *self)
12343 {
12344 return new ada_catchpoint_location (self);
12345 }
12346
12347 /* Implement the RE_SET method in the breakpoint_ops structure for all
12348 exception catchpoint kinds. */
12349
12350 static void
12351 re_set_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12352 {
12353 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12354
12355 /* Call the base class's method. This updates the catchpoint's
12356 locations. */
12357 bkpt_breakpoint_ops.re_set (b);
12358
12359 /* Reparse the exception conditional expressions. One for each
12360 location. */
12361 create_excep_cond_exprs (c, c->m_kind);
12362 }
12363
12364 /* Returns true if we should stop for this breakpoint hit. If the
12365 user specified a specific exception, we only want to cause a stop
12366 if the program thrown that exception. */
12367
12368 static int
12369 should_stop_exception (const struct bp_location *bl)
12370 {
12371 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
12372 const struct ada_catchpoint_location *ada_loc
12373 = (const struct ada_catchpoint_location *) bl;
12374 int stop;
12375
12376 struct internalvar *var = lookup_internalvar ("_ada_exception");
12377 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_assert)
12378 clear_internalvar (var);
12379 else
12380 {
12381 try
12382 {
12383 const char *expr;
12384
12385 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_handlers)
12386 expr = ("GNAT_GCC_exception_Access(gcc_exception)"
12387 ".all.occurrence.id");
12388 else
12389 expr = "e";
12390
12391 struct value *exc = parse_and_eval (expr);
12392 set_internalvar (var, exc);
12393 }
12394 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
12395 {
12396 clear_internalvar (var);
12397 }
12398 }
12399
12400 /* With no specific exception, should always stop. */
12401 if (c->excep_string.empty ())
12402 return 1;
12403
12404 if (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr == NULL)
12405 {
12406 /* We will have a NULL expression if back when we were creating
12407 the expressions, this location's had failed to parse. */
12408 return 1;
12409 }
12410
12411 stop = 1;
12412 try
12413 {
12414 struct value *mark;
12415
12416 mark = value_mark ();
12417 stop = value_true (evaluate_expression (ada_loc->excep_cond_expr.get ()));
12418 value_free_to_mark (mark);
12419 }
12420 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
12421 {
12422 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
12423 _("Error in testing exception condition:\n"));
12424 }
12425
12426 return stop;
12427 }
12428
12429 /* Implement the CHECK_STATUS method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12430 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12431
12432 static void
12433 check_status_exception (bpstat bs)
12434 {
12435 bs->stop = should_stop_exception (bs->bp_location_at);
12436 }
12437
12438 /* Implement the PRINT_IT method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12439 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12440
12441 static enum print_stop_action
12442 print_it_exception (bpstat bs)
12443 {
12444 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12445 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12446
12447 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
12448
12449 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12450 {
12451 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12452 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12453 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12454 }
12455
12456 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del
12457 ? "\nTemporary catchpoint " : "\nCatchpoint ");
12458 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
12459 uiout->text (", ");
12460
12461 /* ada_exception_name_addr relies on the selected frame being the
12462 current frame. Need to do this here because this function may be
12463 called more than once when printing a stop, and below, we'll
12464 select the first frame past the Ada run-time (see
12465 ada_find_printable_frame). */
12466 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
12467
12468 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12469 switch (c->m_kind)
12470 {
12471 case ada_catch_exception:
12472 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12473 case ada_catch_handlers:
12474 {
12475 const CORE_ADDR addr = ada_exception_name_addr (c->m_kind, b);
12476 char exception_name[256];
12477
12478 if (addr != 0)
12479 {
12480 read_memory (addr, (gdb_byte *) exception_name,
12481 sizeof (exception_name) - 1);
12482 exception_name [sizeof (exception_name) - 1] = '\0';
12483 }
12484 else
12485 {
12486 /* For some reason, we were unable to read the exception
12487 name. This could happen if the Runtime was compiled
12488 without debugging info, for instance. In that case,
12489 just replace the exception name by the generic string
12490 "exception" - it will read as "an exception" in the
12491 notification we are about to print. */
12492 memcpy (exception_name, "exception", sizeof ("exception"));
12493 }
12494 /* In the case of unhandled exception breakpoints, we print
12495 the exception name as "unhandled EXCEPTION_NAME", to make
12496 it clearer to the user which kind of catchpoint just got
12497 hit. We used ui_out_text to make sure that this extra
12498 info does not pollute the exception name in the MI case. */
12499 if (c->m_kind == ada_catch_exception_unhandled)
12500 uiout->text ("unhandled ");
12501 uiout->field_string ("exception-name", exception_name);
12502 }
12503 break;
12504 case ada_catch_assert:
12505 /* In this case, the name of the exception is not really
12506 important. Just print "failed assertion" to make it clearer
12507 that his program just hit an assertion-failure catchpoint.
12508 We used ui_out_text because this info does not belong in
12509 the MI output. */
12510 uiout->text ("failed assertion");
12511 break;
12512 }
12513
12514 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> exception_message = ada_exception_message ();
12515 if (exception_message != NULL)
12516 {
12517 uiout->text (" (");
12518 uiout->field_string ("exception-message", exception_message.get ());
12519 uiout->text (")");
12520 }
12521
12522 uiout->text (" at ");
12523 ada_find_printable_frame (get_current_frame ());
12524
12525 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12526 }
12527
12528 /* Implement the PRINT_ONE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12529 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12530
12531 static void
12532 print_one_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
12533 {
12534 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12535 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12536 struct value_print_options opts;
12537
12538 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12539
12540 if (opts.addressprint)
12541 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
12542
12543 annotate_field (5);
12544 switch (c->m_kind)
12545 {
12546 case ada_catch_exception:
12547 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12548 {
12549 std::string msg = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception"),
12550 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12551
12552 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
12553 }
12554 else
12555 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions");
12556
12557 break;
12558
12559 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12560 uiout->field_string ("what", "unhandled Ada exceptions");
12561 break;
12562
12563 case ada_catch_handlers:
12564 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12565 {
12566 uiout->field_fmt ("what",
12567 _("`%s' Ada exception handlers"),
12568 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12569 }
12570 else
12571 uiout->field_string ("what", "all Ada exceptions handlers");
12572 break;
12573
12574 case ada_catch_assert:
12575 uiout->field_string ("what", "failed Ada assertions");
12576 break;
12577
12578 default:
12579 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12580 break;
12581 }
12582 }
12583
12584 /* Implement the PRINT_MENTION method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12585 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12586
12587 static void
12588 print_mention_exception (struct breakpoint *b)
12589 {
12590 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12591 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12592
12593 uiout->text (b->disposition == disp_del ? _("Temporary catchpoint ")
12594 : _("Catchpoint "));
12595 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
12596 uiout->text (": ");
12597
12598 switch (c->m_kind)
12599 {
12600 case ada_catch_exception:
12601 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12602 {
12603 std::string info = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception"),
12604 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12605 uiout->text (info.c_str ());
12606 }
12607 else
12608 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions"));
12609 break;
12610
12611 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12612 uiout->text (_("unhandled Ada exceptions"));
12613 break;
12614
12615 case ada_catch_handlers:
12616 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12617 {
12618 std::string info
12619 = string_printf (_("`%s' Ada exception handlers"),
12620 c->excep_string.c_str ());
12621 uiout->text (info.c_str ());
12622 }
12623 else
12624 uiout->text (_("all Ada exceptions handlers"));
12625 break;
12626
12627 case ada_catch_assert:
12628 uiout->text (_("failed Ada assertions"));
12629 break;
12630
12631 default:
12632 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12633 break;
12634 }
12635 }
12636
12637 /* Implement the PRINT_RECREATE method in the breakpoint_ops structure
12638 for all exception catchpoint kinds. */
12639
12640 static void
12641 print_recreate_exception (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12642 {
12643 struct ada_catchpoint *c = (struct ada_catchpoint *) b;
12644
12645 switch (c->m_kind)
12646 {
12647 case ada_catch_exception:
12648 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception");
12649 if (!c->excep_string.empty ())
12650 fprintf_filtered (fp, " %s", c->excep_string.c_str ());
12651 break;
12652
12653 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12654 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch exception unhandled");
12655 break;
12656
12657 case ada_catch_handlers:
12658 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch handlers");
12659 break;
12660
12661 case ada_catch_assert:
12662 fprintf_filtered (fp, "catch assert");
12663 break;
12664
12665 default:
12666 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unexpected catchpoint type"));
12667 }
12668 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
12669 }
12670
12671 /* Virtual tables for various breakpoint types. */
12672 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
12673 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
12674 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
12675 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops;
12676
12677 /* See ada-lang.h. */
12678
12679 bool
12680 is_ada_exception_catchpoint (breakpoint *bp)
12681 {
12682 return (bp->ops == &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops
12683 || bp->ops == &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops
12684 || bp->ops == &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops
12685 || bp->ops == &catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops);
12686 }
12687
12688 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch exception" command.
12689 Set EX to the appropriate catchpoint type.
12690 Set EXCEP_STRING to the name of the specific exception if
12691 specified by the user.
12692 IS_CATCH_HANDLERS_CMD: True if the arguments are for a
12693 "catch handlers" command. False otherwise.
12694 If a condition is found at the end of the arguments, the condition
12695 expression is stored in COND_STRING (memory must be deallocated
12696 after use). Otherwise COND_STRING is set to NULL. */
12697
12698 static void
12699 catch_ada_exception_command_split (const char *args,
12700 bool is_catch_handlers_cmd,
12701 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind *ex,
12702 std::string *excep_string,
12703 std::string *cond_string)
12704 {
12705 std::string exception_name;
12706
12707 exception_name = extract_arg (&args);
12708 if (exception_name == "if")
12709 {
12710 /* This is not an exception name; this is the start of a condition
12711 expression for a catchpoint on all exceptions. So, "un-get"
12712 this token, and set exception_name to NULL. */
12713 exception_name.clear ();
12714 args -= 2;
12715 }
12716
12717 /* Check to see if we have a condition. */
12718
12719 args = skip_spaces (args);
12720 if (startswith (args, "if")
12721 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
12722 {
12723 args += 2;
12724 args = skip_spaces (args);
12725
12726 if (args[0] == '\0')
12727 error (_("Condition missing after `if' keyword"));
12728 *cond_string = args;
12729
12730 args += strlen (args);
12731 }
12732
12733 /* Check that we do not have any more arguments. Anything else
12734 is unexpected. */
12735
12736 if (args[0] != '\0')
12737 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
12738
12739 if (is_catch_handlers_cmd)
12740 {
12741 /* Catch handling of exceptions. */
12742 *ex = ada_catch_handlers;
12743 *excep_string = exception_name;
12744 }
12745 else if (exception_name.empty ())
12746 {
12747 /* Catch all exceptions. */
12748 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12749 excep_string->clear ();
12750 }
12751 else if (exception_name == "unhandled")
12752 {
12753 /* Catch unhandled exceptions. */
12754 *ex = ada_catch_exception_unhandled;
12755 excep_string->clear ();
12756 }
12757 else
12758 {
12759 /* Catch a specific exception. */
12760 *ex = ada_catch_exception;
12761 *excep_string = exception_name;
12762 }
12763 }
12764
12765 /* Return the name of the symbol on which we should break in order to
12766 implement a catchpoint of the EX kind. */
12767
12768 static const char *
12769 ada_exception_sym_name (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12770 {
12771 struct ada_inferior_data *data = get_ada_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
12772
12773 gdb_assert (data->exception_info != NULL);
12774
12775 switch (ex)
12776 {
12777 case ada_catch_exception:
12778 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_sym);
12779 break;
12780 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12781 return (data->exception_info->catch_exception_unhandled_sym);
12782 break;
12783 case ada_catch_assert:
12784 return (data->exception_info->catch_assert_sym);
12785 break;
12786 case ada_catch_handlers:
12787 return (data->exception_info->catch_handlers_sym);
12788 break;
12789 default:
12790 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12791 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12792 }
12793 }
12794
12795 /* Return the breakpoint ops "virtual table" used for catchpoints
12796 of the EX kind. */
12797
12798 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
12799 ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12800 {
12801 switch (ex)
12802 {
12803 case ada_catch_exception:
12804 return (&catch_exception_breakpoint_ops);
12805 break;
12806 case ada_catch_exception_unhandled:
12807 return (&catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops);
12808 break;
12809 case ada_catch_assert:
12810 return (&catch_assert_breakpoint_ops);
12811 break;
12812 case ada_catch_handlers:
12813 return (&catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops);
12814 break;
12815 default:
12816 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12817 _("unexpected catchpoint kind (%d)"), ex);
12818 }
12819 }
12820
12821 /* Return the condition that will be used to match the current exception
12822 being raised with the exception that the user wants to catch. This
12823 assumes that this condition is used when the inferior just triggered
12824 an exception catchpoint.
12825 EX: the type of catchpoints used for catching Ada exceptions. */
12826
12827 static std::string
12828 ada_exception_catchpoint_cond_string (const char *excep_string,
12829 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex)
12830 {
12831 int i;
12832 bool is_standard_exc = false;
12833 std::string result;
12834
12835 if (ex == ada_catch_handlers)
12836 {
12837 /* For exception handlers catchpoints, the condition string does
12838 not use the same parameter as for the other exceptions. */
12839 result = ("long_integer (GNAT_GCC_exception_Access"
12840 "(gcc_exception).all.occurrence.id)");
12841 }
12842 else
12843 result = "long_integer (e)";
12844
12845 /* The standard exceptions are a special case. They are defined in
12846 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info; if
12847 EXCEP_STRING is the not-fully-qualified name of a standard
12848 exception (e.g. "constraint_error") then, during the evaluation
12849 of the condition expression, the symbol lookup on this name would
12850 *not* return this standard exception. The catchpoint condition
12851 may then be set only on user-defined exceptions which have the
12852 same not-fully-qualified name (e.g. my_package.constraint_error).
12853
12854 To avoid this unexcepted behavior, these standard exceptions are
12855 systematically prefixed by "standard". This means that "catch
12856 exception constraint_error" is rewritten into "catch exception
12857 standard.constraint_error".
12858
12859 If an exception named constraint_error is defined in another package of
12860 the inferior program, then the only way to specify this exception as a
12861 breakpoint condition is to use its fully-qualified named:
12862 e.g. my_package.constraint_error. */
12863
12864 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (standard_exc) / sizeof (char *); i++)
12865 {
12866 if (strcmp (standard_exc [i], excep_string) == 0)
12867 {
12868 is_standard_exc = true;
12869 break;
12870 }
12871 }
12872
12873 result += " = ";
12874
12875 if (is_standard_exc)
12876 string_appendf (result, "long_integer (&standard.%s)", excep_string);
12877 else
12878 string_appendf (result, "long_integer (&%s)", excep_string);
12879
12880 return result;
12881 }
12882
12883 /* Return the symtab_and_line that should be used to insert an exception
12884 catchpoint of the TYPE kind.
12885
12886 ADDR_STRING returns the name of the function where the real
12887 breakpoint that implements the catchpoints is set, depending on the
12888 type of catchpoint we need to create. */
12889
12890 static struct symtab_and_line
12891 ada_exception_sal (enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex,
12892 std::string *addr_string, const struct breakpoint_ops **ops)
12893 {
12894 const char *sym_name;
12895 struct symbol *sym;
12896
12897 /* First, find out which exception support info to use. */
12898 ada_exception_support_info_sniffer ();
12899
12900 /* Then lookup the function on which we will break in order to catch
12901 the Ada exceptions requested by the user. */
12902 sym_name = ada_exception_sym_name (ex);
12903 sym = standard_lookup (sym_name, NULL, VAR_DOMAIN);
12904
12905 if (sym == NULL)
12906 error (_("Catchpoint symbol not found: %s"), sym_name);
12907
12908 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK)
12909 error (_("Unable to insert catchpoint. %s is not a function."), sym_name);
12910
12911 /* Set ADDR_STRING. */
12912 *addr_string = sym_name;
12913
12914 /* Set OPS. */
12915 *ops = ada_exception_breakpoint_ops (ex);
12916
12917 return find_function_start_sal (sym, 1);
12918 }
12919
12920 /* Create an Ada exception catchpoint.
12921
12922 EX_KIND is the kind of exception catchpoint to be created.
12923
12924 If EXCEPT_STRING is empty, this catchpoint is expected to trigger
12925 for all exceptions. Otherwise, EXCEPT_STRING indicates the name
12926 of the exception to which this catchpoint applies.
12927
12928 COND_STRING, if not empty, is the catchpoint condition.
12929
12930 TEMPFLAG, if nonzero, means that the underlying breakpoint
12931 should be temporary.
12932
12933 FROM_TTY is the usual argument passed to all commands implementations. */
12934
12935 void
12936 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12937 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind,
12938 const std::string &excep_string,
12939 const std::string &cond_string,
12940 int tempflag,
12941 int disabled,
12942 int from_tty)
12943 {
12944 std::string addr_string;
12945 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = NULL;
12946 struct symtab_and_line sal = ada_exception_sal (ex_kind, &addr_string, &ops);
12947
12948 std::unique_ptr<ada_catchpoint> c (new ada_catchpoint (ex_kind));
12949 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, sal, addr_string.c_str (),
12950 ops, tempflag, disabled, from_tty);
12951 c->excep_string = excep_string;
12952 create_excep_cond_exprs (c.get (), ex_kind);
12953 if (!cond_string.empty ())
12954 set_breakpoint_condition (c.get (), cond_string.c_str (), from_tty);
12955 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
12956 }
12957
12958 /* Implement the "catch exception" command. */
12959
12960 static void
12961 catch_ada_exception_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
12962 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12963 {
12964 const char *arg = arg_entry;
12965 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12966 int tempflag;
12967 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12968 std::string excep_string;
12969 std::string cond_string;
12970
12971 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12972
12973 if (!arg)
12974 arg = "";
12975 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, false, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
12976 &cond_string);
12977 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
12978 excep_string, cond_string,
12979 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
12980 from_tty);
12981 }
12982
12983 /* Implement the "catch handlers" command. */
12984
12985 static void
12986 catch_ada_handlers_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
12987 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12988 {
12989 const char *arg = arg_entry;
12990 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12991 int tempflag;
12992 enum ada_exception_catchpoint_kind ex_kind;
12993 std::string excep_string;
12994 std::string cond_string;
12995
12996 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12997
12998 if (!arg)
12999 arg = "";
13000 catch_ada_exception_command_split (arg, true, &ex_kind, &excep_string,
13001 &cond_string);
13002 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ex_kind,
13003 excep_string, cond_string,
13004 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
13005 from_tty);
13006 }
13007
13008 /* Completion function for the Ada "catch" commands. */
13009
13010 static void
13011 catch_ada_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd, completion_tracker &tracker,
13012 const char *text, const char *word)
13013 {
13014 std::vector<ada_exc_info> exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (NULL);
13015
13016 for (const ada_exc_info &info : exceptions)
13017 {
13018 if (startswith (info.name, word))
13019 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (info.name));
13020 }
13021 }
13022
13023 /* Split the arguments specified in a "catch assert" command.
13024
13025 ARGS contains the command's arguments (or the empty string if
13026 no arguments were passed).
13027
13028 If ARGS contains a condition, set COND_STRING to that condition
13029 (the memory needs to be deallocated after use). */
13030
13031 static void
13032 catch_ada_assert_command_split (const char *args, std::string &cond_string)
13033 {
13034 args = skip_spaces (args);
13035
13036 /* Check whether a condition was provided. */
13037 if (startswith (args, "if")
13038 && (isspace (args[2]) || args[2] == '\0'))
13039 {
13040 args += 2;
13041 args = skip_spaces (args);
13042 if (args[0] == '\0')
13043 error (_("condition missing after `if' keyword"));
13044 cond_string.assign (args);
13045 }
13046
13047 /* Otherwise, there should be no other argument at the end of
13048 the command. */
13049 else if (args[0] != '\0')
13050 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
13051 }
13052
13053 /* Implement the "catch assert" command. */
13054
13055 static void
13056 catch_assert_command (const char *arg_entry, int from_tty,
13057 struct cmd_list_element *command)
13058 {
13059 const char *arg = arg_entry;
13060 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13061 int tempflag;
13062 std::string cond_string;
13063
13064 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
13065
13066 if (!arg)
13067 arg = "";
13068 catch_ada_assert_command_split (arg, cond_string);
13069 create_ada_exception_catchpoint (gdbarch, ada_catch_assert,
13070 "", cond_string,
13071 tempflag, 1 /* enabled */,
13072 from_tty);
13073 }
13074
13075 /* Return non-zero if the symbol SYM is an Ada exception object. */
13076
13077 static int
13078 ada_is_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
13079 {
13080 const char *type_name = TYPE_NAME (SYMBOL_TYPE (sym));
13081
13082 return (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_TYPEDEF
13083 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_BLOCK
13084 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_CONST
13085 && SYMBOL_CLASS (sym) != LOC_UNRESOLVED
13086 && type_name != NULL && strcmp (type_name, "exception") == 0);
13087 }
13088
13089 /* Given a global symbol SYM, return non-zero iff SYM is a non-standard
13090 Ada exception object. This matches all exceptions except the ones
13091 defined by the Ada language. */
13092
13093 static int
13094 ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (struct symbol *sym)
13095 {
13096 int i;
13097
13098 if (!ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13099 return 0;
13100
13101 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13102 if (strcmp (sym->linkage_name (), standard_exc[i]) == 0)
13103 return 0; /* A standard exception. */
13104
13105 /* Numeric_Error is also a standard exception, so exclude it.
13106 See the STANDARD_EXC description for more details as to why
13107 this exception is not listed in that array. */
13108 if (strcmp (sym->linkage_name (), "numeric_error") == 0)
13109 return 0;
13110
13111 return 1;
13112 }
13113
13114 /* A helper function for std::sort, comparing two struct ada_exc_info
13115 objects.
13116
13117 The comparison is determined first by exception name, and then
13118 by exception address. */
13119
13120 bool
13121 ada_exc_info::operator< (const ada_exc_info &other) const
13122 {
13123 int result;
13124
13125 result = strcmp (name, other.name);
13126 if (result < 0)
13127 return true;
13128 if (result == 0 && addr < other.addr)
13129 return true;
13130 return false;
13131 }
13132
13133 bool
13134 ada_exc_info::operator== (const ada_exc_info &other) const
13135 {
13136 return addr == other.addr && strcmp (name, other.name) == 0;
13137 }
13138
13139 /* Sort EXCEPTIONS using compare_ada_exception_info as the comparison
13140 routine, but keeping the first SKIP elements untouched.
13141
13142 All duplicates are also removed. */
13143
13144 static void
13145 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions,
13146 int skip)
13147 {
13148 std::sort (exceptions->begin () + skip, exceptions->end ());
13149 exceptions->erase (std::unique (exceptions->begin () + skip, exceptions->end ()),
13150 exceptions->end ());
13151 }
13152
13153 /* Add all exceptions defined by the Ada standard whose name match
13154 a regular expression.
13155
13156 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13157 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13158 filtering is performed.
13159
13160 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13161 gets pushed. */
13162
13163 static void
13164 ada_add_standard_exceptions (compiled_regex *preg,
13165 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13166 {
13167 int i;
13168
13169 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (standard_exc); i++)
13170 {
13171 if (preg == NULL
13172 || preg->exec (standard_exc[i], 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
13173 {
13174 struct bound_minimal_symbol msymbol
13175 = ada_lookup_simple_minsym (standard_exc[i]);
13176
13177 if (msymbol.minsym != NULL)
13178 {
13179 struct ada_exc_info info
13180 = {standard_exc[i], BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (msymbol)};
13181
13182 exceptions->push_back (info);
13183 }
13184 }
13185 }
13186 }
13187
13188 /* Add all Ada exceptions defined locally and accessible from the given
13189 FRAME.
13190
13191 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13192 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13193 filtering is performed.
13194
13195 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13196 gets pushed. */
13197
13198 static void
13199 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (compiled_regex *preg,
13200 struct frame_info *frame,
13201 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13202 {
13203 const struct block *block = get_frame_block (frame, 0);
13204
13205 while (block != 0)
13206 {
13207 struct block_iterator iter;
13208 struct symbol *sym;
13209
13210 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (block, iter, sym)
13211 {
13212 switch (SYMBOL_CLASS (sym))
13213 {
13214 case LOC_TYPEDEF:
13215 case LOC_BLOCK:
13216 case LOC_CONST:
13217 break;
13218 default:
13219 if (ada_is_exception_sym (sym))
13220 {
13221 struct ada_exc_info info = {sym->print_name (),
13222 SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13223
13224 exceptions->push_back (info);
13225 }
13226 }
13227 }
13228 if (BLOCK_FUNCTION (block) != NULL)
13229 break;
13230 block = BLOCK_SUPERBLOCK (block);
13231 }
13232 }
13233
13234 /* Return true if NAME matches PREG or if PREG is NULL. */
13235
13236 static bool
13237 name_matches_regex (const char *name, compiled_regex *preg)
13238 {
13239 return (preg == NULL
13240 || preg->exec (ada_decode (name).c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0);
13241 }
13242
13243 /* Add all exceptions defined globally whose name name match
13244 a regular expression, excluding standard exceptions.
13245
13246 The reason we exclude standard exceptions is that they need
13247 to be handled separately: Standard exceptions are defined inside
13248 a runtime unit which is normally not compiled with debugging info,
13249 and thus usually do not show up in our symbol search. However,
13250 if the unit was in fact built with debugging info, we need to
13251 exclude them because they would duplicate the entry we found
13252 during the special loop that specifically searches for those
13253 standard exceptions.
13254
13255 If PREG is not NULL, then this regexp_t object is used to
13256 perform the symbol name matching. Otherwise, no name-based
13257 filtering is performed.
13258
13259 EXCEPTIONS is a vector of exceptions to which matching exceptions
13260 gets pushed. */
13261
13262 static void
13263 ada_add_global_exceptions (compiled_regex *preg,
13264 std::vector<ada_exc_info> *exceptions)
13265 {
13266 /* In Ada, the symbol "search name" is a linkage name, whereas the
13267 regular expression used to do the matching refers to the natural
13268 name. So match against the decoded name. */
13269 expand_symtabs_matching (NULL,
13270 lookup_name_info::match_any (),
13271 [&] (const char *search_name)
13272 {
13273 std::string decoded = ada_decode (search_name);
13274 return name_matches_regex (decoded.c_str (), preg);
13275 },
13276 NULL,
13277 VARIABLES_DOMAIN);
13278
13279 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
13280 {
13281 for (compunit_symtab *s : objfile->compunits ())
13282 {
13283 const struct blockvector *bv = COMPUNIT_BLOCKVECTOR (s);
13284 int i;
13285
13286 for (i = GLOBAL_BLOCK; i <= STATIC_BLOCK; i++)
13287 {
13288 const struct block *b = BLOCKVECTOR_BLOCK (bv, i);
13289 struct block_iterator iter;
13290 struct symbol *sym;
13291
13292 ALL_BLOCK_SYMBOLS (b, iter, sym)
13293 if (ada_is_non_standard_exception_sym (sym)
13294 && name_matches_regex (sym->natural_name (), preg))
13295 {
13296 struct ada_exc_info info
13297 = {sym->print_name (), SYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (sym)};
13298
13299 exceptions->push_back (info);
13300 }
13301 }
13302 }
13303 }
13304 }
13305
13306 /* Implements ada_exceptions_list with the regular expression passed
13307 as a regex_t, rather than a string.
13308
13309 If not NULL, PREG is used to filter out exceptions whose names
13310 do not match. Otherwise, all exceptions are listed. */
13311
13312 static std::vector<ada_exc_info>
13313 ada_exceptions_list_1 (compiled_regex *preg)
13314 {
13315 std::vector<ada_exc_info> result;
13316 int prev_len;
13317
13318 /* First, list the known standard exceptions. These exceptions
13319 need to be handled separately, as they are usually defined in
13320 runtime units that have been compiled without debugging info. */
13321
13322 ada_add_standard_exceptions (preg, &result);
13323
13324 /* Next, find all exceptions whose scope is local and accessible
13325 from the currently selected frame. */
13326
13327 if (has_stack_frames ())
13328 {
13329 prev_len = result.size ();
13330 ada_add_exceptions_from_frame (preg, get_selected_frame (NULL),
13331 &result);
13332 if (result.size () > prev_len)
13333 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13334 }
13335
13336 /* Add all exceptions whose scope is global. */
13337
13338 prev_len = result.size ();
13339 ada_add_global_exceptions (preg, &result);
13340 if (result.size () > prev_len)
13341 sort_remove_dups_ada_exceptions_list (&result, prev_len);
13342
13343 return result;
13344 }
13345
13346 /* Return a vector of ada_exc_info.
13347
13348 If REGEXP is NULL, all exceptions are included in the result.
13349 Otherwise, it should contain a valid regular expression,
13350 and only the exceptions whose names match that regular expression
13351 are included in the result.
13352
13353 The exceptions are sorted in the following order:
13354 - Standard exceptions (defined by the Ada language), in
13355 alphabetical order;
13356 - Exceptions only visible from the current frame, in
13357 alphabetical order;
13358 - Exceptions whose scope is global, in alphabetical order. */
13359
13360 std::vector<ada_exc_info>
13361 ada_exceptions_list (const char *regexp)
13362 {
13363 if (regexp == NULL)
13364 return ada_exceptions_list_1 (NULL);
13365
13366 compiled_regex reg (regexp, REG_NOSUB, _("invalid regular expression"));
13367 return ada_exceptions_list_1 (&reg);
13368 }
13369
13370 /* Implement the "info exceptions" command. */
13371
13372 static void
13373 info_exceptions_command (const char *regexp, int from_tty)
13374 {
13375 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
13376
13377 std::vector<ada_exc_info> exceptions = ada_exceptions_list (regexp);
13378
13379 if (regexp != NULL)
13380 printf_filtered
13381 (_("All Ada exceptions matching regular expression \"%s\":\n"), regexp);
13382 else
13383 printf_filtered (_("All defined Ada exceptions:\n"));
13384
13385 for (const ada_exc_info &info : exceptions)
13386 printf_filtered ("%s: %s\n", info.name, paddress (gdbarch, info.addr));
13387 }
13388
13389 /* Operators */
13390 /* Information about operators given special treatment in functions
13391 below. */
13392 /* Format: OP_DEFN (<operator>, <operator length>, <# args>, <binop>). */
13393
13394 #define ADA_OPERATORS \
13395 OP_DEFN (OP_VAR_VALUE, 4, 0, 0) \
13396 OP_DEFN (BINOP_IN_BOUNDS, 3, 2, 0) \
13397 OP_DEFN (TERNOP_IN_RANGE, 1, 3, 0) \
13398 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_FIRST, 1, 2, 0) \
13399 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LAST, 1, 2, 0) \
13400 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_LENGTH, 1, 2, 0) \
13401 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_IMAGE, 1, 2, 0) \
13402 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MAX, 1, 3, 0) \
13403 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MIN, 1, 3, 0) \
13404 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_MODULUS, 1, 1, 0) \
13405 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_POS, 1, 2, 0) \
13406 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_SIZE, 1, 1, 0) \
13407 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_TAG, 1, 1, 0) \
13408 OP_DEFN (OP_ATR_VAL, 1, 2, 0) \
13409 OP_DEFN (UNOP_QUAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13410 OP_DEFN (UNOP_IN_RANGE, 3, 1, 0) \
13411 OP_DEFN (OP_OTHERS, 1, 1, 0) \
13412 OP_DEFN (OP_POSITIONAL, 3, 1, 0) \
13413 OP_DEFN (OP_DISCRETE_RANGE, 1, 2, 0)
13414
13415 static void
13416 ada_operator_length (const struct expression *exp, int pc, int *oplenp,
13417 int *argsp)
13418 {
13419 switch (exp->elts[pc - 1].opcode)
13420 {
13421 default:
13422 operator_length_standard (exp, pc, oplenp, argsp);
13423 break;
13424
13425 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13426 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13427 ADA_OPERATORS;
13428 #undef OP_DEFN
13429
13430 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13431 *oplenp = 3;
13432 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst);
13433 break;
13434
13435 case OP_CHOICES:
13436 *oplenp = 3;
13437 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc - 2].longconst) + 1;
13438 break;
13439 }
13440 }
13441
13442 /* Implementation of the exp_descriptor method operator_check. */
13443
13444 static int
13445 ada_operator_check (struct expression *exp, int pos,
13446 int (*objfile_func) (struct objfile *objfile, void *data),
13447 void *data)
13448 {
13449 const union exp_element *const elts = exp->elts;
13450 struct type *type = NULL;
13451
13452 switch (elts[pos].opcode)
13453 {
13454 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13455 case UNOP_QUAL:
13456 type = elts[pos + 1].type;
13457 break;
13458
13459 default:
13460 return operator_check_standard (exp, pos, objfile_func, data);
13461 }
13462
13463 /* Invoke callbacks for TYPE and OBJFILE if they were set as non-NULL. */
13464
13465 if (type && TYPE_OBJFILE (type)
13466 && (*objfile_func) (TYPE_OBJFILE (type), data))
13467 return 1;
13468
13469 return 0;
13470 }
13471
13472 static const char *
13473 ada_op_name (enum exp_opcode opcode)
13474 {
13475 switch (opcode)
13476 {
13477 default:
13478 return op_name_standard (opcode);
13479
13480 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) case op: return #op;
13481 ADA_OPERATORS;
13482 #undef OP_DEFN
13483
13484 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13485 return "OP_AGGREGATE";
13486 case OP_CHOICES:
13487 return "OP_CHOICES";
13488 case OP_NAME:
13489 return "OP_NAME";
13490 }
13491 }
13492
13493 /* As for operator_length, but assumes PC is pointing at the first
13494 element of the operator, and gives meaningful results only for the
13495 Ada-specific operators, returning 0 for *OPLENP and *ARGSP otherwise. */
13496
13497 static void
13498 ada_forward_operator_length (struct expression *exp, int pc,
13499 int *oplenp, int *argsp)
13500 {
13501 switch (exp->elts[pc].opcode)
13502 {
13503 default:
13504 *oplenp = *argsp = 0;
13505 break;
13506
13507 #define OP_DEFN(op, len, args, binop) \
13508 case op: *oplenp = len; *argsp = args; break;
13509 ADA_OPERATORS;
13510 #undef OP_DEFN
13511
13512 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13513 *oplenp = 3;
13514 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13515 break;
13516
13517 case OP_CHOICES:
13518 *oplenp = 3;
13519 *argsp = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst) + 1;
13520 break;
13521
13522 case OP_STRING:
13523 case OP_NAME:
13524 {
13525 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13526
13527 *oplenp = 4 + BYTES_TO_EXP_ELEM (len + 1);
13528 *argsp = 0;
13529 break;
13530 }
13531 }
13532 }
13533
13534 static int
13535 ada_dump_subexp_body (struct expression *exp, struct ui_file *stream, int elt)
13536 {
13537 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[elt].opcode;
13538 int oplen, nargs;
13539 int pc = elt;
13540 int i;
13541
13542 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, elt, &oplen, &nargs);
13543
13544 switch (op)
13545 {
13546 /* Ada attributes ('Foo). */
13547 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13548 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13549 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13550 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13551 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13552 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13553 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13554 case OP_ATR_POS:
13555 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13556 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13557 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13558 break;
13559
13560 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13561 case UNOP_QUAL:
13562 /* XXX: gdb_sprint_host_address, type_sprint */
13563 fprintf_filtered (stream, _("Type @"));
13564 gdb_print_host_address (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, stream);
13565 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (");
13566 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, NULL, stream, 0);
13567 fprintf_filtered (stream, ")");
13568 break;
13569 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13570 fprintf_filtered (stream, " (%d)",
13571 longest_to_int (exp->elts[pc + 2].longconst));
13572 break;
13573 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13574 break;
13575
13576 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13577 case OP_OTHERS:
13578 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13579 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13580 case OP_CHOICES:
13581 break;
13582
13583 case OP_NAME:
13584 case OP_STRING:
13585 {
13586 char *name = &exp->elts[elt + 2].string;
13587 int len = longest_to_int (exp->elts[elt + 1].longconst);
13588
13589 fprintf_filtered (stream, "Text: `%.*s'", len, name);
13590 break;
13591 }
13592
13593 default:
13594 return dump_subexp_body_standard (exp, stream, elt);
13595 }
13596
13597 elt += oplen;
13598 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13599 elt = dump_subexp (exp, stream, elt);
13600
13601 return elt;
13602 }
13603
13604 /* The Ada extension of print_subexp (q.v.). */
13605
13606 static void
13607 ada_print_subexp (struct expression *exp, int *pos,
13608 struct ui_file *stream, enum precedence prec)
13609 {
13610 int oplen, nargs, i;
13611 int pc = *pos;
13612 enum exp_opcode op = exp->elts[pc].opcode;
13613
13614 ada_forward_operator_length (exp, pc, &oplen, &nargs);
13615
13616 *pos += oplen;
13617 switch (op)
13618 {
13619 default:
13620 *pos -= oplen;
13621 print_subexp_standard (exp, pos, stream, prec);
13622 return;
13623
13624 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
13625 fputs_filtered (exp->elts[pc + 2].symbol->natural_name (), stream);
13626 return;
13627
13628 case BINOP_IN_BOUNDS:
13629 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13630 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13631 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13632 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13633 fputs_filtered ("'range", stream);
13634 if (exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst > 1)
13635 fprintf_filtered (stream, "(%ld)",
13636 (long) exp->elts[pc + 1].longconst);
13637 return;
13638
13639 case TERNOP_IN_RANGE:
13640 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13641 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13642 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13643 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13644 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13645 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13646 fputs_filtered (" .. ", stream);
13647 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_EQUAL);
13648 if (prec >= PREC_EQUAL)
13649 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13650 return;
13651
13652 case OP_ATR_FIRST:
13653 case OP_ATR_LAST:
13654 case OP_ATR_LENGTH:
13655 case OP_ATR_IMAGE:
13656 case OP_ATR_MAX:
13657 case OP_ATR_MIN:
13658 case OP_ATR_MODULUS:
13659 case OP_ATR_POS:
13660 case OP_ATR_SIZE:
13661 case OP_ATR_TAG:
13662 case OP_ATR_VAL:
13663 if (exp->elts[*pos].opcode == OP_TYPE)
13664 {
13665 if (TYPE_CODE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type) != TYPE_CODE_VOID)
13666 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[*pos + 1].type, "", stream, 0, 0,
13667 &type_print_raw_options);
13668 *pos += 3;
13669 }
13670 else
13671 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13672 fprintf_filtered (stream, "'%s", ada_attribute_name (op));
13673 if (nargs > 1)
13674 {
13675 int tem;
13676
13677 for (tem = 1; tem < nargs; tem += 1)
13678 {
13679 fputs_filtered ((tem == 1) ? " (" : ", ", stream);
13680 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_ABOVE_COMMA);
13681 }
13682 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13683 }
13684 return;
13685
13686 case UNOP_QUAL:
13687 type_print (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 0);
13688 fputs_filtered ("'(", stream);
13689 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_PREFIX);
13690 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13691 return;
13692
13693 case UNOP_IN_RANGE:
13694 /* XXX: sprint_subexp */
13695 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13696 fputs_filtered (" in ", stream);
13697 LA_PRINT_TYPE (exp->elts[pc + 1].type, "", stream, 1, 0,
13698 &type_print_raw_options);
13699 return;
13700
13701 case OP_DISCRETE_RANGE:
13702 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13703 fputs_filtered ("..", stream);
13704 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13705 return;
13706
13707 case OP_OTHERS:
13708 fputs_filtered ("others => ", stream);
13709 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13710 return;
13711
13712 case OP_CHOICES:
13713 for (i = 0; i < nargs-1; i += 1)
13714 {
13715 if (i > 0)
13716 fputs_filtered ("|", stream);
13717 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13718 }
13719 fputs_filtered (" => ", stream);
13720 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13721 return;
13722
13723 case OP_POSITIONAL:
13724 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13725 return;
13726
13727 case OP_AGGREGATE:
13728 fputs_filtered ("(", stream);
13729 for (i = 0; i < nargs; i += 1)
13730 {
13731 if (i > 0)
13732 fputs_filtered (", ", stream);
13733 print_subexp (exp, pos, stream, PREC_SUFFIX);
13734 }
13735 fputs_filtered (")", stream);
13736 return;
13737 }
13738 }
13739
13740 /* Table mapping opcodes into strings for printing operators
13741 and precedences of the operators. */
13742
13743 static const struct op_print ada_op_print_tab[] = {
13744 {":=", BINOP_ASSIGN, PREC_ASSIGN, 1},
13745 {"or else", BINOP_LOGICAL_OR, PREC_LOGICAL_OR, 0},
13746 {"and then", BINOP_LOGICAL_AND, PREC_LOGICAL_AND, 0},
13747 {"or", BINOP_BITWISE_IOR, PREC_BITWISE_IOR, 0},
13748 {"xor", BINOP_BITWISE_XOR, PREC_BITWISE_XOR, 0},
13749 {"and", BINOP_BITWISE_AND, PREC_BITWISE_AND, 0},
13750 {"=", BINOP_EQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13751 {"/=", BINOP_NOTEQUAL, PREC_EQUAL, 0},
13752 {"<=", BINOP_LEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13753 {">=", BINOP_GEQ, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13754 {">", BINOP_GTR, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13755 {"<", BINOP_LESS, PREC_ORDER, 0},
13756 {">>", BINOP_RSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13757 {"<<", BINOP_LSH, PREC_SHIFT, 0},
13758 {"+", BINOP_ADD, PREC_ADD, 0},
13759 {"-", BINOP_SUB, PREC_ADD, 0},
13760 {"&", BINOP_CONCAT, PREC_ADD, 0},
13761 {"*", BINOP_MUL, PREC_MUL, 0},
13762 {"/", BINOP_DIV, PREC_MUL, 0},
13763 {"rem", BINOP_REM, PREC_MUL, 0},
13764 {"mod", BINOP_MOD, PREC_MUL, 0},
13765 {"**", BINOP_EXP, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13766 {"@", BINOP_REPEAT, PREC_REPEAT, 0},
13767 {"-", UNOP_NEG, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13768 {"+", UNOP_PLUS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13769 {"not ", UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13770 {"not ", UNOP_COMPLEMENT, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13771 {"abs ", UNOP_ABS, PREC_PREFIX, 0},
13772 {".all", UNOP_IND, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13773 {"'access", UNOP_ADDR, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13774 {"'size", OP_ATR_SIZE, PREC_SUFFIX, 1},
13775 {NULL, OP_NULL, PREC_SUFFIX, 0}
13776 };
13777 \f
13778 enum ada_primitive_types {
13779 ada_primitive_type_int,
13780 ada_primitive_type_long,
13781 ada_primitive_type_short,
13782 ada_primitive_type_char,
13783 ada_primitive_type_float,
13784 ada_primitive_type_double,
13785 ada_primitive_type_void,
13786 ada_primitive_type_long_long,
13787 ada_primitive_type_long_double,
13788 ada_primitive_type_natural,
13789 ada_primitive_type_positive,
13790 ada_primitive_type_system_address,
13791 ada_primitive_type_storage_offset,
13792 nr_ada_primitive_types
13793 };
13794
13795 static void
13796 ada_language_arch_info (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13797 struct language_arch_info *lai)
13798 {
13799 const struct builtin_type *builtin = builtin_type (gdbarch);
13800
13801 lai->primitive_type_vector
13802 = GDBARCH_OBSTACK_CALLOC (gdbarch, nr_ada_primitive_types + 1,
13803 struct type *);
13804
13805 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_int]
13806 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13807 0, "integer");
13808 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long]
13809 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_bit (gdbarch),
13810 0, "long_integer");
13811 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_short]
13812 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_short_bit (gdbarch),
13813 0, "short_integer");
13814 lai->string_char_type
13815 = lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_char]
13816 = arch_character_type (gdbarch, TARGET_CHAR_BIT, 0, "character");
13817 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_float]
13818 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_float_bit (gdbarch),
13819 "float", gdbarch_float_format (gdbarch));
13820 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_double]
13821 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_double_bit (gdbarch),
13822 "long_float", gdbarch_double_format (gdbarch));
13823 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_long]
13824 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_long_bit (gdbarch),
13825 0, "long_long_integer");
13826 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_long_double]
13827 = arch_float_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_long_double_bit (gdbarch),
13828 "long_long_float", gdbarch_long_double_format (gdbarch));
13829 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_natural]
13830 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13831 0, "natural");
13832 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_positive]
13833 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, gdbarch_int_bit (gdbarch),
13834 0, "positive");
13835 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_void]
13836 = builtin->builtin_void;
13837
13838 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]
13839 = lookup_pointer_type (arch_type (gdbarch, TYPE_CODE_VOID, TARGET_CHAR_BIT,
13840 "void"));
13841 TYPE_NAME (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address])
13842 = "system__address";
13843
13844 /* Create the equivalent of the System.Storage_Elements.Storage_Offset
13845 type. This is a signed integral type whose size is the same as
13846 the size of addresses. */
13847 {
13848 unsigned int addr_length = TYPE_LENGTH
13849 (lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_system_address]);
13850
13851 lai->primitive_type_vector [ada_primitive_type_storage_offset]
13852 = arch_integer_type (gdbarch, addr_length * HOST_CHAR_BIT, 0,
13853 "storage_offset");
13854 }
13855
13856 lai->bool_type_symbol = NULL;
13857 lai->bool_type_default = builtin->builtin_bool;
13858 }
13859 \f
13860 /* Language vector */
13861
13862 /* Not really used, but needed in the ada_language_defn. */
13863
13864 static void
13865 emit_char (int c, struct type *type, struct ui_file *stream, int quoter)
13866 {
13867 ada_emit_char (c, type, stream, quoter, 1);
13868 }
13869
13870 static int
13871 parse (struct parser_state *ps)
13872 {
13873 warnings_issued = 0;
13874 return ada_parse (ps);
13875 }
13876
13877 static const struct exp_descriptor ada_exp_descriptor = {
13878 ada_print_subexp,
13879 ada_operator_length,
13880 ada_operator_check,
13881 ada_op_name,
13882 ada_dump_subexp_body,
13883 ada_evaluate_subexp
13884 };
13885
13886 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype adapter for wild_match. */
13887
13888 static bool
13889 do_wild_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13890 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13891 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13892 {
13893 return wild_match (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name));
13894 }
13895
13896 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype adapter for full_match. */
13897
13898 static bool
13899 do_full_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13900 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13901 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13902 {
13903 return full_match (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name));
13904 }
13905
13906 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype for exact (verbatim) matches. */
13907
13908 static bool
13909 do_exact_match (const char *symbol_search_name,
13910 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13911 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13912 {
13913 return strcmp (symbol_search_name, ada_lookup_name (lookup_name)) == 0;
13914 }
13915
13916 /* Build the Ada lookup name for LOOKUP_NAME. */
13917
13918 ada_lookup_name_info::ada_lookup_name_info (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
13919 {
13920 gdb::string_view user_name = lookup_name.name ();
13921
13922 if (user_name[0] == '<')
13923 {
13924 if (user_name.back () == '>')
13925 m_encoded_name
13926 = user_name.substr (1, user_name.size () - 2).to_string ();
13927 else
13928 m_encoded_name
13929 = user_name.substr (1, user_name.size () - 1).to_string ();
13930 m_encoded_p = true;
13931 m_verbatim_p = true;
13932 m_wild_match_p = false;
13933 m_standard_p = false;
13934 }
13935 else
13936 {
13937 m_verbatim_p = false;
13938
13939 m_encoded_p = user_name.find ("__") != gdb::string_view::npos;
13940
13941 if (!m_encoded_p)
13942 {
13943 const char *folded = ada_fold_name (user_name);
13944 const char *encoded = ada_encode_1 (folded, false);
13945 if (encoded != NULL)
13946 m_encoded_name = encoded;
13947 else
13948 m_encoded_name = user_name.to_string ();
13949 }
13950 else
13951 m_encoded_name = user_name.to_string ();
13952
13953 /* Handle the 'package Standard' special case. See description
13954 of m_standard_p. */
13955 if (startswith (m_encoded_name.c_str (), "standard__"))
13956 {
13957 m_encoded_name = m_encoded_name.substr (sizeof ("standard__") - 1);
13958 m_standard_p = true;
13959 }
13960 else
13961 m_standard_p = false;
13962
13963 /* If the name contains a ".", then the user is entering a fully
13964 qualified entity name, and the match must not be done in wild
13965 mode. Similarly, if the user wants to complete what looks
13966 like an encoded name, the match must not be done in wild
13967 mode. Also, in the standard__ special case always do
13968 non-wild matching. */
13969 m_wild_match_p
13970 = (lookup_name.match_type () != symbol_name_match_type::FULL
13971 && !m_encoded_p
13972 && !m_standard_p
13973 && user_name.find ('.') == std::string::npos);
13974 }
13975 }
13976
13977 /* symbol_name_matcher_ftype method for Ada. This only handles
13978 completion mode. */
13979
13980 static bool
13981 ada_symbol_name_matches (const char *symbol_search_name,
13982 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13983 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13984 {
13985 return lookup_name.ada ().matches (symbol_search_name,
13986 lookup_name.match_type (),
13987 comp_match_res);
13988 }
13989
13990 /* A name matcher that matches the symbol name exactly, with
13991 strcmp. */
13992
13993 static bool
13994 literal_symbol_name_matcher (const char *symbol_search_name,
13995 const lookup_name_info &lookup_name,
13996 completion_match_result *comp_match_res)
13997 {
13998 gdb::string_view name_view = lookup_name.name ();
13999
14000 if (lookup_name.completion_mode ()
14001 ? (strncmp (symbol_search_name, name_view.data (),
14002 name_view.size ()) == 0)
14003 : symbol_search_name == name_view)
14004 {
14005 if (comp_match_res != NULL)
14006 comp_match_res->set_match (symbol_search_name);
14007 return true;
14008 }
14009 else
14010 return false;
14011 }
14012
14013 /* Implement the "la_get_symbol_name_matcher" language_defn method for
14014 Ada. */
14015
14016 static symbol_name_matcher_ftype *
14017 ada_get_symbol_name_matcher (const lookup_name_info &lookup_name)
14018 {
14019 if (lookup_name.match_type () == symbol_name_match_type::SEARCH_NAME)
14020 return literal_symbol_name_matcher;
14021
14022 if (lookup_name.completion_mode ())
14023 return ada_symbol_name_matches;
14024 else
14025 {
14026 if (lookup_name.ada ().wild_match_p ())
14027 return do_wild_match;
14028 else if (lookup_name.ada ().verbatim_p ())
14029 return do_exact_match;
14030 else
14031 return do_full_match;
14032 }
14033 }
14034
14035 /* Implement the "la_read_var_value" language_defn method for Ada. */
14036
14037 static struct value *
14038 ada_read_var_value (struct symbol *var, const struct block *var_block,
14039 struct frame_info *frame)
14040 {
14041 /* The only case where default_read_var_value is not sufficient
14042 is when VAR is a renaming... */
14043 if (frame != nullptr)
14044 {
14045 const struct block *frame_block = get_frame_block (frame, NULL);
14046 if (frame_block != nullptr && ada_is_renaming_symbol (var))
14047 return ada_read_renaming_var_value (var, frame_block);
14048 }
14049
14050 /* This is a typical case where we expect the default_read_var_value
14051 function to work. */
14052 return default_read_var_value (var, var_block, frame);
14053 }
14054
14055 static const char *ada_extensions[] =
14056 {
14057 ".adb", ".ads", ".a", ".ada", ".dg", NULL
14058 };
14059
14060 extern const struct language_defn ada_language_defn = {
14061 "ada", /* Language name */
14062 "Ada",
14063 language_ada,
14064 range_check_off,
14065 case_sensitive_on, /* Yes, Ada is case-insensitive, but
14066 that's not quite what this means. */
14067 array_row_major,
14068 macro_expansion_no,
14069 ada_extensions,
14070 &ada_exp_descriptor,
14071 parse,
14072 resolve,
14073 ada_printchar, /* Print a character constant */
14074 ada_printstr, /* Function to print string constant */
14075 emit_char, /* Function to print single char (not used) */
14076 ada_print_type, /* Print a type using appropriate syntax */
14077 ada_print_typedef, /* Print a typedef using appropriate syntax */
14078 ada_value_print_inner, /* la_value_print_inner */
14079 ada_value_print, /* Print a top-level value */
14080 ada_read_var_value, /* la_read_var_value */
14081 NULL, /* Language specific skip_trampoline */
14082 NULL, /* name_of_this */
14083 true, /* la_store_sym_names_in_linkage_form_p */
14084 ada_lookup_symbol_nonlocal, /* Looking up non-local symbols. */
14085 basic_lookup_transparent_type, /* lookup_transparent_type */
14086 ada_la_decode, /* Language specific symbol demangler */
14087 ada_sniff_from_mangled_name,
14088 NULL, /* Language specific
14089 class_name_from_physname */
14090 ada_op_print_tab, /* expression operators for printing */
14091 0, /* c-style arrays */
14092 1, /* String lower bound */
14093 ada_get_gdb_completer_word_break_characters,
14094 ada_collect_symbol_completion_matches,
14095 ada_language_arch_info,
14096 ada_print_array_index,
14097 default_pass_by_reference,
14098 ada_watch_location_expression,
14099 ada_get_symbol_name_matcher, /* la_get_symbol_name_matcher */
14100 ada_iterate_over_symbols,
14101 default_search_name_hash,
14102 &ada_varobj_ops,
14103 NULL,
14104 NULL,
14105 ada_is_string_type,
14106 "(...)" /* la_struct_too_deep_ellipsis */
14107 };
14108
14109 /* Command-list for the "set/show ada" prefix command. */
14110 static struct cmd_list_element *set_ada_list;
14111 static struct cmd_list_element *show_ada_list;
14112
14113 static void
14114 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops (void)
14115 {
14116 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14117
14118 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
14119
14120 ops = &catch_exception_breakpoint_ops;
14121 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14122 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14123 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14124 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14125 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14126 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14127 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14128 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14129
14130 ops = &catch_exception_unhandled_breakpoint_ops;
14131 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14132 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14133 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14134 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14135 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14136 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14137 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14138 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14139
14140 ops = &catch_assert_breakpoint_ops;
14141 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14142 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14143 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14144 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14145 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14146 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14147 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14148 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14149
14150 ops = &catch_handlers_breakpoint_ops;
14151 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
14152 ops->allocate_location = allocate_location_exception;
14153 ops->re_set = re_set_exception;
14154 ops->check_status = check_status_exception;
14155 ops->print_it = print_it_exception;
14156 ops->print_one = print_one_exception;
14157 ops->print_mention = print_mention_exception;
14158 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_exception;
14159 }
14160
14161 /* This module's 'new_objfile' observer. */
14162
14163 static void
14164 ada_new_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
14165 {
14166 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
14167 }
14168
14169 /* This module's 'free_objfile' observer. */
14170
14171 static void
14172 ada_free_objfile_observer (struct objfile *objfile)
14173 {
14174 ada_clear_symbol_cache ();
14175 }
14176
14177 void _initialize_ada_language ();
14178 void
14179 _initialize_ada_language ()
14180 {
14181 initialize_ada_catchpoint_ops ();
14182
14183 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class,
14184 _("Prefix command for changing Ada-specific settings."),
14185 &set_ada_list, "set ada ", 0, &setlist);
14186
14187 add_show_prefix_cmd ("ada", no_class,
14188 _("Generic command for showing Ada-specific settings."),
14189 &show_ada_list, "show ada ", 0, &showlist);
14190
14191 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("trust-PAD-over-XVS", class_obscure,
14192 &trust_pad_over_xvs, _("\
14193 Enable or disable an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types."), _("\
14194 Show whether an optimization trusting PAD types over XVS types is activated."),
14195 _("\
14196 This is related to the encoding used by the GNAT compiler. The debugger\n\
14197 should normally trust the contents of PAD types, but certain older versions\n\
14198 of GNAT have a bug that sometimes causes the information in the PAD type\n\
14199 to be incorrect. Turning this setting \"off\" allows the debugger to\n\
14200 work around this bug. It is always safe to turn this option \"off\", but\n\
14201 this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is recommended to NOT change\n\
14202 this option to \"off\" unless necessary."),
14203 NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
14204
14205 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("print-signatures", class_vars,
14206 &print_signatures, _("\
14207 Enable or disable the output of formal and return types for functions in the \
14208 overloads selection menu."), _("\
14209 Show whether the output of formal and return types for functions in the \
14210 overloads selection menu is activated."),
14211 NULL, NULL, NULL, &set_ada_list, &show_ada_list);
14212
14213 add_catch_command ("exception", _("\
14214 Catch Ada exceptions, when raised.\n\
14215 Usage: catch exception [ARG] [if CONDITION]\n\
14216 Without any argument, stop when any Ada exception is raised.\n\
14217 If ARG is \"unhandled\" (without the quotes), only stop when the exception\n\
14218 being raised does not have a handler (and will therefore lead to the task's\n\
14219 termination).\n\
14220 Otherwise, the catchpoint only stops when the name of the exception being\n\
14221 raised is the same as ARG.\n\
14222 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14223 exception should cause a stop."),
14224 catch_ada_exception_command,
14225 catch_ada_completer,
14226 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14227 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14228
14229 add_catch_command ("handlers", _("\
14230 Catch Ada exceptions, when handled.\n\
14231 Usage: catch handlers [ARG] [if CONDITION]\n\
14232 Without any argument, stop when any Ada exception is handled.\n\
14233 With an argument, catch only exceptions with the given name.\n\
14234 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14235 exception should cause a stop."),
14236 catch_ada_handlers_command,
14237 catch_ada_completer,
14238 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14239 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14240 add_catch_command ("assert", _("\
14241 Catch failed Ada assertions, when raised.\n\
14242 Usage: catch assert [if CONDITION]\n\
14243 CONDITION is a boolean expression that is evaluated to see whether the\n\
14244 exception should cause a stop."),
14245 catch_assert_command,
14246 NULL,
14247 CATCH_PERMANENT,
14248 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
14249
14250 varsize_limit = 65536;
14251 add_setshow_uinteger_cmd ("varsize-limit", class_support,
14252 &varsize_limit, _("\
14253 Set the maximum number of bytes allowed in a variable-size object."), _("\
14254 Show the maximum number of bytes allowed in a variable-size object."), _("\
14255 Attempts to access an object whose size is not a compile-time constant\n\
14256 and exceeds this limit will cause an error."),
14257 NULL, NULL, &setlist, &showlist);
14258
14259 add_info ("exceptions", info_exceptions_command,
14260 _("\
14261 List all Ada exception names.\n\
14262 Usage: info exceptions [REGEXP]\n\
14263 If a regular expression is passed as an argument, only those matching\n\
14264 the regular expression are listed."));
14265
14266 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance,
14267 _("Set Ada maintenance-related variables."),
14268 &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance set ada ",
14269 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_set_cmdlist);
14270
14271 add_show_prefix_cmd ("ada", class_maintenance,
14272 _("Show Ada maintenance-related variables."),
14273 &maint_show_ada_cmdlist, "maintenance show ada ",
14274 0/*allow-unknown*/, &maintenance_show_cmdlist);
14275
14276 add_setshow_boolean_cmd
14277 ("ignore-descriptive-types", class_maintenance,
14278 &ada_ignore_descriptive_types_p,
14279 _("Set whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
14280 _("Show whether descriptive types generated by GNAT should be ignored."),
14281 _("\
14282 When enabled, the debugger will stop using the DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type\n\
14283 DWARF attribute."),
14284 NULL, NULL, &maint_set_ada_cmdlist, &maint_show_ada_cmdlist);
14285
14286 decoded_names_store = htab_create_alloc (256, htab_hash_string, streq_hash,
14287 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14288
14289 /* The ada-lang observers. */
14290 gdb::observers::new_objfile.attach (ada_new_objfile_observer);
14291 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (ada_free_objfile_observer);
14292 gdb::observers::inferior_exit.attach (ada_inferior_exit);
14293 }
This page took 0.340577 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.